gdb/
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006@*
56 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
57
58 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
59 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
60 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
61 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
62 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
63 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
64
65 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
66 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
67 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
68 development.''
69 @end ifinfo
70
71 @titlepage
72 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
73 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
74 @sp 1
75 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
76 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
77 @page
78 @tex
79 {\parskip=0pt
80 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
81 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
82 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
83 }
84 @end tex
85
86 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
87 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
88 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006
89 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
90 @sp 2
91 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
92 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
93 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
94 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
95
96 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
97 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
98 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
99 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
100 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
101 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
102
103 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
104 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
105 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
106 development.''
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
118 @value{GDBVN}.
119
120 Copyright (C) 1988-2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
121
122 @menu
123 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
124 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
125
126 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
127 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
128 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
129 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
130 * Stack:: Examining the stack
131 * Source:: Examining source files
132 * Data:: Examining data
133 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
134 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
135 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
136
137 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
138
139 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
140 * Altering:: Altering execution
141 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
142 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
143 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
144 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
145 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
146 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
147 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
148 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
149 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
150 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
151 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
152
153 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
154 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
155
156 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
157 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
158 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
159 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
160 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
161 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
198 For more information, see @ref{Supported languages,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
217 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
218
219 @menu
220 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
221 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
222 @end menu
223
224 @node Free Software
225 @unnumberedsec Free software
226
227 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
228 General Public License
229 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
230 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
231 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
232 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
233 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
234 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
235
236 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
237 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
238 from anyone else.
239
240 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
241
242 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
243 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
244 include with the free software. Many of our most important
245 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
246 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
247 when an important free software package does not come with a free
248 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
249 gaps today.
250
251 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
252 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
253 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
254 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
255 them from the free software world.
256
257 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
258 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
259 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
260 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
261 contract to make it non-free.
262
263 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
264 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
265 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
266 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
267 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
268 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
269 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
270
271 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
272 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
273 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
274 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
275
276 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
277 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
278 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
279 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
280 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
281 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
282 community.
283
284 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
285 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
286 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
287 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
288 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
289 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
290 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
291 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
292 of the manual.
293
294 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
295 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
296 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
297 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
298 manual to replace it.
299
300 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
301 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
302 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
303 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
304 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
305 the free software community.
306
307 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
308 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
309 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
310 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
311 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
312 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
313 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
314 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
315 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
316
317 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
318 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
319 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
320 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
321 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
322 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
323 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
324 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
325
326 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
327 published by other publishers, at
328 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
329
330 @node Contributors
331 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
332
333 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
334 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
335 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
336 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
337 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
338 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
339 blow-by-blow account.
340
341 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
342
343 @quotation
344 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
345 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
346 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
347 @end quotation
348
349 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
350 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
351 releases:
352 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
353 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
354 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
355 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
356 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
357 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
358 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
359 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
360 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
361
362 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
363 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
364
365 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
366 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
367 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
368 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
369 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
370
371 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
372 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
373 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
374
375 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
376 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
377
378 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
379
380 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
381 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
382 support.
383 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
384 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
385 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
386 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
387 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
388 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
389 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
390 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
391 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
392 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
393 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
394 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
395 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
396 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
397 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
398 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
399
400 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
401
402 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
403 libraries.
404
405 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
406 about several machine instruction sets.
407
408 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
409 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
410 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
411 and RDI targets, respectively.
412
413 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
414 command-line editing and command history.
415
416 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
417 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
418
419 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
420 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
421 symbols.
422
423 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
424 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
425
426 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
427
428 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
429 processors.
430
431 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
432
433 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
434
435 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
436
437 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
438 watchpoints.
439
440 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
441
442 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
443
444 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
445 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
446
447 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
448 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
449 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
450 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
451 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
452 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
453 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
454
455 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
456 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
457
458 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
459 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
460 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
461 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
462 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
463 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
464 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
465 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
466 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
467 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
468 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
469 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
470 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
471 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
472 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
473
474 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
475 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
476
477 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
478 Hat.
479
480 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
481 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
482 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
483 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
484 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
485 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
486
487 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
488 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
489 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
490 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
491 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
492 trad unwinders. The architecture specific changes, each involving a
493 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
494 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
495 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
496 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
497 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
498 Weigand.
499
500 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
501 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
502 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
503 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
504
505 @node Sample Session
506 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
507
508 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
509 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
510 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
511
512 @iftex
513 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
514 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
515 @end iftex
516
517 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
518 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
519
520 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
521 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
522 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
523 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
524 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
525 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
526 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
527 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
528 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
529
530 @smallexample
531 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
532 $ @b{./m4}
533 @b{define(foo,0000)}
534
535 @b{foo}
536 0000
537 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
538
539 @b{bar}
540 0000
541 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
542
543 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
544 @b{baz}
545 @b{Ctrl-d}
546 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
547 @end smallexample
548
549 @noindent
550 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
551
552 @smallexample
553 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
554 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
555 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
556 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
557 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
558 the conditions.
559 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
560 for details.
561
562 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
563 (@value{GDBP})
564 @end smallexample
565
566 @noindent
567 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
568 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
569 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
570 that examples fit in this manual.
571
572 @smallexample
573 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
574 @end smallexample
575
576 @noindent
577 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
578 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
579 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
580 @code{break} command.
581
582 @smallexample
583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
584 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
585 @end smallexample
586
587 @noindent
588 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
589 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
590 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
591
592 @smallexample
593 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
594 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
595 @b{define(foo,0000)}
596
597 @b{foo}
598 0000
599 @end smallexample
600
601 @noindent
602 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
603 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
604 context where it stops.
605
606 @smallexample
607 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
608
609 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
610 at builtin.c:879
611 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
612 @end smallexample
613
614 @noindent
615 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
616 the next line of the current function.
617
618 @smallexample
619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
620 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
621 : nil,
622 @end smallexample
623
624 @noindent
625 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
626 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
627 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
628 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
629
630 @smallexample
631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
632 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
633 at input.c:530
634 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
635 @end smallexample
636
637 @noindent
638 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
639 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
640 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
641 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
642 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
643 stack frame for each active subroutine.
644
645 @smallexample
646 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
647 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
648 at input.c:530
649 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
650 at builtin.c:882
651 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
652 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
653 at macro.c:71
654 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
655 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
660 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
661 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
665 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
667 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
668 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
669 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
670 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
671 : xstrdup(rq);
672 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
673 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
678 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
679 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
680 (@code{print}) to see their values.
681
682 @smallexample
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
684 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
686 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
687 @end smallexample
688
689 @noindent
690 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
691 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
692 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
696 533 xfree(rquote);
697 534
698 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
699 : xstrdup (lq);
700 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
701 : xstrdup (rq);
702 537
703 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
704 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
705 540 @}
706 541
707 542 void
708 @end smallexample
709
710 @noindent
711 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
712 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
713
714 @smallexample
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
716 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
717 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
718 540 @}
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
720 $3 = 9
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
722 $4 = 7
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
727 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
728 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
729 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
730 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
731 assignments.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
735 $5 = 7
736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
737 $6 = 9
738 @end smallexample
739
740 @noindent
741 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
742 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
743 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
744 example that caused trouble initially:
745
746 @smallexample
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
748 Continuing.
749
750 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
751
752 baz
753 0000
754 @end smallexample
755
756 @noindent
757 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
758 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
759 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
760
761 @smallexample
762 @b{Ctrl-d}
763 Program exited normally.
764 @end smallexample
765
766 @noindent
767 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
768 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
769 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
770
771 @smallexample
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
773 @end smallexample
774
775 @node Invocation
776 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
777
778 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
779 The essentials are:
780 @itemize @bullet
781 @item
782 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
783 @item
784 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
785 @end itemize
786
787 @menu
788 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
789 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
790 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
791 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
792 @end menu
793
794 @node Invoking GDB
795 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
796
797 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
798 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
799
800 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
801 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
802
803 The command-line options described here are designed
804 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
805 options may effectively be unavailable.
806
807 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
808 specifying an executable program:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @noindent
815 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
816 specified:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
820 @end smallexample
821
822 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
823 to debug a running process:
824
825 @smallexample
826 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
827 @end smallexample
828
829 @noindent
830 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
831 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
832
833 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
834 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
835 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
836 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
837 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
838
839 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
840 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
841 option processing.
842 @smallexample
843 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
844 @end smallexample
845 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
846 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
847
848 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
849 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
850
851 @smallexample
852 @value{GDBP} -silent
853 @end smallexample
854
855 @noindent
856 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
857 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
858
859 @noindent
860 Type
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} -help
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
868 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
869
870 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
871 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
872 @samp{-x} option is used.
873
874
875 @menu
876 * File Options:: Choosing files
877 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
878 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
879 @end menu
880
881 @node File Options
882 @subsection Choosing files
883
884 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
885 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
886 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
887 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
888 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
889 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
890 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
891 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
892 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
893 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
894 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
895 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
896 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
897
898 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
899 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
900 argument and ignore it.
901
902 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
903 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
904 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
905 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
906 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
907
908 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
909 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
910 @c it.
911
912 @table @code
913 @item -symbols @var{file}
914 @itemx -s @var{file}
915 @cindex @code{--symbols}
916 @cindex @code{-s}
917 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
918
919 @item -exec @var{file}
920 @itemx -e @var{file}
921 @cindex @code{--exec}
922 @cindex @code{-e}
923 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
924 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
925
926 @item -se @var{file}
927 @cindex @code{--se}
928 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
929 file.
930
931 @item -core @var{file}
932 @itemx -c @var{file}
933 @cindex @code{--core}
934 @cindex @code{-c}
935 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
936
937 @item -c @var{number}
938 @item -pid @var{number}
939 @itemx -p @var{number}
940 @cindex @code{--pid}
941 @cindex @code{-p}
942 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
943 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
944 file named @var{number}.
945
946 @item -command @var{file}
947 @itemx -x @var{file}
948 @cindex @code{--command}
949 @cindex @code{-x}
950 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
951 Files,, Command files}.
952
953 @item -eval-command @var{command}
954 @itemx -ex @var{command}
955 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
956 @cindex @code{-ex}
957 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
958
959 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
960 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
961
962 @smallexample
963 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
964 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
965 @end smallexample
966
967 @item -directory @var{directory}
968 @itemx -d @var{directory}
969 @cindex @code{--directory}
970 @cindex @code{-d}
971 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
972
973 @item -r
974 @itemx -readnow
975 @cindex @code{--readnow}
976 @cindex @code{-r}
977 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
978 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
979 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
980
981 @end table
982
983 @node Mode Options
984 @subsection Choosing modes
985
986 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
987 batch mode or quiet mode.
988
989 @table @code
990 @item -nx
991 @itemx -n
992 @cindex @code{--nx}
993 @cindex @code{-n}
994 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
995 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
996 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
997 files}.
998
999 @item -quiet
1000 @itemx -silent
1001 @itemx -q
1002 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1003 @cindex @code{--silent}
1004 @cindex @code{-q}
1005 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1006 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1007
1008 @item -batch
1009 @cindex @code{--batch}
1010 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1011 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1012 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1013 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1014 in the command files.
1015
1016 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1017 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1018 make this more useful, the message
1019
1020 @smallexample
1021 Program exited normally.
1022 @end smallexample
1023
1024 @noindent
1025 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1026 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1027 mode.
1028
1029 @item -batch-silent
1030 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1031 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1032 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1033 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1034 for an interactive session.
1035
1036 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1037 messages, for example.
1038
1039 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1040 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1041
1042 @item -return-child-result
1043 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1044 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1045 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1046
1047 @itemize @bullet
1048 @item
1049 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1050 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1051 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1052 @item
1053 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1054 @item
1055 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1056 the exit code will be -1.
1057 @end itemize
1058
1059 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1060 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1061 interface.
1062
1063 @item -nowindows
1064 @itemx -nw
1065 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1066 @cindex @code{-nw}
1067 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1068 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1069 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1070
1071 @item -windows
1072 @itemx -w
1073 @cindex @code{--windows}
1074 @cindex @code{-w}
1075 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1076 used if possible.
1077
1078 @item -cd @var{directory}
1079 @cindex @code{--cd}
1080 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1081 instead of the current directory.
1082
1083 @item -fullname
1084 @itemx -f
1085 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1086 @cindex @code{-f}
1087 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1088 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1089 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1090 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1091 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1092 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1093 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1094 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1095 frame.
1096
1097 @item -epoch
1098 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1099 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1100 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1101 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1102 separate window.
1103
1104 @item -annotate @var{level}
1105 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1106 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1107 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1108 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1109 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1110 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1111 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1112 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1113 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1114
1115 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1116 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1117
1118 @item --args
1119 @cindex @code{--args}
1120 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1121 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1122 This option stops option processing.
1123
1124 @item -baud @var{bps}
1125 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1126 @cindex @code{--baud}
1127 @cindex @code{-b}
1128 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1129 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1130
1131 @item -l @var{timeout}
1132 @cindex @code{-l}
1133 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1134 for remote debugging.
1135
1136 @item -tty @var{device}
1137 @itemx -t @var{device}
1138 @cindex @code{--tty}
1139 @cindex @code{-t}
1140 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1141 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1142
1143 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1144 @item -tui
1145 @cindex @code{--tui}
1146 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1147 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1148 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1149 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1150 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1151 @samp{gdbtui}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1152 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1153
1154 @c @item -xdb
1155 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1156 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1157 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1158 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1159 @c systems.
1160
1161 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1162 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1163 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1164 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1165 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1166 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1167
1168 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1169 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1170 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1171 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1172 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1173 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1174
1175 @item -write
1176 @cindex @code{--write}
1177 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1178 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1179 (@pxref{Patching}).
1180
1181 @item -statistics
1182 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1183 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1184 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1185
1186 @item -version
1187 @cindex @code{--version}
1188 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1189 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1190
1191 @end table
1192
1193 @node Startup
1194 @subsection What @value{GDBN} does during startup
1195 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1196
1197 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1198
1199 @enumerate
1200 @item
1201 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1202 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1203
1204 @item
1205 @cindex init file
1206 Reads the @dfn{init file} (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1207 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1208 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1209 that file.
1210
1211 @item
1212 Processes command line options and operands.
1213
1214 @item
1215 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1216 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1217 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1218 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1219 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1220 @value{GDBN}.
1221
1222 @item
1223 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1224 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1225
1226 @item
1227 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1228 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1229 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1230 @end enumerate
1231
1232 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1233 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1234 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1235 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1236 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1237 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
1238
1239 @cindex init file name
1240 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1241 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1242 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
1243 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
1244 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
1245 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
1246 environments with special init file names:
1247
1248 @itemize @bullet
1249 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1250 @item
1251 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1252 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1253 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1254 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1255 the file to the standard name.
1256
1257 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
1258 @item
1259 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
1260
1261 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
1262 @item
1263 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
1264
1265 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
1266 @item
1267 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
1268
1269 @item
1270 CISCO 68k: @file{.cisco-gdbinit}
1271 @end itemize
1272
1273
1274 @node Quitting GDB
1275 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1276 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1277 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1278
1279 @table @code
1280 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1281 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1282 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1283 @itemx q
1284 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1285 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1286 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1287 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1288 error code.
1289 @end table
1290
1291 @cindex interrupt
1292 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1293 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1294 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1295 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1296 until a time when it is safe.
1297
1298 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1299 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1300 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1301
1302 @node Shell Commands
1303 @section Shell commands
1304
1305 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1306 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1307 just use the @code{shell} command.
1308
1309 @table @code
1310 @kindex shell
1311 @cindex shell escape
1312 @item shell @var{command string}
1313 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1314 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1315 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1316 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1317 @end table
1318
1319 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1320 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1321 @value{GDBN}:
1322
1323 @table @code
1324 @kindex make
1325 @cindex calling make
1326 @item make @var{make-args}
1327 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1328 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1329 @end table
1330
1331 @node Logging output
1332 @section Logging output
1333 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1334 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1335
1336 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1337 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1338
1339 @table @code
1340 @kindex set logging
1341 @item set logging on
1342 Enable logging.
1343 @item set logging off
1344 Disable logging.
1345 @cindex logging file name
1346 @item set logging file @var{file}
1347 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1348 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1349 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1350 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1351 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1352 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1353 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1354 @kindex show logging
1355 @item show logging
1356 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1357 @end table
1358
1359 @node Commands
1360 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1361
1362 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1363 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1364 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1365 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1366 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1367
1368 @menu
1369 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1370 * Completion:: Command completion
1371 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1372 @end menu
1373
1374 @node Command Syntax
1375 @section Command syntax
1376
1377 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1378 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1379 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1380 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1381 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1382 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1383
1384 @cindex abbreviation
1385 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1386 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1387 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1388 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1389 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1390 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1391 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1392
1393 @cindex repeating commands
1394 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1395 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1396 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1397 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1398 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1399 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1400 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1401
1402 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1403 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1404 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1405
1406 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1407 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1408 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1409 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1410 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1411
1412 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1413 @cindex comment
1414 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1415 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1416 Files,,Command files}).
1417
1418 @cindex repeating command sequences
1419 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1420 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1421 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1422 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1423 for editing.
1424
1425 @node Completion
1426 @section Command completion
1427
1428 @cindex completion
1429 @cindex word completion
1430 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1431 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1432 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1433 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1434
1435 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1436 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1437 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1438 enter it). For example, if you type
1439
1440 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1441 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1442 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1443 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1444 @smallexample
1445 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1446 @end smallexample
1447
1448 @noindent
1449 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1450 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1451
1452 @smallexample
1453 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1454 @end smallexample
1455
1456 @noindent
1457 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1458 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1459 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1460 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1461 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1462 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1463
1464 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1465 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1466 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1467 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1468 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1469 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1470 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1471 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1472 example:
1473
1474 @smallexample
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1476 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1477 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1478 make_abs_section make_function_type
1479 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1480 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1481 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1482 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1483 @end smallexample
1484
1485 @noindent
1486 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1487 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1488 command.
1489
1490 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1491 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1492 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1493 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1494 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1495
1496 @cindex quotes in commands
1497 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1498 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1499 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1500 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1501 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1502 @value{GDBN} commands.
1503
1504 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1505 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1506 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1507 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1508 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1509 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1510 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1511 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1512 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1513 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1514 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1515
1516 @smallexample
1517 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1518 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1519 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1520 @end smallexample
1521
1522 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1523 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1524 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1525 place:
1526
1527 @smallexample
1528 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1529 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1530 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1531 @end smallexample
1532
1533 @noindent
1534 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1535 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1536 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1537
1538 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1539 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1540 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1541 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1542
1543
1544 @node Help
1545 @section Getting help
1546 @cindex online documentation
1547 @kindex help
1548
1549 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1550 using the command @code{help}.
1551
1552 @table @code
1553 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1554 @item help
1555 @itemx h
1556 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1557 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1558
1559 @smallexample
1560 (@value{GDBP}) help
1561 List of classes of commands:
1562
1563 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1564 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1565 data -- Examining data
1566 files -- Specifying and examining files
1567 internals -- Maintenance commands
1568 obscure -- Obscure features
1569 running -- Running the program
1570 stack -- Examining the stack
1571 status -- Status inquiries
1572 support -- Support facilities
1573 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1574 stopping the program
1575 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1576
1577 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1578 commands in that class.
1579 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1580 documentation.
1581 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1582 (@value{GDBP})
1583 @end smallexample
1584 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1585
1586 @item help @var{class}
1587 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1588 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1589 help display for the class @code{status}:
1590
1591 @smallexample
1592 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1593 Status inquiries.
1594
1595 List of commands:
1596
1597 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1598 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1599 info -- Generic command for showing things
1600 about the program being debugged
1601 show -- Generic command for showing things
1602 about the debugger
1603
1604 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1605 documentation.
1606 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1607 (@value{GDBP})
1608 @end smallexample
1609
1610 @item help @var{command}
1611 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1612 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1613
1614 @kindex apropos
1615 @item apropos @var{args}
1616 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1617 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1618 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 apropos reload
1622 @end smallexample
1623
1624 @noindent
1625 results in:
1626
1627 @smallexample
1628 @c @group
1629 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1630 multiple times in one run
1631 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1632 multiple times in one run
1633 @c @end group
1634 @end smallexample
1635
1636 @kindex complete
1637 @item complete @var{args}
1638 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1639 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1640 command you want completed. For example:
1641
1642 @smallexample
1643 complete i
1644 @end smallexample
1645
1646 @noindent results in:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 @group
1650 if
1651 ignore
1652 info
1653 inspect
1654 @end group
1655 @end smallexample
1656
1657 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1658 @end table
1659
1660 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1661 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1662 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1663 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1664 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1665 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1666
1667 @c @group
1668 @table @code
1669 @kindex info
1670 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1671 @item info
1672 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1673 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1674 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1675 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1676 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1677 @w{@code{help info}}.
1678
1679 @kindex set
1680 @item set
1681 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1682 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1683 @code{set prompt $}.
1684
1685 @kindex show
1686 @item show
1687 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1688 @value{GDBN} itself.
1689 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1690 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1691 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1692 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1693
1694 @kindex info set
1695 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1696 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1697 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1698 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1699 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1700 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1701 @end table
1702 @c @end group
1703
1704 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1705 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1706
1707 @table @code
1708 @kindex show version
1709 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1710 @item show version
1711 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1712 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1713 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1714 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1715 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1716 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1717 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1718 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1719 @value{GDBN}.
1720
1721 @kindex show copying
1722 @kindex info copying
1723 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1724 @item show copying
1725 @itemx info copying
1726 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1727
1728 @kindex show warranty
1729 @kindex info warranty
1730 @item show warranty
1731 @itemx info warranty
1732 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1733 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1734
1735 @end table
1736
1737 @node Running
1738 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1739
1740 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1741 debugging information when you compile it.
1742
1743 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1744 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1745 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1746 kill a child process.
1747
1748 @menu
1749 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1750 * Starting:: Starting your program
1751 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1752 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1753
1754 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1755 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1756 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1757 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1758
1759 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1760 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1761 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1762 @end menu
1763
1764 @node Compilation
1765 @section Compiling for debugging
1766
1767 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1768 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1769 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1770 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1771 and addresses in the executable code.
1772
1773 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1774 the compiler.
1775
1776 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1777 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1778 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1779 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1780 executables containing debugging information.
1781
1782 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1783 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1784 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1785 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1786 in pushing your luck.
1787
1788 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1789 @cindex debugging optimized code
1790 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1791 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1792 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1793 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1794 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1795 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1796
1797 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1798 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1799 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1800 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1801 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1802
1803 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1804 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1805 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1806
1807 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1808 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1809 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1810 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1811 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1812 provides macro information if you specify the options
1813 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1814 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1815 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1816 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1817 @option{-g} alone.
1818
1819 @need 2000
1820 @node Starting
1821 @section Starting your program
1822 @cindex starting
1823 @cindex running
1824
1825 @table @code
1826 @kindex run
1827 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1828 @item run
1829 @itemx r
1830 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1831 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1832 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1833 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1834 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1835
1836 @end table
1837
1838 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1839 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1840 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1841 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1842
1843 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1844 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1845 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1846 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1847 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1848 divided into four categories:
1849
1850 @table @asis
1851 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1852 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1853 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1854 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1855 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1856 the arguments.
1857 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1858 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1859 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1860
1861 @item The @emph{environment.}
1862 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1863 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1864 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1865 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1866
1867 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1868 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1869 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1870 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1871
1872 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1873 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1874 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1875 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1876 set a different device for your program.
1877 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1878
1879 @cindex pipes
1880 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1881 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1882 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1883 wrong program.
1884 @end table
1885
1886 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1887 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1888 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1889 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1890 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1891
1892 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1893 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1894 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1895 your current breakpoints.
1896
1897 @table @code
1898 @kindex start
1899 @item start
1900 @cindex run to main procedure
1901 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1902 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1903 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1904 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1905 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1906 procedure, depending on the language used.
1907
1908 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1909 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1910 the @samp{run} command.
1911
1912 @cindex elaboration phase
1913 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1914 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1915 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1916 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1917 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1918 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1919 will remain to halt execution.
1920
1921 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1922 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1923 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1924 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1925 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1926
1927 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1928 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1929 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1930 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1931 elaboration code before running your program.
1932 @end table
1933
1934 @node Arguments
1935 @section Your program's arguments
1936
1937 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1938 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1939 @code{run} command.
1940 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1941 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1942 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1943 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1944 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1945
1946 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1947 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1948 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1949 the program, not by the shell.
1950
1951 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1952 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1953
1954 @table @code
1955 @kindex set args
1956 @item set args
1957 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1958 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1959 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1960 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1961 it again without arguments.
1962
1963 @kindex show args
1964 @item show args
1965 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1966 @end table
1967
1968 @node Environment
1969 @section Your program's environment
1970
1971 @cindex environment (of your program)
1972 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1973 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1974 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1975 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1976 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1977 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1978 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1979
1980 @table @code
1981 @kindex path
1982 @item path @var{directory}
1983 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1984 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1985 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1986 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1987 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1988 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1989 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1990
1991 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1992 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1993 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1994 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1995 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1996 @var{directory} to the search path.
1997 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1998 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1999
2000 @kindex show paths
2001 @item show paths
2002 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2003 environment variable).
2004
2005 @kindex show environment
2006 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2007 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2008 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2009 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2010 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2011
2012 @kindex set environment
2013 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2014 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2015 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2016 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2017 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2018 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2019 null value.
2020 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2021 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2022
2023 For example, this command:
2024
2025 @smallexample
2026 set env USER = foo
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 @noindent
2030 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2031 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2032 are not actually required.)
2033
2034 @kindex unset environment
2035 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2036 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2037 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2038 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2039 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2040 @end table
2041
2042 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2043 the shell indicated
2044 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2045 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2046 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2047 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2048 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2049 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2050 @file{.profile}.
2051
2052 @node Working Directory
2053 @section Your program's working directory
2054
2055 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2056 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2057 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2058 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2059 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2060 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2061
2062 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2063 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2064 specify files}.
2065
2066 @table @code
2067 @kindex cd
2068 @cindex change working directory
2069 @item cd @var{directory}
2070 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2071
2072 @kindex pwd
2073 @item pwd
2074 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2075 @end table
2076
2077 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2078 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2079 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2080 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2081 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2082 current working directory of the debuggee.
2083
2084 @node Input/Output
2085 @section Your program's input and output
2086
2087 @cindex redirection
2088 @cindex i/o
2089 @cindex terminal
2090 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2091 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2092 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2093 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2094 running your program.
2095
2096 @table @code
2097 @kindex info terminal
2098 @item info terminal
2099 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2100 program is using.
2101 @end table
2102
2103 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2104 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2105
2106 @smallexample
2107 run > outfile
2108 @end smallexample
2109
2110 @noindent
2111 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2112
2113 @kindex tty
2114 @cindex controlling terminal
2115 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2116 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2117 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2118 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2119 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2120
2121 @smallexample
2122 tty /dev/ttyb
2123 @end smallexample
2124
2125 @noindent
2126 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2127 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2128 that as their controlling terminal.
2129
2130 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2131 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2132 terminal.
2133
2134 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2135 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2136 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2137 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2138
2139 @cindex inferior tty
2140 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2141 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2142 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2143 program.
2144
2145 @table @code
2146 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2147 @kindex set inferior-tty
2148 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2149
2150 @item show inferior-tty
2151 @kindex show inferior-tty
2152 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2153 @end table
2154
2155 @node Attach
2156 @section Debugging an already-running process
2157 @kindex attach
2158 @cindex attach
2159
2160 @table @code
2161 @item attach @var{process-id}
2162 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2163 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2164 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2165 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2166 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2167
2168 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2169 executing the command.
2170 @end table
2171
2172 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2173 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2174 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2175 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2176
2177 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2178 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2179 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2180 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
2181 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2182 Specify Files}.
2183
2184 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2185 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2186 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2187 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2188 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2189 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2190 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2191
2192 @table @code
2193 @kindex detach
2194 @item detach
2195 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2196 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2197 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2198 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2199 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2200 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2201 executing the command.
2202 @end table
2203
2204 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2205 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2206 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2207 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2208 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2209 messages}).
2210
2211 @node Kill Process
2212 @section Killing the child process
2213
2214 @table @code
2215 @kindex kill
2216 @item kill
2217 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2218 @end table
2219
2220 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2221 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2222 is running.
2223
2224 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2225 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2226 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2227 outside the debugger.
2228
2229 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2230 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2231 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2232 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2233 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2234 breakpoint settings).
2235
2236 @node Threads
2237 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2238
2239 @cindex threads of execution
2240 @cindex multiple threads
2241 @cindex switching threads
2242 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2243 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2244 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2245 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2246 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2247 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2248 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2249
2250 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2251 programs:
2252
2253 @itemize @bullet
2254 @item automatic notification of new threads
2255 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2256 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2257 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2258 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2259 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2260 @end itemize
2261
2262 @quotation
2263 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2264 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2265 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2266 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2267 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2268 like this:
2269
2270 @smallexample
2271 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2272 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2273 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2274 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2275 @end smallexample
2276 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2277 @c doesn't support threads"?
2278 @end quotation
2279
2280 @cindex focus of debugging
2281 @cindex current thread
2282 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2283 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2284 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2285 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2286 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2287
2288 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2289 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2290 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2291 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2292 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2293 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2294 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2295 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2296 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2297 LynxOS, you might see
2298
2299 @smallexample
2300 [New process 35 thread 27]
2301 @end smallexample
2302
2303 @noindent
2304 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2305 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2306 further qualifier.
2307
2308 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2309 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2310 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2311 @c program?
2312 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2313 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2314 @c threads ab initio?
2315
2316 @cindex thread number
2317 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2318 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2319 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2320
2321 @table @code
2322 @kindex info threads
2323 @item info threads
2324 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2325 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2326
2327 @enumerate
2328 @item
2329 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2330
2331 @item
2332 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2333
2334 @item
2335 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2336 @end enumerate
2337
2338 @noindent
2339 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2340 indicates the current thread.
2341
2342 For example,
2343 @end table
2344 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2345
2346 @smallexample
2347 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2348 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2349 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2350 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2351 at threadtest.c:68
2352 @end smallexample
2353
2354 On HP-UX systems:
2355
2356 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2357 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2358 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2359 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2360 thread in your program.
2361
2362 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2363 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2364 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2365 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2366 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2367 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2368 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2369 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2370 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2371 HP-UX, you see
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2379
2380 @table @code
2381 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2382 @item info threads
2383 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2384 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2385
2386 @enumerate
2387 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2388
2389 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2390
2391 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2392 @end enumerate
2393
2394 @noindent
2395 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2396 indicates the current thread.
2397
2398 For example,
2399 @end table
2400 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2401
2402 @smallexample
2403 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2404 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2405 at quicksort.c:137
2406 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2407 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2408 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2409 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2410 @end smallexample
2411
2412 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2413 Solaris-specific command:
2414
2415 @table @code
2416 @item maint info sol-threads
2417 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2418 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2419 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2420 @end table
2421
2422 @table @code
2423 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2424 @item thread @var{threadno}
2425 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2426 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2427 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2428 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2429 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2430
2431 @smallexample
2432 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2433 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2434 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2435 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2436 @end smallexample
2437
2438 @noindent
2439 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2440 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2441 threads.
2442
2443 @kindex thread apply
2444 @cindex apply command to several threads
2445 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2446 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2447 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2448 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2449 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2450 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2451 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2452 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2453 @end table
2454
2455 @cindex automatic thread selection
2456 @cindex switching threads automatically
2457 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2458 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2459 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2460 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2461 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2462 thread.
2463
2464 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2465 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2466 programs with multiple threads.
2467
2468 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2469 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2470
2471 @node Processes
2472 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2473
2474 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2475 @cindex multiple processes
2476 @cindex processes, multiple
2477 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2478 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2479 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2480 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2481 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2482 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2483 will cause it to terminate.
2484
2485 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2486 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2487 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2488 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2489 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2490 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2491 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2492 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2493 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2494 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2495
2496 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2497 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2498 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2499 only?) and GNU/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2500
2501 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2502 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2503
2504 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2505 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2506
2507 @table @code
2508 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2509 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2510 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2511 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2512 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2513
2514 @table @code
2515 @item parent
2516 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2517 unimpeded. This is the default.
2518
2519 @item child
2520 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2521 unimpeded.
2522
2523 @end table
2524
2525 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2526 @item show follow-fork-mode
2527 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2528 @end table
2529
2530 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2531 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2532 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2533
2534 @table @code
2535 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2536 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2537 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2538 retain debugger control over them both.
2539
2540 @table @code
2541 @item on
2542 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2543 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2544 independently. This is the default.
2545
2546 @item off
2547 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2548 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2549 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2550 is held suspended.
2551
2552 @end table
2553
2554 @kindex show detach-on-follow
2555 @item show detach-on-follow
2556 Show whether detach-on-follow mode is on/off.
2557 @end table
2558
2559 If you choose to set @var{detach-on-follow} mode off, then
2560 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2561 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2562 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2563 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2564
2565 @table @code
2566 @kindex info forks
2567 @item info forks
2568 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2569 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2570 position (program counter) of the process.
2571
2572
2573 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2574 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2575 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2576 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2577 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2578
2579 @end table
2580
2581 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2582 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2583 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2584 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2585
2586 @table @code
2587 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2588 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2589 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2590 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2591 allowed to run independently.
2592
2593 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2594 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2595 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2596 and remove it from the fork list.
2597
2598 @end table
2599
2600 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2601 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2602 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2603 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2604 the child process's @code{main}.
2605
2606 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2607 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2608
2609 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2610 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2611 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2612 argument.
2613
2614 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2615 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2616 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2617
2618 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2619 @section Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2620
2621 @cindex checkpoint
2622 @cindex restart
2623 @cindex bookmark
2624 @cindex snapshot of a process
2625 @cindex rewind program state
2626
2627 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2628 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2629 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2630 later.
2631
2632 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2633 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2634 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2635 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2636 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2637
2638 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2639 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2640 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2641 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2642 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2643 start again from there.
2644
2645 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2646 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2647
2648 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2649
2650 @table @code
2651 @kindex checkpoint
2652 @item checkpoint
2653 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2654 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2655 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2656
2657 @kindex info checkpoints
2658 @item info checkpoints
2659 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2660 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2661 listed:
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @item Checkpoint ID
2665 @item Process ID
2666 @item Code Address
2667 @item Source line, or label
2668 @end table
2669
2670 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2671 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2672 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2673 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2674 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2675 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2676 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2677
2678 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2679 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2680 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2681 the debugger.
2682
2683 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2684 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2685 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2686
2687 @end table
2688
2689 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2690 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2691 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2692 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2693 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2694 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2695 previously read data can be read again.
2696
2697 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2698 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2699 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2700 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2701 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2702 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2703
2704 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2705 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2706 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2707 different execution path this time.
2708
2709 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2710 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2711 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2712 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2713 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2714 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2715 potentially pose a problem.
2716
2717 @subsection A non-obvious benefit of using checkpoints
2718
2719 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2720 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2721 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2722 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2723 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2724 next.
2725
2726 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2727 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2728 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2729 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2730 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2731
2732 @node Stopping
2733 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2734
2735 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2736 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2737 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2738
2739 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2740 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2741 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2742 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2743 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2744 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2745 explicitly request this information at any time.
2746
2747 @table @code
2748 @kindex info program
2749 @item info program
2750 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2751 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2752 @end table
2753
2754 @menu
2755 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2756 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2757 * Signals:: Signals
2758 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2759 @end menu
2760
2761 @node Breakpoints
2762 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2763
2764 @cindex breakpoints
2765 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2766 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2767 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2768 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2769 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2770 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2771 program.
2772
2773 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2774 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2775 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2776 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2777 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2778 call).
2779
2780 @cindex watchpoints
2781 @cindex data breakpoints
2782 @cindex memory tracing
2783 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2784 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2785 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2786 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2787 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2788 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2789 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2790 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting watchpoints}), but aside
2791 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2792 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2793 same commands.
2794
2795 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2796 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2797 Automatic display}.
2798
2799 @cindex catchpoints
2800 @cindex breakpoint on events
2801 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2802 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2803 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2804 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2805 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2806 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2807 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2808
2809 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2810 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2811 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2812 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2813 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2814 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2815 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2816 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2817 enable it again.
2818
2819 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2820 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2821 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2822 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2823 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2824 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2825 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2826
2827 @menu
2828 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2829 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2830 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2831 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2832 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2833 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2834 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2835 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2836 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2837 * Breakpoint related warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
2838 @end menu
2839
2840 @node Set Breaks
2841 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2842
2843 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2844 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2845 @c
2846 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2847
2848 @kindex break
2849 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2850 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2851 @cindex latest breakpoint
2852 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2853 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2854 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2855 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2856 convenience variables.
2857
2858 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2859
2860 @table @code
2861 @item break @var{function}
2862 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2863 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2864 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2865 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2866
2867 @item break +@var{offset}
2868 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2869 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2870 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2871 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2872
2873 @item break @var{linenum}
2874 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2875 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2876 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2877 code on that line.
2878
2879 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2880 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2881
2882 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2883 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2884 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2885 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2886 functions.
2887
2888 @item break *@var{address}
2889 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2890 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2891 information or source files.
2892
2893 @item break
2894 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2895 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2896 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2897 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2898 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2899 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2900 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2901 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2902 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2903 inside loops.
2904
2905 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2906 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2907 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2908 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2909 existed when your program stopped.
2910
2911 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2912 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2913 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2914 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2915 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2916 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2917 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2918
2919 @kindex tbreak
2920 @item tbreak @var{args}
2921 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2922 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2923 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2924 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2925
2926 @kindex hbreak
2927 @cindex hardware breakpoints
2928 @item hbreak @var{args}
2929 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2930 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2931 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2932 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2933 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2934 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2935 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
2936 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2937 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2938 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2939 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2940 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2941 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2942 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2943 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
2944 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
2945 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2946
2947
2948 @kindex thbreak
2949 @item thbreak @var{args}
2950 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2951 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2952 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2953 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2954 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2955 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2956 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2957 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2958
2959 @kindex rbreak
2960 @cindex regular expression
2961 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
2962 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
2963 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2964 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2965 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2966 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2967 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2968 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2969 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2970
2971 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2972 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2973 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2974 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2975 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2976 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2977
2978 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
2979 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2980 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2981 classes.
2982
2983 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
2984 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
2985 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
2986
2987 @smallexample
2988 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
2989 @end smallexample
2990
2991 @kindex info breakpoints
2992 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2993 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2994 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2995 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2996 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2997 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
2998 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
2999 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3000
3001 @table @emph
3002 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3003 @item Type
3004 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3005 @item Disposition
3006 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3007 @item Enabled or Disabled
3008 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3009 that are not enabled.
3010 @item Address
3011 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. If the
3012 breakpoint is pending (see below for details) on a future load of a shared library, the address
3013 will be listed as @samp{<PENDING>}.
3014 @item What
3015 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3016 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3017 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3018 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3019 @end table
3020
3021 @noindent
3022 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3023 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3024 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3025 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3026 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3027 valid location.
3028
3029 @noindent
3030 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3031 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3032 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3033 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3034 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
3035
3036 @noindent
3037 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3038 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3039 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3040 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3041 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3042 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3043 @end table
3044
3045 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3046 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3047 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3048 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3049
3050 @cindex pending breakpoints
3051 If a specified breakpoint location cannot be found, it may be due to the fact
3052 that the location is in a shared library that is yet to be loaded. In such
3053 a case, you may want @value{GDBN} to create a special breakpoint (known as
3054 a @dfn{pending breakpoint}) that
3055 attempts to resolve itself in the future when an appropriate shared library
3056 gets loaded.
3057
3058 Pending breakpoints are useful to set at the start of your
3059 @value{GDBN} session for locations that you know will be dynamically loaded
3060 later by the program being debugged. When shared libraries are loaded,
3061 a check is made to see if the load resolves any pending breakpoint locations.
3062 If a pending breakpoint location gets resolved,
3063 a regular breakpoint is created and the original pending breakpoint is removed.
3064
3065 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling pending
3066 breakpoint support:
3067
3068 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3069 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3070 @table @code
3071 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3072 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3073 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3074
3075 @item set breakpoint pending on
3076 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3077 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3078
3079 @item set breakpoint pending off
3080 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3081 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3082 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3083
3084 @item show breakpoint pending
3085 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3086 @end table
3087
3088 @cindex operations allowed on pending breakpoints
3089 Normal breakpoint operations apply to pending breakpoints as well. You may
3090 specify a condition for a pending breakpoint and/or commands to run when the
3091 breakpoint is reached. You can also enable or disable
3092 the pending breakpoint. When you specify a condition for a pending breakpoint,
3093 the parsing of the condition will be deferred until the point where the
3094 pending breakpoint location is resolved. Disabling a pending breakpoint
3095 tells @value{GDBN} to not attempt to resolve the breakpoint on any subsequent
3096 shared library load. When a pending breakpoint is re-enabled,
3097 @value{GDBN} checks to see if the location is already resolved.
3098 This is done because any number of shared library loads could have
3099 occurred since the time the breakpoint was disabled and one or more
3100 of these loads could resolve the location.
3101
3102 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3103 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3104 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3105 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3106 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3107 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3108 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3109 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3110
3111
3112 @node Set Watchpoints
3113 @subsection Setting watchpoints
3114
3115 @cindex setting watchpoints
3116 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3117 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3118 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3119 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3120 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3121
3122 @itemize @bullet
3123 @item
3124 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3125
3126 @item
3127 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3128 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3129 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3130
3131 @item
3132 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3133 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3134 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3135 @end itemize
3136
3137 @cindex software watchpoints
3138 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3139 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3140 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3141 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3142 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3143 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3144 culprit.)
3145
3146 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3147 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3148 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3149
3150 @table @code
3151 @kindex watch
3152 @item watch @var{expr}
3153 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3154 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3155 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3156 to watch the value of a single variable:
3157
3158 @smallexample
3159 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3160 @end smallexample
3161
3162 @kindex rwatch
3163 @item rwatch @var{expr}
3164 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3165 by the program.
3166
3167 @kindex awatch
3168 @item awatch @var{expr}
3169 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3170 or written into by the program.
3171
3172 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3173 @item info watchpoints
3174 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3175 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3176 @end table
3177
3178 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3179 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3180 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3181 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3182 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3183 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3184
3185 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3186 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3187 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3188 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3189 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3190 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3191 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3192 mechanism of watching expressiion values.)
3193
3194 @table @code
3195 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3196 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3197 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3198
3199 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3200 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3201 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3202 @end table
3203
3204 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3205 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3206 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3207
3208 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3209
3210 @smallexample
3211 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3212 @end smallexample
3213
3214 @noindent
3215 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3216
3217 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3218 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3219 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3220 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3221 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3222 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3223 will print a message like this:
3224
3225 @smallexample
3226 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3227 @end smallexample
3228
3229 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3230 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3231 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3232 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3233 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3234 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3235 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3236 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3237
3238 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3239 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3240 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3241 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3242 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3243 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3244
3245 @smallexample
3246 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3247 @end smallexample
3248
3249 @noindent
3250 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3251
3252 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3253 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3254 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3255 expression with separately allocated resources.
3256
3257 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
3258 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
3259 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
3260 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
3261 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
3262 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
3263 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
3264 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
3265 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
3266 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
3267
3268 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3269 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3270 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3271
3272 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3273 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3274 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3275 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3276 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3277 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3278 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3279 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3280 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3281
3282 @quotation
3283 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3284 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3285 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
3286 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
3287 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
3288 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
3289 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
3290 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
3291 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
3292 the expression.
3293
3294 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
3295 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
3296 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3297 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3298 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3299 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3300 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3301 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3302 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3303 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3304 @end quotation
3305
3306 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3307
3308 @node Set Catchpoints
3309 @subsection Setting catchpoints
3310 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3311 @cindex exception handlers
3312 @cindex event handling
3313
3314 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3315 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3316 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3317
3318 @table @code
3319 @kindex catch
3320 @item catch @var{event}
3321 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3322 @table @code
3323 @item throw
3324 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3325 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3326
3327 @item catch
3328 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3329
3330 @item exec
3331 @cindex break on fork/exec
3332 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3333
3334 @item fork
3335 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3336
3337 @item vfork
3338 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3339
3340 @item load
3341 @itemx load @var{libname}
3342 @cindex break on load/unload of shared library
3343 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
3344 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3345
3346 @item unload
3347 @itemx unload @var{libname}
3348 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
3349 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
3350 @end table
3351
3352 @item tcatch @var{event}
3353 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3354 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3355
3356 @end table
3357
3358 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3359
3360 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3361 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3362
3363 @itemize @bullet
3364 @item
3365 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3366 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3367 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3368 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3369 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3370 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3371 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3372 disabled within interactive calls.
3373
3374 @item
3375 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3376
3377 @item
3378 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3379 @end itemize
3380
3381 @cindex raise exceptions
3382 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3383 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3384 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3385 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3386 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3387 out where the exception was raised.
3388
3389 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3390 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3391 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3392 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3393
3394 @smallexample
3395 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3396 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3397 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3398 @end smallexample
3399
3400 @noindent
3401 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3402 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3403 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
3404
3405 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
3406 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3407 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3408 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3409 raised.
3410
3411
3412 @node Delete Breaks
3413 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
3414
3415 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3416 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3417 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3418 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3419 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3420 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3421
3422 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3423 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3424 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3425 their breakpoint numbers.
3426
3427 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3428 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3429 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3430
3431 @table @code
3432 @kindex clear
3433 @item clear
3434 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3435 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
3436 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3437 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3438
3439 @item clear @var{function}
3440 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3441 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3442
3443 @item clear @var{linenum}
3444 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3445 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3446 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3447
3448 @cindex delete breakpoints
3449 @kindex delete
3450 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3451 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3452 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3453 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3454 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3455 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3456 @end table
3457
3458 @node Disabling
3459 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
3460
3461 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3462 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3463 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3464 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3465 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3466
3467 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3468 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3469 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3470 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3471 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3472
3473 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3474 states of enablement:
3475
3476 @itemize @bullet
3477 @item
3478 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3479 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3480 @item
3481 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3482 @item
3483 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3484 disabled.
3485 @item
3486 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3487 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3488 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3489 @end itemize
3490
3491 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3492 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3493
3494 @table @code
3495 @kindex disable
3496 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3497 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3498 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3499 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3500 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3501 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3502 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3503
3504 @kindex enable
3505 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3506 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3507 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3508
3509 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3510 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3511 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3512
3513 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3514 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3515 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3516 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3517 @end table
3518
3519 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3520 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3521 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3522 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3523 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3524 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3525 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3526 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3527 stepping}.)
3528
3529 @node Conditions
3530 @subsection Break conditions
3531 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3532 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3533
3534 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3535 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3536 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3537 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3538 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3539 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3540 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3541 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3542
3543 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3544 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3545 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3546 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3547 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3548
3549 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3550 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3551 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3552 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3553 one.
3554
3555 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3556 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3557 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3558 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3559 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3560 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3561 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3562 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3563 conditions for the
3564 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3565 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3566
3567 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3568 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3569 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3570 with the @code{condition} command.
3571
3572 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3573 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3574 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3575 catchpoint.
3576
3577 @table @code
3578 @kindex condition
3579 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3580 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3581 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3582 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3583 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3584 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3585 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3586 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3587 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3588 prints an error message:
3589
3590 @smallexample
3591 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3592 @end smallexample
3593
3594 @noindent
3595 @value{GDBN} does
3596 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3597 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3598 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3599
3600 @item condition @var{bnum}
3601 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3602 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3603 @end table
3604
3605 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3606 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3607 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3608 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3609 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3610 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3611 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3612 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3613 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3614 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3615 your program reaches it.
3616
3617 @table @code
3618 @kindex ignore
3619 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3620 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3621 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3622 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3623 takes no action.
3624
3625 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3626 a count of zero.
3627
3628 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3629 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3630 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3631 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3632
3633 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3634 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3635 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3636
3637 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3638 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3639 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3640 variables}.
3641 @end table
3642
3643 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3644
3645
3646 @node Break Commands
3647 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3648
3649 @cindex breakpoint commands
3650 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3651 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3652 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3653 enable other breakpoints.
3654
3655 @table @code
3656 @kindex commands
3657 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3658 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3659 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3660 @itemx end
3661 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3662 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3663 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3664
3665 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3666 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3667
3668 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3669 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3670 recently encountered).
3671 @end table
3672
3673 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3674 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3675
3676 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3677 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3678 that resumes execution.
3679
3680 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3681 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3682 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3683 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3684 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3685
3686 @kindex silent
3687 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3688 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3689 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3690 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3691 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3692 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3693
3694 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3695 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3696 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3697
3698 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3699 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3700
3701 @smallexample
3702 break foo if x>0
3703 commands
3704 silent
3705 printf "x is %d\n",x
3706 cont
3707 end
3708 @end smallexample
3709
3710 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3711 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3712 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3713 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3714 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3715 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3716 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3717
3718 @smallexample
3719 break 403
3720 commands
3721 silent
3722 set x = y + 4
3723 cont
3724 end
3725 @end smallexample
3726
3727 @node Breakpoint Menus
3728 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3729 @cindex overloading
3730 @cindex symbol overloading
3731
3732 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3733 single function name
3734 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3735 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3736 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3737 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3738 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3739 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3740 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3741 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3742 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3743 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3744 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3745 breakpoints.
3746
3747 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3748 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3749 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3750
3751 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3752 @smallexample
3753 @group
3754 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3755 [0] cancel
3756 [1] all
3757 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3758 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3759 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3760 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3761 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3762 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3763 > 2 4 6
3764 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3765 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3766 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3767 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3768 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3769 breakpoints.
3770 (@value{GDBP})
3771 @end group
3772 @end smallexample
3773
3774 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3775 @node Error in Breakpoints
3776 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3777 @c
3778 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3779 @c
3780 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3781 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3782 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3783 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3784
3785 @smallexample
3786 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3787 The same program may be running in another process.
3788 @end smallexample
3789
3790 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3791
3792 @enumerate
3793 @item
3794 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3795
3796 @item
3797 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3798 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3799 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3800 Then start your program again.
3801
3802 @item
3803 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3804 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3805 to nonsharable executables.
3806 @end enumerate
3807 @c @end ifclear
3808
3809 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3810 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3811
3812 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3813 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3814 @smallexample
3815 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3816 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3817 @end smallexample
3818
3819 @noindent
3820 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3821 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3822 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3823
3824 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3825 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3826
3827 @node Breakpoint related warnings
3828 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3829 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
3830
3831 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
3832 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
3833 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
3834 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
3835
3836 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
3837 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
3838 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
3839 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
3840 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
3841 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
3842 first in the bundle.
3843
3844 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
3845 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
3846 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
3847 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
3848 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
3849 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
3850 is hit.
3851
3852 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
3853 that's been subject to address adjustment:
3854
3855 @smallexample
3856 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
3857 @end smallexample
3858
3859 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
3860 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
3861 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
3862 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
3863 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
3864 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
3865 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
3866 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
3867
3868 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
3869 adjusted breakpoints:
3870
3871 @smallexample
3872 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
3873 to 0x00010410.
3874 @end smallexample
3875
3876 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
3877 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
3878 frequently than expected.
3879
3880 @node Continuing and Stepping
3881 @section Continuing and stepping
3882
3883 @cindex stepping
3884 @cindex continuing
3885 @cindex resuming execution
3886 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3887 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3888 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3889 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3890 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3891 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3892 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3893 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3894
3895 @table @code
3896 @kindex continue
3897 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3898 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3899 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3900 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3901 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3902 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3903 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3904 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3905 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3906 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3907
3908 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3909 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3910 @code{continue} is ignored.
3911
3912 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3913 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3914 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3915 @code{continue}.
3916 @end table
3917
3918 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3919 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3920 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3921 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3922
3923 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3924 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3925 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3926 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3927 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3928 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3929
3930 @table @code
3931 @kindex step
3932 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3933 @item step
3934 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3935 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3936 abbreviated @code{s}.
3937
3938 @quotation
3939 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3940 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3941 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3942 @c distinction here.
3943 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3944 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3945 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3946 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3947 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3948 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3949 below.
3950 @end quotation
3951
3952 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3953 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3954 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3955 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3956 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3957 called within the line.
3958
3959 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3960 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3961 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3962 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3963 was any debugging information about the routine.
3964
3965 @item step @var{count}
3966 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3967 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3968 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3969
3970 @kindex next
3971 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3972 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3973 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3974 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3975 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3976 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3977 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3978 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3979
3980 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3981
3982
3983 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3984 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3985 @c
3986 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3987 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3988 @c function are executed without stopping.
3989
3990 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3991 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3992 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3993
3994 @kindex set step-mode
3995 @item set step-mode
3996 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3997 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3998 @itemx set step-mode on
3999 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4000 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4001 information rather than stepping over it.
4002
4003 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4004 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4005 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4006
4007 @item set step-mode off
4008 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4009 debug information. This is the default.
4010
4011 @item show step-mode
4012 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4013 source line debug information.
4014
4015 @kindex finish
4016 @item finish
4017 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4018 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
4019
4020 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4021 ,Returning from a function}).
4022
4023 @kindex until
4024 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4025 @cindex run until specified location
4026 @item until
4027 @itemx u
4028 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4029 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4030 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4031 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4032 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4033 than the address of the jump.
4034
4035 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4036 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4037 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4038 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4039 through the next iteration.
4040
4041 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4042 stack frame.
4043
4044 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4045 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4046 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4047 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4048 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4049
4050 @smallexample
4051 (@value{GDBP}) f
4052 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4053 206 expand_input();
4054 (@value{GDBP}) until
4055 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4056 @end smallexample
4057
4058 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4059 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4060 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4061 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4062 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4063 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4064 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4065
4066 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4067 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4068 argument.
4069
4070 @item until @var{location}
4071 @itemx u @var{location}
4072 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4073 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4074 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4075 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
4076 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4077 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4078 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4079 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4080 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4081 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
4082 invocations have returned.
4083
4084 @smallexample
4085 94 int factorial (int value)
4086 95 @{
4087 96 if (value > 1) @{
4088 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4089 98 @}
4090 99 return (value);
4091 100 @}
4092 @end smallexample
4093
4094
4095 @kindex advance @var{location}
4096 @itemx advance @var{location}
4097 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4098 required, which should be of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
4099 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4100 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4101 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4102 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4103
4104
4105 @kindex stepi
4106 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4107 @item stepi
4108 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4109 @itemx si
4110 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4111
4112 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4113 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4114 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4115 Display,, Automatic display}.
4116
4117 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4118
4119 @need 750
4120 @kindex nexti
4121 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4122 @item nexti
4123 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4124 @itemx ni
4125 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4126 proceed until the function returns.
4127
4128 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4129 @end table
4130
4131 @node Signals
4132 @section Signals
4133 @cindex signals
4134
4135 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4136 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4137 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4138 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4139 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4140 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4141 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4142 requested an alarm).
4143
4144 @cindex fatal signals
4145 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4146 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4147 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4148 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4149 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4150 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4151
4152 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4153 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4154 signal.
4155
4156 @cindex handling signals
4157 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4158 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4159 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4160 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4161 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4162
4163 @table @code
4164 @kindex info signals
4165 @kindex info handle
4166 @item info signals
4167 @itemx info handle
4168 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4169 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4170 the defined types of signals.
4171
4172 @item info signals @var{sig}
4173 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4174
4175 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4176
4177 @kindex handle
4178 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4179 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4180 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4181 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4182 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4183 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4184 say what change to make.
4185 @end table
4186
4187 @c @group
4188 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4189 Their full names are:
4190
4191 @table @code
4192 @item nostop
4193 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4194 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4195
4196 @item stop
4197 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4198 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4199
4200 @item print
4201 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4202
4203 @item noprint
4204 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4205 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4206
4207 @item pass
4208 @itemx noignore
4209 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4210 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4211 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4212
4213 @item nopass
4214 @itemx ignore
4215 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4216 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4217 @end table
4218 @c @end group
4219
4220 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4221 program until you
4222 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4223 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4224 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4225 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4226 program sees that signal when you continue.
4227
4228 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4229 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4230 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4231 erroneous signals.
4232
4233 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4234 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4235 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4236 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4237 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4238 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4239 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4240 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4241 program a signal}.
4242
4243 @node Thread Stops
4244 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
4245
4246 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4247 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
4248 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4249
4250 @table @code
4251 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4252 @cindex thread breakpoints
4253 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4254 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4255 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4256 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4257 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4258
4259 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4260 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4261 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4262 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4263 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4264
4265 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4266 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4267 program.
4268
4269 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4270 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4271 breakpoint condition, like this:
4272
4273 @smallexample
4274 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4275 @end smallexample
4276
4277 @end table
4278
4279 @cindex stopped threads
4280 @cindex threads, stopped
4281 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4282 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4283 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4284 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4285 underfoot.
4286
4287 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4288 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4289 @cindex premature return from system calls
4290 There is an unfortunate side effect. If one thread stops for a
4291 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4292 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4293 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4294 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4295 stop execution.
4296
4297 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4298 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4299 style anyways.
4300
4301 For example, do not write code like this:
4302
4303 @smallexample
4304 sleep (10);
4305 @end smallexample
4306
4307 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4308 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4309
4310 Instead, write this:
4311
4312 @smallexample
4313 int unslept = 10;
4314 while (unslept > 0)
4315 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4316 @end smallexample
4317
4318 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4319 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4320 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4321 @value{GDBN}.
4322
4323 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4324 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4325 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4326 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4327
4328 @cindex continuing threads
4329 @cindex threads, continuing
4330 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4331 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4332 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4333
4334 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4335 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4336 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4337 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4338 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4339 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4340 stops.
4341
4342 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4343 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4344 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4345 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4346
4347 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
4348 thread to run.
4349
4350 @table @code
4351 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4352 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4353 @cindex lock scheduler
4354 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4355 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4356 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4357 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
4358 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
4359 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4360 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4361 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4362 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4363 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
4364 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
4365
4366 @item show scheduler-locking
4367 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4368 @end table
4369
4370
4371 @node Stack
4372 @chapter Examining the Stack
4373
4374 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
4375 stopped and how it got there.
4376
4377 @cindex call stack
4378 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
4379 is generated.
4380 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
4381 the arguments of the call,
4382 and the local variables of the function being called.
4383 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
4384 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
4385 stack}.
4386
4387 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
4388 stack allow you to see all of this information.
4389
4390 @cindex selected frame
4391 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
4392 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
4393 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
4394 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
4395 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
4396 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4397
4398 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
4399 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
4400 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
4401
4402 @menu
4403 * Frames:: Stack frames
4404 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
4405 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
4406 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
4407
4408 @end menu
4409
4410 @node Frames
4411 @section Stack frames
4412
4413 @cindex frame, definition
4414 @cindex stack frame
4415 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
4416 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
4417 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
4418 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
4419 which the function is executing.
4420
4421 @cindex initial frame
4422 @cindex outermost frame
4423 @cindex innermost frame
4424 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
4425 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
4426 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
4427 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
4428 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
4429 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
4430 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
4431 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
4432
4433 @cindex frame pointer
4434 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
4435 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
4436 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
4437 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
4438 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
4439 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
4440
4441 @cindex frame number
4442 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
4443 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
4444 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
4445 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
4446 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
4447
4448 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
4449 @c underflow problems.
4450 @cindex frameless execution
4451 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
4452 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
4453 @smallexample
4454 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
4455 @end smallexample
4456 generates functions without a frame.)
4457 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
4458 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
4459 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
4460 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
4461 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
4462 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
4463 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
4464
4465 @table @code
4466 @kindex frame@r{, command}
4467 @cindex current stack frame
4468 @item frame @var{args}
4469 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
4470 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
4471 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
4472 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
4473
4474 @kindex select-frame
4475 @cindex selecting frame silently
4476 @item select-frame
4477 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
4478 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
4479 @code{frame}.
4480 @end table
4481
4482 @node Backtrace
4483 @section Backtraces
4484
4485 @cindex traceback
4486 @cindex call stack traces
4487 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
4488 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
4489 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
4490 stack.
4491
4492 @table @code
4493 @kindex backtrace
4494 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
4495 @item backtrace
4496 @itemx bt
4497 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
4498 frames in the stack.
4499
4500 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
4501 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
4502
4503 @item backtrace @var{n}
4504 @itemx bt @var{n}
4505 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
4506
4507 @item backtrace -@var{n}
4508 @itemx bt -@var{n}
4509 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
4510
4511 @item backtrace full
4512 @itemx bt full
4513 @itemx bt full @var{n}
4514 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
4515 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
4516 number of frames to print, as described above.
4517 @end table
4518
4519 @kindex where
4520 @kindex info stack
4521 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
4522 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
4523
4524 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
4525 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
4526 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
4527 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
4528 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
4529 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
4530 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
4531 multi-threaded program.
4532
4533 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
4534 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
4535 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
4536 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
4537 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
4538 line number.
4539
4540 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
4541 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
4542
4543 @smallexample
4544 @group
4545 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4546 at builtin.c:993
4547 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
4548 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
4549 at macro.c:71
4550 (More stack frames follow...)
4551 @end group
4552 @end smallexample
4553
4554 @noindent
4555 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
4556 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
4557 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
4558
4559 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
4560 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
4561 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
4562 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
4563 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
4564 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
4565 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
4566 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
4567 such a backtrace might look like:
4568
4569 @smallexample
4570 @group
4571 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
4572 at builtin.c:993
4573 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
4574 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
4575 at macro.c:71
4576 (More stack frames follow...)
4577 @end group
4578 @end smallexample
4579
4580 @noindent
4581 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
4582 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
4583
4584 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
4585 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
4586 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
4587
4588 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
4589 @cindex program entry point
4590 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
4591 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
4592 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
4593 @code{main}@footnote{
4594 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
4595 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
4596 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
4597 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
4598 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
4599 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
4600
4601 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
4602 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
4603
4604 @table @code
4605 @item set backtrace past-main
4606 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
4607 @kindex set backtrace
4608 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
4609
4610 @item set backtrace past-main off
4611 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
4612 default.
4613
4614 @item show backtrace past-main
4615 @kindex show backtrace
4616 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
4617
4618 @item set backtrace past-entry
4619 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
4620 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
4621 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
4622 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
4623
4624 @item set backtrace past-entry off
4625 Backtraces will stop when they encouter the internal entry point of an
4626 application. This is the default.
4627
4628 @item show backtrace past-entry
4629 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
4630
4631 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
4632 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
4633 @cindex backtrace limit
4634 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
4635 unlimited.
4636
4637 @item show backtrace limit
4638 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
4639 @end table
4640
4641 @node Selection
4642 @section Selecting a frame
4643
4644 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
4645 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
4646 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
4647 of the stack frame just selected.
4648
4649 @table @code
4650 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
4651 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
4652 @item frame @var{n}
4653 @itemx f @var{n}
4654 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
4655 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
4656 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
4657 @code{main}.
4658
4659 @item frame @var{addr}
4660 @itemx f @var{addr}
4661 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
4662 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
4663 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
4664 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
4665 switches between them.
4666
4667 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
4668 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
4669
4670 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
4671 pointer and a program counter.
4672
4673 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
4674 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
4675
4676 @kindex up
4677 @item up @var{n}
4678 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4679 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
4680 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
4681
4682 @kindex down
4683 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
4684 @item down @var{n}
4685 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
4686 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
4687 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
4688 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
4689 @end table
4690
4691 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4692 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4693 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4694 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4695
4696 @need 1000
4697 For example:
4698
4699 @smallexample
4700 @group
4701 (@value{GDBP}) up
4702 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4703 at env.c:10
4704 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4705 @end group
4706 @end smallexample
4707
4708 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4709 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4710 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4711 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4712 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4713 for details.
4714
4715 @table @code
4716 @kindex down-silently
4717 @kindex up-silently
4718 @item up-silently @var{n}
4719 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4720 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4721 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4722 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4723 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4724 distracting.
4725 @end table
4726
4727 @node Frame Info
4728 @section Information about a frame
4729
4730 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4731 stack frame.
4732
4733 @table @code
4734 @item frame
4735 @itemx f
4736 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4737 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4738 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4739 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4740 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4741
4742 @kindex info frame
4743 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4744 @item info frame
4745 @itemx info f
4746 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4747 including:
4748
4749 @itemize @bullet
4750 @item
4751 the address of the frame
4752 @item
4753 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4754 @item
4755 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4756 @item
4757 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4758 @item
4759 the address of the frame's arguments
4760 @item
4761 the address of the frame's local variables
4762 @item
4763 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4764 @item
4765 which registers were saved in the frame
4766 @end itemize
4767
4768 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4769 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4770 the usual conventions.
4771
4772 @item info frame @var{addr}
4773 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4774 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4775 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4776 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4777 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4778 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4779
4780 @kindex info args
4781 @item info args
4782 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4783
4784 @item info locals
4785 @kindex info locals
4786 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4787 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4788 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4789
4790 @kindex info catch
4791 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4792 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4793 @item info catch
4794 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4795 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4796 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4797 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4798 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4799
4800 @end table
4801
4802
4803 @node Source
4804 @chapter Examining Source Files
4805
4806 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4807 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4808 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4809 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4810 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4811 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4812 source files by explicit command.
4813
4814 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4815 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4816 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4817
4818 @menu
4819 * List:: Printing source lines
4820 * Edit:: Editing source files
4821 * Search:: Searching source files
4822 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4823 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4824 @end menu
4825
4826 @node List
4827 @section Printing source lines
4828
4829 @kindex list
4830 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4831 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4832 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4833 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4834
4835 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4836
4837 @table @code
4838 @item list @var{linenum}
4839 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4840 current source file.
4841
4842 @item list @var{function}
4843 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4844 @var{function}.
4845
4846 @item list
4847 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4848 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4849 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4850 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4851 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4852
4853 @item list -
4854 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4855 @end table
4856
4857 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
4858 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4859 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4860
4861 @table @code
4862 @kindex set listsize
4863 @item set listsize @var{count}
4864 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4865 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4866
4867 @kindex show listsize
4868 @item show listsize
4869 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4870 @end table
4871
4872 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4873 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4874 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4875 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4876 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4877
4878 @cindex linespec
4879 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4880 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4881 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4882 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4883
4884 @table @code
4885 @item list @var{linespec}
4886 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4887
4888 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4889 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4890 linespecs.
4891
4892 @item list ,@var{last}
4893 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4894
4895 @item list @var{first},
4896 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4897
4898 @item list +
4899 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4900
4901 @item list -
4902 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4903
4904 @item list
4905 As described in the preceding table.
4906 @end table
4907
4908 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4909 kinds of linespec.
4910
4911 @table @code
4912 @item @var{number}
4913 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4914 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4915 the same source file as the first linespec.
4916
4917 @item +@var{offset}
4918 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4919 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4920 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4921 first linespec.
4922
4923 @item -@var{offset}
4924 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4925
4926 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4927 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4928
4929 @item @var{function}
4930 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4931 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4932
4933 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4934 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4935 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4936 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4937 identically named functions in different source files.
4938
4939 @item *@var{address}
4940 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4941 @var{address} may be any expression.
4942 @end table
4943
4944 @node Edit
4945 @section Editing source files
4946 @cindex editing source files
4947
4948 @kindex edit
4949 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4950 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4951 The editing program of your choice
4952 is invoked with the current line set to
4953 the active line in the program.
4954 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4955 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4956
4957 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4958
4959 @table @code
4960 @item edit
4961 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4962
4963 @item edit @var{number}
4964 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4965
4966 @item edit @var{function}
4967 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4968
4969 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4970 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4971
4972 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4973 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4974 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4975 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4976 identically named functions in different source files.
4977
4978 @item edit *@var{address}
4979 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4980 @var{address} may be any expression.
4981 @end table
4982
4983 @subsection Choosing your editor
4984 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4985 @footnote{
4986 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4987 following command-line syntax:
4988 @smallexample
4989 ex +@var{number} file
4990 @end smallexample
4991 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
4992 the file where to start editing.}.
4993 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
4994 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4995 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4996 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4997 @smallexample
4998 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4999 export EDITOR
5000 gdb @dots{}
5001 @end smallexample
5002 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5003 @smallexample
5004 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5005 gdb @dots{}
5006 @end smallexample
5007
5008 @node Search
5009 @section Searching source files
5010 @cindex searching source files
5011
5012 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5013 regular expression.
5014
5015 @table @code
5016 @kindex search
5017 @kindex forward-search
5018 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5019 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5020 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5021 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5022 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5023 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5024 @code{fo}.
5025
5026 @kindex reverse-search
5027 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5028 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5029 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5030 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5031 this command as @code{rev}.
5032 @end table
5033
5034 @node Source Path
5035 @section Specifying source directories
5036
5037 @cindex source path
5038 @cindex directories for source files
5039 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5040 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5041 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5042 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5043 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5044 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5045 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5046
5047 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5048 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5049 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5050 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5051 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5052 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5053 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5054 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5055 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5056 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5057 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5058
5059 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5060 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5061 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5062 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5063 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5064 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5065
5066 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5067 source files.
5068
5069 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5070 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5071 each line is in the file.
5072
5073 @kindex directory
5074 @kindex dir
5075 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5076 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5077 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5078
5079 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5080 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5081
5082 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5083 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5084 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5085 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5086 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5087 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5088 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5089 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5090 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5091 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5092 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5093 name to look up the sources.
5094
5095 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5096 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5097 GDB to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5098 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5099 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5100 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5101 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5102 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5103
5104 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5105 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5106 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5107 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5108 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5109 is applied only at the begining of the directory name, this rule will
5110 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5111
5112 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5113 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5114 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5115 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5116 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5117 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5118 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5119 command.
5120
5121 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5122 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5123 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5124 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5125 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5126 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5127 method available to point GDB at the new location.
5128
5129 @table @code
5130 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5131 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5132 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5133 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5134 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5135 part of absolute file names) or
5136 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5137 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5138
5139 @kindex cdir
5140 @kindex cwd
5141 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5142 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
5143 @cindex compilation directory
5144 @cindex current directory
5145 @cindex working directory
5146 @cindex directory, current
5147 @cindex directory, compilation
5148 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5149 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5150 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5151 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5152 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5153 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5154
5155 @item directory
5156 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5157
5158 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5159 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5160
5161 @item show directories
5162 @kindex show directories
5163 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5164
5165 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5166 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5167 @kindex set substitute-path
5168 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5169 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5170 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5171
5172 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5173 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5174
5175 @smallexample
5176 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5177 @end smallexample
5178
5179 @noindent
5180 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5181 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5182 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5183
5184 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5185 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5186 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5187 the substitution.
5188
5189 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5190
5191 @smallexample
5192 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5193 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5194 @end smallexample
5195
5196 @noindent
5197 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5198 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5199 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5200 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5201
5202
5203 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5204 @kindex unset substitute-path
5205 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5206 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5207 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5208
5209 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5210
5211 @item show substitute-path [path]
5212 @kindex show substitute-path
5213 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5214 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5215
5216 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5217 rules.
5218
5219 @end table
5220
5221 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5222 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5223 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5224
5225 @enumerate
5226 @item
5227 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5228
5229 @item
5230 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5231 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5232 directories in one command.
5233 @end enumerate
5234
5235 @node Machine Code
5236 @section Source and machine code
5237 @cindex source line and its code address
5238
5239 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5240 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5241 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5242 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5243 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5244 well as hex.
5245
5246 @table @code
5247 @kindex info line
5248 @item info line @var{linespec}
5249 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5250 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5251 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
5252 source lines}).
5253 @end table
5254
5255 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5256 the object code for the first line of function
5257 @code{m4_changequote}:
5258
5259 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5260 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5261 @smallexample
5262 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5263 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5264 @end smallexample
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 @cindex code address and its source line
5268 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5269 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5270 @smallexample
5271 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5272 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5273 @end smallexample
5274
5275 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5276 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5277 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5278 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5279 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5280 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5281 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5282 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5283 variables}).
5284
5285 @table @code
5286 @kindex disassemble
5287 @cindex assembly instructions
5288 @cindex instructions, assembly
5289 @cindex machine instructions
5290 @cindex listing machine instructions
5291 @item disassemble
5292 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5293 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5294 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5295 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5296 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5297 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5298 @end table
5299
5300 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5301 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5302
5303 @smallexample
5304 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5305 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5306 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5307 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5308 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5309 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5310 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5311 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5312 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5313 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5314 End of assembler dump.
5315 @end smallexample
5316
5317 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
5318 mnemonics or other syntax.
5319
5320 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
5321 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
5322 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
5323 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
5324 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
5325
5326 @table @code
5327 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
5328 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
5329 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
5330 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
5331 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
5332 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
5333
5334 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
5335 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
5336 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
5337 assemblers for x86-based targets.
5338
5339 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
5340 @item show disassembly-flavor
5341 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
5342 @end table
5343
5344
5345 @node Data
5346 @chapter Examining Data
5347
5348 @cindex printing data
5349 @cindex examining data
5350 @kindex print
5351 @kindex inspect
5352 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
5353 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
5354 @c different window or something like that.
5355 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
5356 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
5357 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
5358 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
5359 Different Languages}).
5360
5361 @table @code
5362 @item print @var{expr}
5363 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
5364 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
5365 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
5366 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
5367 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
5368 formats}.
5369
5370 @item print
5371 @itemx print /@var{f}
5372 @cindex reprint the last value
5373 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
5374 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
5375 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
5376 @end table
5377
5378 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
5379 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
5380 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5381
5382 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
5383 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
5384 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
5385 Table}.
5386
5387 @menu
5388 * Expressions:: Expressions
5389 * Variables:: Program variables
5390 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
5391 * Output Formats:: Output formats
5392 * Memory:: Examining memory
5393 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
5394 * Print Settings:: Print settings
5395 * Value History:: Value history
5396 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
5397 * Registers:: Registers
5398 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
5399 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
5400 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
5401 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
5402 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
5403 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
5404 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
5405 character set than GDB does
5406 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
5407 @end menu
5408
5409 @node Expressions
5410 @section Expressions
5411
5412 @cindex expressions
5413 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
5414 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
5415 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
5416 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
5417 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
5418 you compiled your program to include this information; see
5419 @ref{Compilation}.
5420
5421 @cindex arrays in expressions
5422 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
5423 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5424 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
5425 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
5426
5427 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
5428 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
5429 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
5430 languages.
5431
5432 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
5433 expressions regardless of your programming language.
5434
5435 @cindex casts, in expressions
5436 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
5437 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
5438 at that address in memory.
5439 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
5440
5441 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
5442 to programming languages:
5443
5444 @table @code
5445 @item @@
5446 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
5447 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
5448
5449 @item ::
5450 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
5451 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
5452
5453 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
5454 @cindex type casting memory
5455 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
5456 @cindex casts, to view memory
5457 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
5458 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
5459 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
5460 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
5461 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
5462 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
5463 @end table
5464
5465 @node Variables
5466 @section Program variables
5467
5468 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
5469 in your program.
5470
5471 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
5472 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
5473
5474 @itemize @bullet
5475 @item
5476 global (or file-static)
5477 @end itemize
5478
5479 @noindent or
5480
5481 @itemize @bullet
5482 @item
5483 visible according to the scope rules of the
5484 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5485 @end itemize
5486
5487 @noindent This means that in the function
5488
5489 @smallexample
5490 foo (a)
5491 int a;
5492 @{
5493 bar (a);
5494 @{
5495 int b = test ();
5496 bar (b);
5497 @}
5498 @}
5499 @end smallexample
5500
5501 @noindent
5502 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
5503 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
5504 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
5505 the block where @code{b} is declared.
5506
5507 @cindex variable name conflict
5508 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
5509 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
5510 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
5511 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
5512 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
5513 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
5514 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
5515
5516 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
5517 @iftex
5518 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
5519 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
5520 @end iftex
5521 @smallexample
5522 @var{file}::@var{variable}
5523 @var{function}::@var{variable}
5524 @end smallexample
5525
5526 @noindent
5527 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
5528 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
5529 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
5530 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
5531
5532 @smallexample
5533 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
5534 @end smallexample
5535
5536 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
5537 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
5538 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
5539 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
5540 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
5541 @c conflict?? --mew
5542
5543 @cindex wrong values
5544 @cindex variable values, wrong
5545 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
5546 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
5547 @quotation
5548 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
5549 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
5550 scope, and just before exit.
5551 @end quotation
5552 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
5553 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
5554 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
5555 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
5556 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
5557 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
5558 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
5559 variable definitions may be gone.
5560
5561 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
5562 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
5563 when compiling.
5564
5565 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
5566 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
5567 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
5568 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
5569 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
5570 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
5571 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
5572
5573 @smallexample
5574 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5575 @end smallexample
5576
5577 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
5578 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
5579 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
5580 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
5581 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
5582 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
5583 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
5584 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
5585 @xref{C, , Debugging C++}, for more info about debug info formats
5586 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
5587
5588 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
5589 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
5590 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
5591 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
5592
5593 @node Arrays
5594 @section Artificial arrays
5595
5596 @cindex artificial array
5597 @cindex arrays
5598 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
5599 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
5600 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
5601 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
5602 program.
5603
5604 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
5605 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
5606 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
5607 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
5608 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
5609 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
5610 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
5611 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
5612 example. If a program says
5613
5614 @smallexample
5615 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
5616 @end smallexample
5617
5618 @noindent
5619 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
5620
5621 @smallexample
5622 p *array@@len
5623 @end smallexample
5624
5625 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
5626 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
5627 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
5628 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
5629 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
5630
5631 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
5632 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
5633 The value need not be in memory:
5634 @smallexample
5635 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
5636 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5637 @end smallexample
5638
5639 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
5640 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
5641 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
5642 @smallexample
5643 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
5644 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
5645 @end smallexample
5646
5647 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
5648 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
5649 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
5650 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
5651 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5652 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
5653 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
5654 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
5655 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
5656 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
5657
5658 @smallexample
5659 set $i = 0
5660 p dtab[$i++]->fv
5661 @key{RET}
5662 @key{RET}
5663 @dots{}
5664 @end smallexample
5665
5666 @node Output Formats
5667 @section Output formats
5668
5669 @cindex formatted output
5670 @cindex output formats
5671 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
5672 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
5673 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
5674 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
5675 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
5676
5677 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
5678 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
5679 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
5680 letters supported are:
5681
5682 @table @code
5683 @item x
5684 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
5685 hexadecimal.
5686
5687 @item d
5688 Print as integer in signed decimal.
5689
5690 @item u
5691 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
5692
5693 @item o
5694 Print as integer in octal.
5695
5696 @item t
5697 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
5698 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
5699 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
5700 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
5701
5702 @item a
5703 @cindex unknown address, locating
5704 @cindex locate address
5705 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
5706 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
5707 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
5708
5709 @smallexample
5710 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
5711 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
5712 @end smallexample
5713
5714 @noindent
5715 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
5716 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
5717
5718 @item c
5719 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
5720 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
5721 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
5722 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
5723
5724 @item f
5725 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
5726 using typical floating point syntax.
5727 @end table
5728
5729 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
5730
5731 @smallexample
5732 p/x $pc
5733 @end smallexample
5734
5735 @noindent
5736 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
5737 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
5738
5739 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
5740 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
5741 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
5742
5743 @node Memory
5744 @section Examining memory
5745
5746 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
5747 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
5748
5749 @cindex examining memory
5750 @table @code
5751 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
5752 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
5753 @itemx x @var{addr}
5754 @itemx x
5755 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
5756 @end table
5757
5758 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
5759 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
5760 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
5761 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
5762 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
5763
5764 @table @r
5765 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
5766 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
5767 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
5768 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
5769 @c 4.1.2.
5770
5771 @item @var{f}, the display format
5772 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
5773 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
5774 @samp{f}), and in addition @samp{s} (for null-terminated strings) and
5775 @samp{i} (for machine instructions). The default is @samp{x}
5776 (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes each time you use either
5777 @code{x} or @code{print}.
5778
5779 @item @var{u}, the unit size
5780 The unit size is any of
5781
5782 @table @code
5783 @item b
5784 Bytes.
5785 @item h
5786 Halfwords (two bytes).
5787 @item w
5788 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
5789 @item g
5790 Giant words (eight bytes).
5791 @end table
5792
5793 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
5794 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
5795 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
5796
5797 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
5798 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
5799 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
5800 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
5801 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
5802 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
5803 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
5804 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
5805 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
5806 a value from memory).
5807 @end table
5808
5809 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
5810 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
5811 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
5812 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
5813 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
5814
5815 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
5816 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
5817 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
5818 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
5819 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
5820
5821 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
5822 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
5823 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
5824 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
5825 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
5826 Code,,Source and machine code}.
5827
5828 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
5829 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
5830 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
5831 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
5832 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
5833 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
5834 for successive uses of @code{x}.
5835
5836 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
5837 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
5838 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5839 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5840 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5841 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5842 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5843 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5844 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5845
5846 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5847 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5848 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5849
5850 @cindex remote memory comparison
5851 @cindex verify remote memory image
5852 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
5853 (@pxref{Remote}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
5854 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
5855 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
5856 situations.
5857
5858 @table @code
5859 @kindex compare-sections
5860 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
5861 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
5862 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
5863 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
5864 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
5865 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
5866 remote request.
5867 @end table
5868
5869 @node Auto Display
5870 @section Automatic display
5871 @cindex automatic display
5872 @cindex display of expressions
5873
5874 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5875 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5876 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5877 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5878 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5879 The automatic display looks like this:
5880
5881 @smallexample
5882 2: foo = 38
5883 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5884 @end smallexample
5885
5886 @noindent
5887 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5888 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5889 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5890 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5891 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5892 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5893 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5894
5895 @table @code
5896 @kindex display
5897 @item display @var{expr}
5898 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5899 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5900
5901 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5902
5903 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5904 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5905 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5906 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5907 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5908
5909 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5910 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5911 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5912 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5913 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5914 @end table
5915
5916 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5917 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5918 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5919
5920 @table @code
5921 @kindex delete display
5922 @kindex undisplay
5923 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5924 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5925 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5926
5927 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5928 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5929
5930 @kindex disable display
5931 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5932 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5933 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5934 enabled again later.
5935
5936 @kindex enable display
5937 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5938 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5939 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5940
5941 @item display
5942 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5943 done when your program stops.
5944
5945 @kindex info display
5946 @item info display
5947 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5948 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5949 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5950 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5951 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5952 @end table
5953
5954 @cindex display disabled out of scope
5955 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5956 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5957 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5958 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5959 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5960 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5961 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5962 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5963 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5964 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5965
5966 @node Print Settings
5967 @section Print settings
5968
5969 @cindex format options
5970 @cindex print settings
5971 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5972 and symbols are printed.
5973
5974 @noindent
5975 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5976
5977 @table @code
5978 @kindex set print
5979 @item set print address
5980 @itemx set print address on
5981 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
5982 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5983 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5984 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5985 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5986 @code{set print address on}:
5987
5988 @smallexample
5989 @group
5990 (@value{GDBP}) f
5991 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5992 at input.c:530
5993 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5994 @end group
5995 @end smallexample
5996
5997 @item set print address off
5998 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5999 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6000
6001 @smallexample
6002 @group
6003 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6004 (@value{GDBP}) f
6005 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6006 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6007 @end group
6008 @end smallexample
6009
6010 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6011 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6012 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6013 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6014
6015 @kindex show print
6016 @item show print address
6017 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6018 @end table
6019
6020 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6021 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6022 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6023 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6024 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6025 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6026 it prints a symbolic address:
6027
6028 @table @code
6029 @item set print symbol-filename on
6030 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6031 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6032 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6033 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6034
6035 @item set print symbol-filename off
6036 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6037 default.
6038
6039 @item show print symbol-filename
6040 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6041 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6042 @end table
6043
6044 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6045 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6046 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6047
6048 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6049 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6050
6051 @table @code
6052 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6053 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6054 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6055 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6056 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6057 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6058
6059 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6060 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6061 symbolic address.
6062 @end table
6063
6064 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6065 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6066 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6067 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6068 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6069 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6070 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6071 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6072
6073 @smallexample
6074 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6075 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6076 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6077 @end smallexample
6078
6079 @quotation
6080 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6081 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6082 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6083 @end quotation
6084
6085 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6086
6087 @table @code
6088 @item set print array
6089 @itemx set print array on
6090 @cindex pretty print arrays
6091 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6092 but uses more space. The default is off.
6093
6094 @item set print array off
6095 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6096
6097 @item show print array
6098 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6099 arrays.
6100
6101 @cindex print array indexes
6102 @item set print array-indexes
6103 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6104 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6105 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6106 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6107
6108 @item set print array-indexes off
6109 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6110
6111 @item show print array-indexes
6112 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6113 arrays.
6114
6115 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6116 @cindex number of array elements to print
6117 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6118 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6119 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6120 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6121 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6122 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6123 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6124
6125 @item show print elements
6126 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6127 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6128
6129 @item set print repeats
6130 @cindex repeated array elements
6131 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
6132 elelments. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
6133 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
6134 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
6135 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
6136 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
6137 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
6138
6139 @item show print repeats
6140 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
6141 elements.
6142
6143 @item set print null-stop
6144 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
6145 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
6146 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
6147 contain only short strings.
6148 The default is off.
6149
6150 @item show print null-stop
6151 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
6152 @sc{null} character.
6153
6154 @item set print pretty on
6155 @cindex print structures in indented form
6156 @cindex indentation in structure display
6157 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
6158 per line, like this:
6159
6160 @smallexample
6161 @group
6162 $1 = @{
6163 next = 0x0,
6164 flags = @{
6165 sweet = 1,
6166 sour = 1
6167 @},
6168 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
6169 @}
6170 @end group
6171 @end smallexample
6172
6173 @item set print pretty off
6174 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
6175
6176 @smallexample
6177 @group
6178 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
6179 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
6180 @end group
6181 @end smallexample
6182
6183 @noindent
6184 This is the default format.
6185
6186 @item show print pretty
6187 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
6188
6189 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
6190 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
6191 @cindex octal escapes in strings
6192 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
6193 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
6194 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
6195 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
6196 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
6197
6198 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
6199 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
6200 international character sets, and is the default.
6201
6202 @item show print sevenbit-strings
6203 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
6204
6205 @item set print union on
6206 @cindex unions in structures, printing
6207 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
6208 and other unions. This is the default setting.
6209
6210 @item set print union off
6211 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
6212 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
6213 instead.
6214
6215 @item show print union
6216 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
6217 structures and other unions.
6218
6219 For example, given the declarations
6220
6221 @smallexample
6222 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
6223 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
6224 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
6225 Bug_forms;
6226
6227 struct thing @{
6228 Species it;
6229 union @{
6230 Tree_forms tree;
6231 Bug_forms bug;
6232 @} form;
6233 @};
6234
6235 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
6236 @end smallexample
6237
6238 @noindent
6239 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
6240
6241 @smallexample
6242 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
6243 @end smallexample
6244
6245 @noindent
6246 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
6247
6248 @smallexample
6249 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
6250 @end smallexample
6251
6252 @noindent
6253 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
6254 and in Pascal.
6255 @end table
6256
6257 @need 1000
6258 @noindent
6259 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
6260
6261 @table @code
6262 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
6263 @item set print demangle
6264 @itemx set print demangle on
6265 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
6266 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
6267 linkage. The default is on.
6268
6269 @item show print demangle
6270 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
6271
6272 @item set print asm-demangle
6273 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
6274 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
6275 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
6276 The default is off.
6277
6278 @item show print asm-demangle
6279 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
6280 or demangled form.
6281
6282 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
6283 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
6284 @kindex set demangle-style
6285 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
6286 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
6287 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @item auto
6291 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
6292
6293 @item gnu
6294 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
6295 This is the default.
6296
6297 @item hp
6298 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
6299
6300 @item lucid
6301 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
6302
6303 @item arm
6304 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
6305 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
6306 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
6307 require further enhancement to permit that.
6308
6309 @end table
6310 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
6311
6312 @item show demangle-style
6313 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
6314
6315 @item set print object
6316 @itemx set print object on
6317 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
6318 @cindex display derived types
6319 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
6320 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
6321 the virtual function table.
6322
6323 @item set print object off
6324 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
6325 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
6326
6327 @item show print object
6328 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
6329
6330 @item set print static-members
6331 @itemx set print static-members on
6332 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
6333 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
6334
6335 @item set print static-members off
6336 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
6337
6338 @item show print static-members
6339 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
6340
6341 @item set print pascal_static-members
6342 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
6343 @cindex static members of Pacal objects
6344 @cindex Pacal objects, static members display
6345 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
6346
6347 @item set print pascal_static-members off
6348 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
6349
6350 @item show print pascal_static-members
6351 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
6352
6353 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
6354 @item set print vtbl
6355 @itemx set print vtbl on
6356 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
6357 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
6358 @cindex VTBL display
6359 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
6360 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6361 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6362
6363 @item set print vtbl off
6364 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
6365
6366 @item show print vtbl
6367 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
6368 @end table
6369
6370 @node Value History
6371 @section Value history
6372
6373 @cindex value history
6374 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
6375 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
6376 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
6377 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
6378 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
6379 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
6380 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
6381 symbol table.
6382
6383 @cindex @code{$}
6384 @cindex @code{$$}
6385 @cindex history number
6386 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
6387 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
6388 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
6389 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
6390 history number.
6391
6392 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
6393 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
6394 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
6395 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
6396 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
6397 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
6398 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
6399
6400 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
6401 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
6402
6403 @smallexample
6404 p *$
6405 @end smallexample
6406
6407 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
6408 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
6409
6410 @smallexample
6411 p *$.next
6412 @end smallexample
6413
6414 @noindent
6415 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
6416 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
6417
6418 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
6419 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
6420
6421 @smallexample
6422 print x
6423 set x=5
6424 @end smallexample
6425
6426 @noindent
6427 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
6428 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
6429
6430 @table @code
6431 @kindex show values
6432 @item show values
6433 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
6434 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
6435 values} does not change the history.
6436
6437 @item show values @var{n}
6438 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
6439
6440 @item show values +
6441 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
6442 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
6443 @end table
6444
6445 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
6446 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
6447
6448 @node Convenience Vars
6449 @section Convenience variables
6450
6451 @cindex convenience variables
6452 @cindex user-defined variables
6453 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
6454 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
6455 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
6456 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
6457 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
6458
6459 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
6460 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
6461 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6462 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
6463 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
6464
6465 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
6466 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
6467 For example:
6468
6469 @smallexample
6470 set $foo = *object_ptr
6471 @end smallexample
6472
6473 @noindent
6474 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
6475 @code{object_ptr}.
6476
6477 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
6478 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
6479 value with another assignment at any time.
6480
6481 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
6482 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
6483 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
6484 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
6485
6486 @table @code
6487 @kindex show convenience
6488 @cindex show all user variables
6489 @item show convenience
6490 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
6491 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
6492
6493 @kindex init-if-undefined
6494 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
6495 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
6496 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
6497 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
6498 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
6499 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
6500 override default values used in a command script.
6501
6502 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
6503 any side-effects do not occur.
6504 @end table
6505
6506 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
6507 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
6508 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
6509
6510 @smallexample
6511 set $i = 0
6512 print bar[$i++]->contents
6513 @end smallexample
6514
6515 @noindent
6516 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
6517
6518 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
6519 values likely to be useful.
6520
6521 @table @code
6522 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
6523 @item $_
6524 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
6525 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
6526 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
6527 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
6528 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
6529 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
6530 to the type of @code{$__}.
6531
6532 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
6533 @item $__
6534 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
6535 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
6536 to match the format in which the data was printed.
6537
6538 @item $_exitcode
6539 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
6540 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
6541 the program being debugged terminates.
6542 @end table
6543
6544 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
6545 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
6546 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
6547
6548 @node Registers
6549 @section Registers
6550
6551 @cindex registers
6552 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
6553 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
6554 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
6555 your machine.
6556
6557 @table @code
6558 @kindex info registers
6559 @item info registers
6560 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
6561 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6562
6563 @kindex info all-registers
6564 @cindex floating point registers
6565 @item info all-registers
6566 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
6567 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
6568
6569 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
6570 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
6571 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
6572 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
6573 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
6574 @end table
6575
6576 @cindex stack pointer register
6577 @cindex program counter register
6578 @cindex process status register
6579 @cindex frame pointer register
6580 @cindex standard registers
6581 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
6582 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
6583 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
6584 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
6585 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
6586 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
6587 register that contains the processor status. For example,
6588 you could print the program counter in hex with
6589
6590 @smallexample
6591 p/x $pc
6592 @end smallexample
6593
6594 @noindent
6595 or print the instruction to be executed next with
6596
6597 @smallexample
6598 x/i $pc
6599 @end smallexample
6600
6601 @noindent
6602 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
6603 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
6604 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
6605 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
6606 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
6607 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
6608 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
6609
6610 @smallexample
6611 set $sp += 4
6612 @end smallexample
6613
6614 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
6615 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
6616 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
6617 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
6618 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
6619 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
6620 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
6621
6622 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
6623 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
6624 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
6625 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
6626 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
6627 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
6628 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
6629
6630 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
6631 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
6632 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
6633 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
6634 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
6635 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
6636 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
6637 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
6638 prints the data in both formats.
6639
6640 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
6641 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
6642 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
6643 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
6644 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
6645 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
6646 registers in @code{struct} notation:
6647
6648 @smallexample
6649 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
6650 $1 = @{
6651 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
6652 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
6653 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
6654 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
6655 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
6656 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
6657 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
6658 @}
6659 @end smallexample
6660
6661 @noindent
6662 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
6663 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
6664 value to a @code{struct} member:
6665
6666 @smallexample
6667 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
6668 @end smallexample
6669
6670 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
6671 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
6672 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
6673 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
6674 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
6675 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
6676
6677 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
6678 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
6679 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
6680 frame makes no difference.
6681
6682 @node Floating Point Hardware
6683 @section Floating point hardware
6684 @cindex floating point
6685
6686 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
6687 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @kindex info float
6691 @item info float
6692 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
6693 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
6694 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
6695 the ARM and x86 machines.
6696 @end table
6697
6698 @node Vector Unit
6699 @section Vector Unit
6700 @cindex vector unit
6701
6702 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
6703 more information about the status of the vector unit.
6704
6705 @table @code
6706 @kindex info vector
6707 @item info vector
6708 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
6709 layout vary depending on the hardware.
6710 @end table
6711
6712 @node OS Information
6713 @section Operating system auxiliary information
6714 @cindex OS information
6715
6716 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
6717 you debug your program.
6718
6719 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
6720 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
6721 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
6722 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
6723 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
6724 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
6725 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
6726 structure.
6727
6728 @table @code
6729 @item info udot
6730 @kindex info udot
6731 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
6732 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
6733 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
6734 the @code{examine} command.
6735 @end table
6736
6737 @cindex auxiliary vector
6738 @cindex vector, auxiliary
6739 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
6740 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
6741 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
6742 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
6743 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
6744 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
6745 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
6746 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
6747 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
6748 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
6749 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
6750
6751 @table @code
6752 @kindex info auxv
6753 @item info auxv
6754 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
6755 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
6756 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
6757 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
6758 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
6759 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
6760 an unrecognized tag.
6761 @end table
6762
6763
6764 @node Memory Region Attributes
6765 @section Memory region attributes
6766 @cindex memory region attributes
6767
6768 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
6769 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
6770 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
6771 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
6772 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
6773 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
6774 user can override the fetched regions.
6775
6776 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
6777 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
6778 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
6779 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
6780 all memory.
6781
6782 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
6783 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
6784
6785 @table @code
6786 @kindex mem
6787 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
6788 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
6789 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
6790 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
6791 case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
6792 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
6793
6794 @item mem auto
6795 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
6796 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
6797
6798 @kindex delete mem
6799 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6800 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
6801 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
6802
6803 @kindex disable mem
6804 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6805 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6806 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
6807 It may be enabled again later.
6808
6809 @kindex enable mem
6810 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
6811 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
6812
6813 @kindex info mem
6814 @item info mem
6815 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
6816 for each region:
6817
6818 @table @emph
6819 @item Memory Region Number
6820 @item Enabled or Disabled.
6821 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
6822 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
6823
6824 @item Lo Address
6825 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
6826
6827 @item Hi Address
6828 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
6829
6830 @item Attributes
6831 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
6832 @end table
6833 @end table
6834
6835
6836 @subsection Attributes
6837
6838 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
6839 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
6840 write accesses to a memory region.
6841
6842 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
6843 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
6844 etc.@: from accessing memory.
6845
6846 @table @code
6847 @item ro
6848 Memory is read only.
6849 @item wo
6850 Memory is write only.
6851 @item rw
6852 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
6853 @end table
6854
6855 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
6856 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
6857 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
6858 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
6859 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
6860
6861 @table @code
6862 @item 8
6863 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
6864 @item 16
6865 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
6866 @item 32
6867 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
6868 @item 64
6869 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
6870 @end table
6871
6872 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
6873 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6874 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
6875 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
6876 @c
6877 @c @table @code
6878 @c @item hwbreak
6879 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
6880 @c @item swbreak (default)
6881 @c @end table
6882
6883 @subsubsection Data Cache
6884 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
6885 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
6886 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
6887 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
6888 registers.
6889
6890 @table @code
6891 @item cache
6892 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
6893 @item nocache
6894 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
6895 @end table
6896
6897 @subsection Memory Access Checking
6898 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
6899 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
6900 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
6901 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
6902
6903 @table @code
6904 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
6905 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
6906 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
6907 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
6908 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
6909 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
6910 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
6911 The default value is @code{off}.
6912 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
6913 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
6914 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
6915 @end table
6916
6917
6918 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
6919 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
6920 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
6921 @c
6922 @c @table @code
6923 @c @item verify
6924 @c @item noverify (default)
6925 @c @end table
6926
6927 @node Dump/Restore Files
6928 @section Copy between memory and a file
6929 @cindex dump/restore files
6930 @cindex append data to a file
6931 @cindex dump data to a file
6932 @cindex restore data from a file
6933
6934 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
6935 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
6936 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
6937 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
6938 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
6939 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
6940 files.
6941
6942 @table @code
6943
6944 @kindex dump
6945 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6946 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6947 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6948 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
6949
6950 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
6951 @table @code
6952 @item binary
6953 Raw binary form.
6954 @item ihex
6955 Intel hex format.
6956 @item srec
6957 Motorola S-record format.
6958 @item tekhex
6959 Tektronix Hex format.
6960 @end table
6961
6962 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
6963 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
6964 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
6965 form.
6966
6967 @kindex append
6968 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
6969 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
6970 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
6971 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
6972 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
6973
6974 @kindex restore
6975 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
6976 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
6977 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
6978 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
6979 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
6980
6981 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
6982 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
6983 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
6984 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
6985 from that location.
6986
6987 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
6988 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
6989 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
6990 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
6991
6992 @end table
6993
6994 @node Core File Generation
6995 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
6996 @cindex dump core from inferior
6997
6998 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
6999 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7000 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7001 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7002 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7003 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7004 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7005
7006 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7007 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7008 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7009
7010 @table @code
7011 @kindex gcore
7012 @kindex generate-core-file
7013 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7014 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7015 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7016 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7017 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7018 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7019
7020 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7021 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7022 @end table
7023
7024 @node Character Sets
7025 @section Character Sets
7026 @cindex character sets
7027 @cindex charset
7028 @cindex translating between character sets
7029 @cindex host character set
7030 @cindex target character set
7031
7032 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7033 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7034 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7035 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7036 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7037 @dfn{target character set}.
7038
7039 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7040 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7041 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7042 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7043 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7044 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7045 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7046 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7047 character and string literals in expressions.
7048
7049 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7050 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7051 target-charset} command, described below.
7052
7053 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7054 support:
7055
7056 @table @code
7057 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7058 @kindex set target-charset
7059 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7060 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7061 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7062 list the target character sets it supports.
7063 @end table
7064
7065 @table @code
7066 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7067 @kindex set host-charset
7068 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7069
7070 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7071 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7072 @code{set host-charset} command.
7073
7074 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7075 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7076 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7077 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7078 list the host character sets it supports.
7079
7080 @item set charset @var{charset}
7081 @kindex set charset
7082 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7083 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7084 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7085 for both host and target.
7086
7087
7088 @item show charset
7089 @kindex show charset
7090 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7091
7092 @itemx show host-charset
7093 @kindex show host-charset
7094 Show the name of the current host charset.
7095
7096 @itemx show target-charset
7097 @kindex show target-charset
7098 Show the name of the current target charset.
7099
7100 @end table
7101
7102 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
7103 sets:
7104
7105 @table @code
7106
7107 @item ASCII
7108 @cindex ASCII character set
7109 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
7110 character set.
7111
7112 @item ISO-8859-1
7113 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
7114 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
7115 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
7116 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
7117 this as its host character set.
7118
7119 @item EBCDIC-US
7120 @itemx IBM1047
7121 @cindex EBCDIC character set
7122 @cindex IBM1047 character set
7123 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
7124 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
7125 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
7126
7127 @end table
7128
7129 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
7130 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
7131 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
7132
7133 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
7134 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
7135 @file{charset-test.c}:
7136
7137 @smallexample
7138 #include <stdio.h>
7139
7140 char ascii_hello[]
7141 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
7142 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
7143 char ibm1047_hello[]
7144 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
7145 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
7146
7147 main ()
7148 @{
7149 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7150 @}
7151 @end smallexample
7152
7153 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
7154 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
7155 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
7156
7157 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
7158
7159 @smallexample
7160 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
7161 $ gdb -nw charset-test
7162 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
7163 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7164 @dots{}
7165 (@value{GDBP})
7166 @end smallexample
7167
7168 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
7169 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
7170 strings:
7171
7172 @smallexample
7173 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7174 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
7175 (@value{GDBP})
7176 @end smallexample
7177
7178 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
7179 initial character set:
7180 @smallexample
7181 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
7182 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7183 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
7184 (@value{GDBP})
7185 @end smallexample
7186
7187 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
7188 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
7189 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
7190 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
7191 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
7192
7193 @smallexample
7194 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7195 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
7196 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7197 $2 = 72 'H'
7198 (@value{GDBP})
7199 @end smallexample
7200
7201 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
7202 literals you use in expressions:
7203
7204 @smallexample
7205 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7206 $3 = 43 '+'
7207 (@value{GDBP})
7208 @end smallexample
7209
7210 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
7211 character.
7212
7213 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
7214 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
7215 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
7216
7217 @smallexample
7218 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7219 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
7220 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7221 $5 = 200 '\310'
7222 (@value{GDBP})
7223 @end smallexample
7224
7225 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7226 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
7227
7228 @smallexample
7229 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7230 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
7231 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
7232 @end smallexample
7233
7234 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
7235 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
7236 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
7237 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
7238 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
7239
7240 @smallexample
7241 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
7242 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
7243 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
7244 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
7245 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
7246 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
7247 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
7248 $7 = 72 '\110'
7249 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
7250 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
7251 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
7252 $9 = 200 'H'
7253 (@value{GDBP})
7254 @end smallexample
7255
7256 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
7257 string literals you use in expressions:
7258
7259 @smallexample
7260 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
7261 $10 = 78 '+'
7262 (@value{GDBP})
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
7266 character.
7267
7268 @node Caching Remote Data
7269 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
7270 @cindex caching data of remote targets
7271
7272 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
7273 remote target (@pxref{Remote}). Such caching generally improves
7274 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
7275 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
7276 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
7277 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
7278 volatile registers are in use.
7279
7280 @table @code
7281 @kindex set remotecache
7282 @item set remotecache on
7283 @itemx set remotecache off
7284 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
7285 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
7286
7287 @kindex show remotecache
7288 @item show remotecache
7289 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
7290
7291 @kindex info dcache
7292 @item info dcache
7293 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
7294 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
7295 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
7296 state (dirty, bad, ok, etc.). This command is useful for debugging
7297 the data cache operation.
7298 @end table
7299
7300
7301 @node Macros
7302 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
7303
7304 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
7305 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
7306 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
7307 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
7308 where it was defined.
7309
7310 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
7311 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
7312 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
7313 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
7314
7315 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
7316 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
7317 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
7318 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
7319 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
7320 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
7321 see @ref{List}.
7322
7323 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
7324 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
7325 variable-arity macros.
7326
7327 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
7328 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
7329 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
7330
7331 @table @code
7332
7333 @kindex macro expand
7334 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
7335 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
7336 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
7337 @item macro expand @var{expression}
7338 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
7339 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
7340 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
7341 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
7342 it can be any string of tokens.
7343
7344 @kindex macro exp1
7345 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
7346 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
7347 @cindex expand macro once
7348 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
7349 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
7350 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
7351 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
7352 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
7353 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
7354 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
7355 can be any string of tokens.
7356
7357 @kindex info macro
7358 @cindex macro definition, showing
7359 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
7360 @item info macro @var{macro}
7361 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
7362 source location where that definition was established.
7363
7364 @kindex macro define
7365 @cindex user-defined macros
7366 @cindex defining macros interactively
7367 @cindex macros, user-defined
7368 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
7369 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
7370 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
7371 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
7372 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
7373 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
7374 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
7375 given in @var{arglist}.
7376
7377 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
7378 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
7379 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
7380 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
7381 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
7382
7383 @kindex macro undef
7384 @item macro undef @var{macro}
7385 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
7386 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
7387 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
7388 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
7389 debugged.
7390
7391 @kindex macro list
7392 @item macro list
7393 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} List all the macros
7394 defined using the @code{macro define} command.
7395 @end table
7396
7397 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
7398 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
7399 show our source files:
7400
7401 @smallexample
7402 $ cat sample.c
7403 #include <stdio.h>
7404 #include "sample.h"
7405
7406 #define M 42
7407 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7408
7409 main ()
7410 @{
7411 #define N 28
7412 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7413 #undef N
7414 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7415 #define N 1729
7416 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7417 @}
7418 $ cat sample.h
7419 #define Q <
7420 $
7421 @end smallexample
7422
7423 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
7424 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
7425 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
7426 information.
7427
7428 @smallexample
7429 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
7430 $
7431 @end smallexample
7432
7433 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
7434
7435 @smallexample
7436 $ gdb -nw sample
7437 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
7438 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
7439 GDB is free software, @dots{}
7440 (@value{GDBP})
7441 @end smallexample
7442
7443 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
7444 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
7445 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
7446
7447 @smallexample
7448 (@value{GDBP}) list main
7449 3
7450 4 #define M 42
7451 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7452 6
7453 7 main ()
7454 8 @{
7455 9 #define N 28
7456 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7457 11 #undef N
7458 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7459 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
7460 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
7461 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
7462 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
7463 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
7464 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
7465 #define Q <
7466 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
7467 expands to: (42 + 1)
7468 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
7469 expands to: once (M + 1)
7470 (@value{GDBP})
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
7474 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
7475 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
7476 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
7477
7478 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
7479 the source line of the current stack frame:
7480
7481 @smallexample
7482 (@value{GDBP}) break main
7483 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
7484 (@value{GDBP}) run
7485 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
7486
7487 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
7488 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
7489 (@value{GDBP})
7490 @end smallexample
7491
7492 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
7493
7494 @smallexample
7495 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7496 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
7497 #define N 28
7498 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7499 expands to: 28 < 42
7500 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7501 $1 = 1
7502 (@value{GDBP})
7503 @end smallexample
7504
7505 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
7506 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
7507 thereof) in force at each point:
7508
7509 @smallexample
7510 (@value{GDBP}) next
7511 Hello, world!
7512 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
7513 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7514 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
7515 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
7516 (@value{GDBP}) next
7517 We're so creative.
7518 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
7519 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
7520 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
7521 #define N 1729
7522 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
7523 expands to: 1729 < 42
7524 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
7525 $2 = 0
7526 (@value{GDBP})
7527 @end smallexample
7528
7529
7530 @node Tracepoints
7531 @chapter Tracepoints
7532 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
7533 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
7534
7535 @cindex tracepoints
7536 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
7537 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
7538 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
7539 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
7540 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
7541 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
7542 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
7543
7544 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
7545 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
7546 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
7547 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
7548 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
7549 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
7550 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
7551 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
7552 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
7553 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
7554 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
7555
7556 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
7557 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
7558 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
7559 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
7560 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
7561 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
7562 Packets}.
7563
7564 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
7565
7566 @menu
7567 * Set Tracepoints::
7568 * Analyze Collected Data::
7569 * Tracepoint Variables::
7570 @end menu
7571
7572 @node Set Tracepoints
7573 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
7574
7575 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
7576 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
7577 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
7578 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
7579 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
7580 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
7581 work on.
7582
7583 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
7584 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
7585 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
7586 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
7587 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
7588 tracepoint was hit.
7589
7590 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
7591 conditions and actions.
7592
7593 @menu
7594 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
7595 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
7596 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
7597 * Tracepoint Actions::
7598 * Listing Tracepoints::
7599 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
7600 @end menu
7601
7602 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
7603 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
7604
7605 @table @code
7606 @cindex set tracepoint
7607 @kindex trace
7608 @item trace
7609 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
7610 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
7611 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
7612 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
7613 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
7614 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
7615 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
7616 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
7617 running.
7618
7619 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
7620
7621 @smallexample
7622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
7623
7624 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
7625
7626 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
7627
7628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
7629
7630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
7631 @end smallexample
7632
7633 @noindent
7634 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
7635
7636 @vindex $tpnum
7637 @cindex last tracepoint number
7638 @cindex recent tracepoint number
7639 @cindex tracepoint number
7640 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
7641 of the most recently set tracepoint.
7642
7643 @kindex delete tracepoint
7644 @cindex tracepoint deletion
7645 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7646 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
7647 default is to delete all tracepoints.
7648
7649 Examples:
7650
7651 @smallexample
7652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
7653
7654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
7655 @end smallexample
7656
7657 @noindent
7658 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
7659 @end table
7660
7661 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7662 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
7663
7664 @table @code
7665 @kindex disable tracepoint
7666 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7667 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
7668 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
7669 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
7670 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
7671
7672 @kindex enable tracepoint
7673 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7674 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
7675 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
7676 run.
7677 @end table
7678
7679 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
7680 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
7681
7682 @table @code
7683 @kindex passcount
7684 @cindex tracepoint pass count
7685 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
7686 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
7687 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
7688 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
7689 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
7690 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
7691 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
7692 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
7693 user.
7694
7695 Examples:
7696
7697 @smallexample
7698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
7699 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
7700
7701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
7702 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
7703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
7705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
7706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
7707 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
7708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
7709 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
7710 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
7711 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
7712 @end smallexample
7713 @end table
7714
7715 @node Tracepoint Actions
7716 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
7717
7718 @table @code
7719 @kindex actions
7720 @cindex tracepoint actions
7721 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7722 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
7723 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
7724 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
7725 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
7726 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
7727 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
7728 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
7729 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
7730 @code{while-stepping}.
7731
7732 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
7733 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
7734 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
7735
7736 @smallexample
7737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
7738
7739 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
7740
7741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
7742 @end smallexample
7743
7744 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
7745 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
7746 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
7747 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
7748 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
7749 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
7750 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
7751 @code{end} command.
7752
7753 @smallexample
7754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
7755 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7756 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
7757 > collect bar,baz
7758 > collect $regs
7759 > while-stepping 12
7760 > collect $fp, $sp
7761 > end
7762 end
7763 @end smallexample
7764
7765 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
7766 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
7767 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
7768 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
7769 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
7770 special arguments are supported:
7771
7772 @table @code
7773 @item $regs
7774 collect all registers
7775
7776 @item $args
7777 collect all function arguments
7778
7779 @item $locals
7780 collect all local variables.
7781 @end table
7782
7783 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
7784 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
7785 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
7786
7787 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
7788 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
7789
7790 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
7791 @item while-stepping @var{n}
7792 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
7793 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
7794 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
7795 its own @code{end} command):
7796
7797 @smallexample
7798 > while-stepping 12
7799 > collect $regs, myglobal
7800 > end
7801 >
7802 @end smallexample
7803
7804 @noindent
7805 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
7806 @code{stepping}.
7807 @end table
7808
7809 @node Listing Tracepoints
7810 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
7811
7812 @table @code
7813 @kindex info tracepoints
7814 @kindex info tp
7815 @cindex information about tracepoints
7816 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
7817 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
7818 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
7819 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
7820 shown:
7821
7822 @itemize @bullet
7823 @item
7824 its number
7825 @item
7826 whether it is enabled or disabled
7827 @item
7828 its address
7829 @item
7830 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
7831 @item
7832 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
7833 @item
7834 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
7835 @item
7836 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
7837 @end itemize
7838
7839 @smallexample
7840 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
7841 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
7842 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
7843 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
7844 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
7845 (@value{GDBP})
7846 @end smallexample
7847
7848 @noindent
7849 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
7850 @end table
7851
7852 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7853 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
7854
7855 @table @code
7856 @kindex tstart
7857 @cindex start a new trace experiment
7858 @cindex collected data discarded
7859 @item tstart
7860 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
7861 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
7862 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
7863 experiment.
7864
7865 @kindex tstop
7866 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
7867 @item tstop
7868 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
7869 stops collecting data.
7870
7871 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
7872 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
7873 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
7874
7875 @kindex tstatus
7876 @cindex status of trace data collection
7877 @cindex trace experiment, status of
7878 @item tstatus
7879 This command displays the status of the current trace data
7880 collection.
7881 @end table
7882
7883 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
7884
7885 @smallexample
7886 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
7887 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
7888 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
7889 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
7890 > while-stepping 11
7891 > collect $regs
7892 > end
7893 > end
7894 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
7895 [time passes @dots{}]
7896 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
7897 @end smallexample
7898
7899
7900 @node Analyze Collected Data
7901 @section Using the collected data
7902
7903 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
7904 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
7905 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
7906 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
7907 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
7908 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
7909 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
7910 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
7911 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
7912 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
7913 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
7914 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
7915 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
7916 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
7917 the buffer will fail.
7918
7919 @menu
7920 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
7921 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
7922 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
7923 @end menu
7924
7925 @node tfind
7926 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
7927
7928 @kindex tfind
7929 @cindex select trace snapshot
7930 @cindex find trace snapshot
7931 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
7932 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
7933 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
7934 snapshot is selected.
7935
7936 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
7937
7938 @table @code
7939 @item tfind start
7940 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
7941 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
7942
7943 @item tfind none
7944 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
7945
7946 @item tfind end
7947 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
7948
7949 @item tfind
7950 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
7951
7952 @item tfind -
7953 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
7954 retracing earlier steps.
7955
7956 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
7957 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
7958 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
7959 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
7960 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
7961
7962 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
7963 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
7964 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
7965 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
7966 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
7967
7968 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7969 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
7970 addresses.
7971
7972 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
7973 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
7974 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
7975
7976 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
7977 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
7978 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
7979 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
7980 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
7981 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
7982 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
7983 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
7984 @end table
7985
7986 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
7987 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
7988 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
7989 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
7990 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
7991 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
7992 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
7993 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
7994 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
7995 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
7996 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
7997 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
7998 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
7999 tracepoint as the current one.
8000
8001 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8002 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8003 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8004 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
8005 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
8006
8007 @smallexample
8008 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8009 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8010 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
8011 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
8012 > tfind
8013 > end
8014
8015 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
8016 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
8017 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
8018 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
8019 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
8020 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
8021 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
8022 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
8023 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
8024 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
8025 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
8026 @end smallexample
8027
8028 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
8029 the buffer:
8030
8031 @smallexample
8032 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8033 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
8034 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
8035 > tfind line
8036 > end
8037
8038 Frame 0, X = 1
8039 Frame 7, X = 2
8040 Frame 13, X = 255
8041 @end smallexample
8042
8043 @node tdump
8044 @subsection @code{tdump}
8045 @kindex tdump
8046 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
8047 @cindex tracepoint data, display
8048
8049 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
8050 the current trace snapshot.
8051
8052 @smallexample
8053 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
8054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8055 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
8056 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
8057 > end
8058
8059 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8060
8061 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
8062 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
8063 at gdb_test.c:444
8064 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
8065
8066 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
8067 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
8068 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
8069 d1 0x18 24
8070 d2 0x80 128
8071 d3 0x33 51
8072 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
8073 d5 0x22 34
8074 d6 0xe0 224
8075 d7 0x380035 3670069
8076 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
8077 a1 0x3000668 50333288
8078 a2 0x100 256
8079 a3 0x322000 3284992
8080 a4 0x3000698 50333336
8081 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
8082 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
8083 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
8084 ps 0x0 0
8085 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
8086 fpcontrol 0x0 0
8087 fpstatus 0x0 0
8088 fpiaddr 0x0 0
8089 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
8090 p1 = (void *) 0x11
8091 p2 = (void *) 0x22
8092 p3 = (void *) 0x33
8093 p4 = (void *) 0x44
8094 p5 = (void *) 0x55
8095 p6 = (void *) 0x66
8096 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
8097
8098 (@value{GDBP})
8099 @end smallexample
8100
8101 @node save-tracepoints
8102 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
8103 @kindex save-tracepoints
8104 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
8105
8106 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
8107 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
8108 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
8109 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
8110 Files}).
8111
8112 @node Tracepoint Variables
8113 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
8114 @cindex tracepoint variables
8115 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
8116
8117 @table @code
8118 @vindex $trace_frame
8119 @item (int) $trace_frame
8120 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
8121 snapshot is selected.
8122
8123 @vindex $tracepoint
8124 @item (int) $tracepoint
8125 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
8126
8127 @vindex $trace_line
8128 @item (int) $trace_line
8129 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
8130
8131 @vindex $trace_file
8132 @item (char []) $trace_file
8133 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
8134
8135 @vindex $trace_func
8136 @item (char []) $trace_func
8137 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
8138 @end table
8139
8140 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
8141 use @code{output} instead.
8142
8143 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
8144 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
8145 data.
8146
8147 @smallexample
8148 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
8149
8150 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
8151 > output $trace_file
8152 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
8153 > tfind
8154 > end
8155 @end smallexample
8156
8157 @node Overlays
8158 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
8159 @cindex overlays
8160
8161 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
8162 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
8163 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
8164 use overlays.
8165
8166 @menu
8167 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
8168 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
8169 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
8170 mapped by asking the inferior.
8171 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
8172 @end menu
8173
8174 @node How Overlays Work
8175 @section How Overlays Work
8176 @cindex mapped overlays
8177 @cindex unmapped overlays
8178 @cindex load address, overlay's
8179 @cindex mapped address
8180 @cindex overlay area
8181
8182 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
8183 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
8184 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
8185 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
8186 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
8187
8188 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
8189 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
8190 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
8191 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
8192 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
8193 largest overlay as well.
8194
8195 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
8196 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
8197 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
8198 there.
8199
8200 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
8201 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
8202 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
8203
8204 @smallexample
8205 @group
8206 Data Instruction Larger
8207 Address Space Address Space Address Space
8208 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
8209 | | | | | |
8210 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
8211 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
8212 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
8213 | and heap | | | | | |
8214 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
8215 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
8216 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
8217 | | | | | |
8218 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
8219 address | | | | | |
8220 | overlay | <-' | | |
8221 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
8222 | | <---. | | load address
8223 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
8224 | | | |
8225 +-----------+ | |
8226 +-----------+
8227 | |
8228 +-----------+
8229
8230 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
8231 @end group
8232 @end smallexample
8233
8234 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
8235 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
8236 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
8237 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
8238 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
8239 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
8240 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
8241 program and the overlay area.
8242
8243 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
8244 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
8245 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
8246 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
8247 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
8248 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
8249 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
8250
8251 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
8252 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
8253 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
8254
8255 @itemize @bullet
8256
8257 @item
8258 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
8259 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
8260 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
8261 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
8262
8263 @item
8264 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
8265 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
8266 your program's performance.
8267
8268 @item
8269 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
8270 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
8271 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
8272 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
8273 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
8274 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
8275 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
8276
8277 @item
8278 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
8279 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
8280 instruction and data spaces.
8281
8282 @end itemize
8283
8284 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
8285 improved in many ways:
8286
8287 @itemize @bullet
8288
8289 @item
8290 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
8291 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
8292 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
8293 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
8294 area in the usual way.
8295
8296 @item
8297 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
8298 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
8299
8300 @item
8301 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
8302 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
8303 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
8304 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
8305 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
8306 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
8307 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
8308
8309 @end itemize
8310
8311
8312 @node Overlay Commands
8313 @section Overlay Commands
8314
8315 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
8316 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
8317 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
8318 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
8319 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
8320 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
8321
8322 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
8323 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
8324
8325 @table @code
8326 @item overlay off
8327 @kindex overlay
8328 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
8329 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
8330 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
8331 overlay support is disabled.
8332
8333 @item overlay manual
8334 @cindex manual overlay debugging
8335 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8336 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
8337 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
8338 commands described below.
8339
8340 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
8341 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
8342 @cindex map an overlay
8343 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
8344 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
8345 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
8346 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
8347 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
8348 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
8349
8350 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
8351 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
8352 @cindex unmap an overlay
8353 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
8354 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
8355 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
8356 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
8357
8358 @item overlay auto
8359 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
8360 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
8361 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
8362 Overlay Debugging}.
8363
8364 @item overlay load-target
8365 @itemx overlay load
8366 @cindex reloading the overlay table
8367 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
8368 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
8369 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
8370 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
8371 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
8372
8373 @item overlay list-overlays
8374 @itemx overlay list
8375 @cindex listing mapped overlays
8376 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
8377 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
8378
8379 @end table
8380
8381 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
8382 of the function the address falls in:
8383
8384 @smallexample
8385 (@value{GDBP}) print main
8386 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
8387 @end smallexample
8388 @noindent
8389 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
8390 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
8391 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
8392 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
8393
8394 @smallexample
8395 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8396 No sections are mapped.
8397 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8398 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
8399 @end smallexample
8400 @noindent
8401 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
8402 name normally:
8403
8404 @smallexample
8405 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
8406 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
8407 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
8408 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
8409 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
8410 @end smallexample
8411
8412 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
8413 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
8414 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
8415 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
8416 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
8417
8418 @itemize @bullet
8419 @item
8420 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
8421 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
8422 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
8423 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
8424 @item
8425 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
8426 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
8427 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
8428 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
8429 breakpoints properly.
8430 @end itemize
8431
8432
8433 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
8434 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
8435 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
8436
8437 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
8438 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
8439 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
8440 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
8441 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
8442 current state of the overlays.
8443
8444 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
8445 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
8446
8447 @table @asis
8448
8449 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
8450 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
8451
8452 @smallexample
8453 struct
8454 @{
8455 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
8456 unsigned long vma;
8457
8458 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
8459 unsigned long size;
8460
8461 /* The overlay's load address. */
8462 unsigned long lma;
8463
8464 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
8465 zero otherwise. */
8466 unsigned long mapped;
8467 @}
8468 @end smallexample
8469
8470 @item @code{_novlys}:
8471 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
8472 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
8473
8474 @end table
8475
8476 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
8477 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
8478 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
8479 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
8480 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
8481 currently mapped.
8482
8483 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
8484 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
8485 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
8486 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
8487 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
8488 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
8489 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
8490 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
8491 are not being executed.
8492
8493 @node Overlay Sample Program
8494 @section Overlay Sample Program
8495 @cindex overlay example program
8496
8497 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
8498 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
8499 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
8500 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
8501 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
8502 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
8503 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
8504
8505 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
8506 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
8507 suite. The program consists of the following files from
8508 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
8509
8510 @table @file
8511 @item overlays.c
8512 The main program file.
8513 @item ovlymgr.c
8514 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
8515 @item foo.c
8516 @itemx bar.c
8517 @itemx baz.c
8518 @itemx grbx.c
8519 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
8520 @item d10v.ld
8521 @itemx m32r.ld
8522 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
8523 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
8524 @end table
8525
8526 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
8527 cross-compiler like this:
8528
8529 @smallexample
8530 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
8531 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
8532 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
8533 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
8534 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
8535 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
8536 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
8537 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
8538 @end smallexample
8539
8540 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
8541 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
8542 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
8543
8544
8545 @node Languages
8546 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
8547 @cindex languages
8548
8549 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
8550 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
8551 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
8552 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
8553 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
8554 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
8555
8556 @cindex working language
8557 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
8558 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
8559 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
8560 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
8561 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
8562 language}.
8563
8564 @menu
8565 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
8566 * Show:: Displaying the language
8567 * Checks:: Type and range checks
8568 * Supported languages:: Supported languages
8569 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
8570 @end menu
8571
8572 @node Setting
8573 @section Switching between source languages
8574
8575 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
8576 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
8577 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
8578 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
8579 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
8580 are printed, etc.
8581
8582 In addition to the working language, every source file that
8583 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
8584 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
8585 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
8586 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
8587 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
8588 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
8589 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
8590 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
8591 Displaying the language}.
8592
8593 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
8594 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
8595 another language. In that case, make the
8596 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
8597 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
8598 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
8599
8600 @menu
8601 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
8602 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
8603 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8604 @end menu
8605
8606 @node Filenames
8607 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
8608
8609 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
8610 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
8611
8612 @table @file
8613 @item .ada
8614 @itemx .ads
8615 @itemx .adb
8616 @itemx .a
8617 Ada source file.
8618
8619 @item .c
8620 C source file
8621
8622 @item .C
8623 @itemx .cc
8624 @itemx .cp
8625 @itemx .cpp
8626 @itemx .cxx
8627 @itemx .c++
8628 C@t{++} source file
8629
8630 @item .m
8631 Objective-C source file
8632
8633 @item .f
8634 @itemx .F
8635 Fortran source file
8636
8637 @item .mod
8638 Modula-2 source file
8639
8640 @item .s
8641 @itemx .S
8642 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
8643 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
8644 @end table
8645
8646 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
8647 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
8648
8649 @node Manually
8650 @subsection Setting the working language
8651
8652 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
8653 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
8654 your program.
8655
8656 @kindex set language
8657 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
8658 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
8659 a language, such as
8660 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
8661 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
8662
8663 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
8664 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
8665 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
8666 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
8667 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
8668 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
8669 command such as:
8670
8671 @smallexample
8672 print a = b + c
8673 @end smallexample
8674
8675 @noindent
8676 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
8677 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
8678 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
8679 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
8680
8681 @node Automatically
8682 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
8683
8684 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
8685 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
8686 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
8687 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
8688 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
8689 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
8690 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
8691 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
8692 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
8693
8694 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
8695 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
8696 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
8697 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
8698 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
8699
8700 @node Show
8701 @section Displaying the language
8702
8703 The following commands help you find out which language is the
8704 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
8705
8706 @table @code
8707 @item show language
8708 @kindex show language
8709 Display the current working language. This is the
8710 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
8711 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
8712
8713 @item info frame
8714 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
8715 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
8716 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
8717 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
8718 information listed here.
8719
8720 @item info source
8721 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
8722 Display the source language of this source file.
8723 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
8724 information listed here.
8725 @end table
8726
8727 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
8728 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
8729 with a language explicitly:
8730
8731 @table @code
8732 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
8733 @kindex set extension-language
8734 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
8735 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
8736
8737 @item info extensions
8738 @kindex info extensions
8739 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
8740 @end table
8741
8742 @node Checks
8743 @section Type and range checking
8744
8745 @quotation
8746 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
8747 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
8748 section documents the intended facilities.
8749 @end quotation
8750 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
8751
8752 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
8753 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
8754 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
8755 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
8756 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
8757 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
8758 errors when your program is running.
8759
8760 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
8761 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
8762 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
8763 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
8764 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
8765 automatically based on your program's source language.
8766 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default
8767 settings of supported languages.
8768
8769 @menu
8770 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
8771 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
8772 @end menu
8773
8774 @cindex type checking
8775 @cindex checks, type
8776 @node Type Checking
8777 @subsection An overview of type checking
8778
8779 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
8780 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
8781 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
8782 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785 1 + 2 @result{} 3
8786 @exdent but
8787 @error{} 1 + 2.3
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
8791 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
8792
8793 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
8794 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
8795 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
8796 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
8797 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
8798 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
8799 also issues a warning.
8800
8801 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
8802 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
8803 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
8804 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
8805 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
8806 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
8807
8808 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
8809 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
8810 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
8811 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
8812 operators. @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for further
8813 details on specific languages.
8814
8815 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
8816
8817 @kindex set check type
8818 @kindex show check type
8819 @table @code
8820 @item set check type auto
8821 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
8822 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8823 each language.
8824
8825 @item set check type on
8826 @itemx set check type off
8827 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8828 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
8829 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
8830 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
8831 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
8832
8833 @item set check type warn
8834 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
8835 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
8836 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
8837 numbers and structures.
8838
8839 @item show type
8840 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
8841 is setting it automatically.
8842 @end table
8843
8844 @cindex range checking
8845 @cindex checks, range
8846 @node Range Checking
8847 @subsection An overview of range checking
8848
8849 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
8850 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
8851 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
8852 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
8853 not exceed the bounds of the array.
8854
8855 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
8856 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
8857 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
8858 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
8859
8860 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
8861 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
8862 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
8863 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
8864 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
8865 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
8866
8867 @smallexample
8868 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
8869 @end smallexample
8870
8871 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
8872 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported languages, ,
8873 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
8874
8875 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
8876
8877 @kindex set check range
8878 @kindex show check range
8879 @table @code
8880 @item set check range auto
8881 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
8882 @xref{Supported languages, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
8883 each language.
8884
8885 @item set check range on
8886 @itemx set check range off
8887 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
8888 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
8889 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
8890 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
8891
8892 @item set check range warn
8893 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
8894 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
8895 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
8896 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
8897 systems).
8898
8899 @item show range
8900 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
8901 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
8902 @end table
8903
8904 @node Supported languages
8905 @section Supported languages
8906
8907 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
8908 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
8909 @c This is false ...
8910 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
8911 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
8912 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
8913 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
8914 language.
8915
8916 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
8917 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
8918 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
8919 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
8920 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
8921 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
8922 language reference or tutorial.
8923
8924 @menu
8925 * C:: C and C@t{++}
8926 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
8927 * Fortran:: Fortran
8928 * Pascal:: Pascal
8929 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
8930 * Ada:: Ada
8931 @end menu
8932
8933 @node C
8934 @subsection C and C@t{++}
8935
8936 @cindex C and C@t{++}
8937 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
8938
8939 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
8940 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
8941 together.
8942
8943 @cindex C@t{++}
8944 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
8945 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
8946 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
8947 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
8948 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
8949 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
8950 compiler (@code{aCC}).
8951
8952 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
8953 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
8954 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
8955 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
8956 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
8957 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
8958
8959 @menu
8960 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
8961 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
8962 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
8963 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
8964 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8965 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
8966 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8967 @end menu
8968
8969 @node C Operators
8970 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
8971
8972 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
8973
8974 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8975 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8976 often defined on groups of types.
8977
8978 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
8979
8980 @itemize @bullet
8981
8982 @item
8983 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
8984 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
8985
8986 @item
8987 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
8988 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
8989
8990 @item
8991 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
8992
8993 @item
8994 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
8995
8996 @end itemize
8997
8998 @noindent
8999 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9000 in order of increasing precedence:
9001
9002 @table @code
9003 @item ,
9004 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
9005 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
9006 expression being the last expression evaluated.
9007
9008 @item =
9009 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
9010 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
9011
9012 @item @var{op}=
9013 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
9014 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
9015 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
9016 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
9017 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
9018
9019 @item ?:
9020 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
9021 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
9022 integral type.
9023
9024 @item ||
9025 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9026
9027 @item &&
9028 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9029
9030 @item |
9031 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9032
9033 @item ^
9034 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
9035
9036 @item &
9037 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
9038
9039 @item ==@r{, }!=
9040 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
9041 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
9042
9043 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
9044 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
9045 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
9046 and non-zero for true.
9047
9048 @item <<@r{, }>>
9049 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
9050
9051 @item @@
9052 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9053
9054 @item +@r{, }-
9055 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
9056 pointer types.
9057
9058 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
9059 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
9060 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
9061 integral types.
9062
9063 @item ++@r{, }--
9064 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
9065 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
9066 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
9067 operation takes place.
9068
9069 @item *
9070 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
9071 @code{++}.
9072
9073 @item &
9074 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
9075
9076 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
9077 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
9078 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
9079 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
9080 stored.
9081
9082 @item -
9083 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
9084 precedence as @code{++}.
9085
9086 @item !
9087 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9088 @code{++}.
9089
9090 @item ~
9091 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
9092 @code{++}.
9093
9094
9095 @item .@r{, }->
9096 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
9097 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
9098 pointer based on the stored type information.
9099 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
9100
9101 @item .*@r{, }->*
9102 Dereferences of pointers to members.
9103
9104 @item []
9105 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
9106 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9107
9108 @item ()
9109 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
9110
9111 @item ::
9112 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
9113 and @code{class} types.
9114
9115 @item ::
9116 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
9117 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
9118 above.
9119 @end table
9120
9121 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
9122 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
9123 predefined meaning.
9124
9125 @menu
9126 * C Constants::
9127 @end menu
9128
9129 @node C Constants
9130 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
9131
9132 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
9133
9134 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
9135 following ways:
9136
9137 @itemize @bullet
9138 @item
9139 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
9140 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
9141 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
9142 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
9143 @code{long} value.
9144
9145 @item
9146 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
9147 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
9148 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
9149 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
9150 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
9151 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
9152 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
9153 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
9154 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
9155 constant.
9156
9157 @item
9158 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
9159 integral equivalents.
9160
9161 @item
9162 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
9163 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
9164 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
9165 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
9166 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
9167 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
9168 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
9169 @samp{\n} for newline.
9170
9171 @item
9172 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
9173 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
9174 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
9175 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
9176 characters.
9177
9178 @item
9179 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
9180 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
9181
9182 @item
9183 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
9184 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
9185 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
9186 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
9187 @end itemize
9188
9189 @menu
9190 * C plus plus expressions::
9191 * C Defaults::
9192 * C Checks::
9193
9194 * Debugging C::
9195 @end menu
9196
9197 @node C plus plus expressions
9198 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
9199
9200 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
9201 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
9202
9203 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
9204 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
9205 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
9206 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
9207 @quotation
9208 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
9209 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
9210 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
9211 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
9212 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
9213 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
9214 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
9215 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
9216 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
9217 C@t{++} code.
9218 @end quotation
9219
9220 @enumerate
9221
9222 @cindex member functions
9223 @item
9224 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
9225
9226 @smallexample
9227 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
9228 @end smallexample
9229
9230 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
9231 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
9232 @item
9233 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
9234 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
9235 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
9236 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
9237
9238 @cindex call overloaded functions
9239 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
9240 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
9241 @item
9242 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
9243 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
9244 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
9245 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
9246 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
9247 default arguments.
9248
9249 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
9250 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
9251 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
9252 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
9253 number of function arguments.
9254
9255 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
9256 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
9257 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
9258
9259 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
9260 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
9261 @smallexample
9262 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
9263 @end smallexample
9264
9265 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
9266 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
9267
9268 @cindex reference declarations
9269 @item
9270 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
9271 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
9272 dereferenced.
9273
9274 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
9275 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
9276 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
9277 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
9278 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
9279
9280 @item
9281 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
9282 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
9283 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
9284 necessary, for example in an expression like
9285 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
9286 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
9287 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
9288 @end enumerate
9289
9290 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
9291 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
9292 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
9293 invoking user-defined operators.
9294
9295 @node C Defaults
9296 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
9297
9298 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
9299
9300 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
9301 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
9302 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
9303 selects the working language.
9304
9305 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
9306 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
9307 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
9308 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
9309 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
9310 for further details.
9311
9312 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
9313 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
9314 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
9315
9316 @node C Checks
9317 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9318
9319 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
9320
9321 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
9322 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
9323 considers two variables type equivalent if:
9324
9325 @itemize @bullet
9326 @item
9327 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
9328 enumerated tag.
9329
9330 @item
9331 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
9332 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
9333
9334 @ignore
9335 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
9336 @c FIXME--beers?
9337 @item
9338 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
9339 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
9340 compilers.)
9341 @end ignore
9342 @end itemize
9343
9344 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
9345 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
9346 that is not itself an array.
9347
9348 @node Debugging C
9349 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
9350
9351 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
9352 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
9353 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
9354 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
9355
9356 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
9357 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
9358 ,Expressions}.
9359
9360 @menu
9361 * Debugging C plus plus::
9362 @end menu
9363
9364 @node Debugging C plus plus
9365 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9366
9367 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
9368
9369 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
9370 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
9371
9372 @table @code
9373 @cindex break in overloaded functions
9374 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
9375 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
9376 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
9377 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
9378
9379 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
9380 @item rbreak @var{regex}
9381 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
9382 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
9383 classes.
9384 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
9385
9386 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
9387 @item catch throw
9388 @itemx catch catch
9389 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
9390 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
9391
9392 @cindex inheritance
9393 @item ptype @var{typename}
9394 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
9395 @var{typename}.
9396 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
9397
9398 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
9399 @item set print demangle
9400 @itemx show print demangle
9401 @itemx set print asm-demangle
9402 @itemx show print asm-demangle
9403 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
9404 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
9405 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9406
9407 @item set print object
9408 @itemx show print object
9409 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
9410 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9411
9412 @item set print vtbl
9413 @itemx show print vtbl
9414 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
9415 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
9416 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9417 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9418
9419 @kindex set overload-resolution
9420 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
9421 @item set overload-resolution on
9422 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
9423 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
9424 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
9425 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
9426 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
9427 message.
9428
9429 @item set overload-resolution off
9430 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
9431 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9432 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
9433 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
9434 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
9435 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
9436 argument types.
9437
9438 @kindex show overload-resolution
9439 @item show overload-resolution
9440 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
9441
9442 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
9443 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
9444 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
9445 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
9446 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
9447 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
9448 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
9449 @end table
9450
9451 @node Objective-C
9452 @subsection Objective-C
9453
9454 @cindex Objective-C
9455 This section provides information about some commands and command
9456 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
9457 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
9458 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
9459
9460 @menu
9461 * Method Names in Commands::
9462 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
9463 @end menu
9464
9465 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
9466 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
9467
9468 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
9469 names as line specifications:
9470
9471 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
9472 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
9473 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
9474 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
9475 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
9476 @itemize
9477 @item @code{clear}
9478 @item @code{break}
9479 @item @code{info line}
9480 @item @code{jump}
9481 @item @code{list}
9482 @end itemize
9483
9484 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
9485
9486 @smallexample
9487 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
9488 @end smallexample
9489
9490 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
9491 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
9492 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
9493 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
9494 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
9495 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
9496 debugged, enter:
9497
9498 @smallexample
9499 break -[Fruit create]
9500 @end smallexample
9501
9502 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
9503 enter:
9504
9505 @smallexample
9506 list +[NSText initialize]
9507 @end smallexample
9508
9509 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
9510 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
9511 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
9512 is also possible to specify just a method name:
9513
9514 @smallexample
9515 break create
9516 @end smallexample
9517
9518 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
9519 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
9520 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
9521 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
9522 none apply.
9523
9524 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
9525 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
9526
9527 @smallexample
9528 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
9529 @end smallexample
9530
9531 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
9532 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
9533 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
9534 @kindex print-object
9535 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
9536
9537 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
9538
9539 @smallexample
9540 print -[@var{object} hash]
9541 @end smallexample
9542
9543 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
9544 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
9545 @noindent
9546 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
9547 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
9548 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
9549 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
9550 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
9551 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
9552
9553 @node Fortran
9554 @subsection Fortran
9555 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
9556
9557 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
9558 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
9559
9560 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
9561 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
9562 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
9563 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
9564 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
9565 underscore.
9566
9567 @menu
9568 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
9569 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
9570 * Special Fortran commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
9571 @end menu
9572
9573 @node Fortran Operators
9574 @subsubsection Fortran operators and expressions
9575
9576 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
9577
9578 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9579 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
9580 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
9581
9582 @table @code
9583 @item **
9584 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
9585 of the second one.
9586
9587 @item :
9588 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
9589 represent a section of array.
9590 @end table
9591
9592 @node Fortran Defaults
9593 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
9594
9595 @cindex Fortran Defaults
9596
9597 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
9598 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
9599 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
9600 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
9601
9602 @node Special Fortran commands
9603 @subsubsection Special Fortran commands
9604
9605 @cindex Special Fortran commands
9606
9607 @value{GDBN} had some commands to support Fortran specific feature,
9608 such as common block displaying.
9609
9610 @table @code
9611 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
9612 @kindex info common
9613 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
9614 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
9615 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
9616 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at current program location are
9617 printed.
9618 @end table
9619
9620 @node Pascal
9621 @subsection Pascal
9622
9623 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
9624 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
9625 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
9626 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
9627 syntax.
9628
9629 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
9630 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
9631 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
9632
9633 @node Modula-2
9634 @subsection Modula-2
9635
9636 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
9637
9638 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
9639 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
9640 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
9641 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
9642 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
9643 table.
9644
9645 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
9646 @menu
9647 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
9648 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
9649 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
9650 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
9651 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
9652 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
9653 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
9654 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
9655 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
9656 @end menu
9657
9658 @node M2 Operators
9659 @subsubsection Operators
9660 @cindex Modula-2 operators
9661
9662 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9663 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9664 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
9665 following definitions hold:
9666
9667 @itemize @bullet
9668
9669 @item
9670 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
9671 their subranges.
9672
9673 @item
9674 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
9675
9676 @item
9677 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
9678
9679 @item
9680 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
9681 @var{type}}.
9682
9683 @item
9684 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
9685
9686 @item
9687 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
9688
9689 @item
9690 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
9691 @end itemize
9692
9693 @noindent
9694 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
9695 increasing precedence:
9696
9697 @table @code
9698 @item ,
9699 Function argument or array index separator.
9700
9701 @item :=
9702 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
9703 @var{value}.
9704
9705 @item <@r{, }>
9706 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
9707 types.
9708
9709 @item <=@r{, }>=
9710 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
9711 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
9712 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
9713
9714 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
9715 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
9716 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
9717 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
9718 comment character.
9719
9720 @item IN
9721 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
9722 Same precedence as @code{<}.
9723
9724 @item OR
9725 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9726
9727 @item AND@r{, }&
9728 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
9729
9730 @item @@
9731 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
9732
9733 @item +@r{, }-
9734 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
9735 and difference on set types.
9736
9737 @item *
9738 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
9739 on set types.
9740
9741 @item /
9742 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
9743 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
9744
9745 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
9746 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
9747 precedence as @code{*}.
9748
9749 @item -
9750 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
9751
9752 @item ^
9753 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
9754
9755 @item NOT
9756 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
9757 @code{^}.
9758
9759 @item .
9760 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
9761 precedence as @code{^}.
9762
9763 @item []
9764 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
9765
9766 @item ()
9767 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
9768 as @code{^}.
9769
9770 @item ::@r{, }.
9771 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
9772 @end table
9773
9774 @quotation
9775 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
9776 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
9777 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
9778 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
9779 @end quotation
9780
9781
9782 @node Built-In Func/Proc
9783 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
9784 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
9785
9786 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
9787 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
9788
9789 @table @var
9790
9791 @item a
9792 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
9793
9794 @item c
9795 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
9796
9797 @item i
9798 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
9799
9800 @item m
9801 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
9802 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
9803 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
9804
9805 @item n
9806 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
9807
9808 @item r
9809 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
9810
9811 @item t
9812 represents a type.
9813
9814 @item v
9815 represents a variable.
9816
9817 @item x
9818 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
9819 explanation of the function for details.
9820 @end table
9821
9822 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
9823
9824 @table @code
9825 @item ABS(@var{n})
9826 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
9827
9828 @item CAP(@var{c})
9829 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
9830 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
9831
9832 @item CHR(@var{i})
9833 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9834
9835 @item DEC(@var{v})
9836 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9837
9838 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
9839 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9840 new value.
9841
9842 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9843 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
9844 set.
9845
9846 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
9847 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
9848
9849 @item HIGH(@var{a})
9850 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
9851
9852 @item INC(@var{v})
9853 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
9854
9855 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
9856 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
9857 new value.
9858
9859 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
9860 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
9861 there. Returns the new set.
9862
9863 @item MAX(@var{t})
9864 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
9865
9866 @item MIN(@var{t})
9867 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
9868
9869 @item ODD(@var{i})
9870 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
9871
9872 @item ORD(@var{x})
9873 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
9874 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
9875 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
9876 integral, character and enumerated types.
9877
9878 @item SIZE(@var{x})
9879 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
9880
9881 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
9882 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
9883
9884 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
9885 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
9886 @end table
9887
9888 @quotation
9889 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
9890 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
9891 an error.
9892 @end quotation
9893
9894 @cindex Modula-2 constants
9895 @node M2 Constants
9896 @subsubsection Constants
9897
9898 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
9899 ways:
9900
9901 @itemize @bullet
9902
9903 @item
9904 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
9905 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
9906 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
9907 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
9908
9909 @item
9910 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
9911 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
9912 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
9913 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
9914 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
9915 digits.
9916
9917 @item
9918 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
9919 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
9920 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
9921 followed by a @samp{C}.
9922
9923 @item
9924 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
9925 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
9926 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
9927 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
9928 sequences.
9929
9930 @item
9931 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
9932
9933 @item
9934 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
9935 @code{FALSE}.
9936
9937 @item
9938 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
9939
9940 @item
9941 Set constants are not yet supported.
9942 @end itemize
9943
9944 @node M2 Types
9945 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
9946 @cindex Modula-2 types
9947
9948 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
9949 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
9950 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
9951 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
9952 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
9953 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
9954
9955 The first example contains the following section of code:
9956
9957 @smallexample
9958 VAR
9959 s: SET OF CHAR ;
9960 r: [20..40] ;
9961 @end smallexample
9962
9963 @noindent
9964 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
9965 @code{r} and @code{s}.
9966
9967 @smallexample
9968 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9969 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
9970 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9971 SET OF CHAR
9972 (@value{GDBP}) print r
9973 21
9974 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
9975 [20..40]
9976 @end smallexample
9977
9978 @noindent
9979 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
9980
9981 @smallexample
9982 VAR
9983 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
9984 @end smallexample
9985
9986 @noindent
9987 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
9988
9989 @smallexample
9990 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
9991 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
9992 @end smallexample
9993
9994 @noindent
9995 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
9996 expressions using the debugger.
9997
9998 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
9999 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
10000
10001 @smallexample
10002 VAR
10003 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
10004 @end smallexample
10005
10006 @smallexample
10007 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10008 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
10009 @end smallexample
10010
10011 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
10012 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
10013 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
10014 above. Unbounded arrays are also not yet recognized in @value{GDBN}.
10015
10016 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
10017
10018 @smallexample
10019 TYPE
10020 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
10021 t = [blue..yellow] ;
10022 VAR
10023 s: t ;
10024 BEGIN
10025 s := blue ;
10026 @end smallexample
10027
10028 @noindent
10029 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
10030 and value of a variable.
10031
10032 @smallexample
10033 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10034 $1 = blue
10035 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
10036 type = [blue..yellow]
10037 @end smallexample
10038
10039 @noindent
10040 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
10041 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
10042 their @code{C} counterparts.
10043
10044 @smallexample
10045 VAR
10046 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10047 BEGIN
10048 s[1] := 1 ;
10049 @end smallexample
10050
10051 @smallexample
10052 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10053 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
10054 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10055 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10056 @end smallexample
10057
10058 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
10059 pointer types as shown in this example:
10060
10061 @smallexample
10062 VAR
10063 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
10064 BEGIN
10065 NEW(s) ;
10066 s^[1] := 1 ;
10067 @end smallexample
10068
10069 @noindent
10070 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
10071
10072 @smallexample
10073 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10074 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
10075 @end smallexample
10076
10077 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
10078 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
10079 types:
10080
10081 @smallexample
10082 TYPE
10083 foo = RECORD
10084 f1: CARDINAL ;
10085 f2: CHAR ;
10086 f3: myarray ;
10087 END ;
10088
10089 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
10090 myrange = [-2..2] ;
10091 VAR
10092 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 @noindent
10096 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
10097 below.
10098
10099 @smallexample
10100 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10101 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
10102 f1 : CARDINAL;
10103 f2 : CHAR;
10104 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
10105 END
10106 @end smallexample
10107
10108 @node M2 Defaults
10109 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
10110 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
10111
10112 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
10113 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
10114 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10115 selected the working language.
10116
10117 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
10118 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
10119 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
10120 the language automatically}, for further details.
10121
10122 @node Deviations
10123 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
10124 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
10125
10126 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
10127 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
10128
10129 @itemize @bullet
10130 @item
10131 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
10132 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
10133 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
10134 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
10135 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
10136 returned a pointer.)
10137
10138 @item
10139 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
10140 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
10141 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
10142 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
10143
10144 @item
10145 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
10146 argument.
10147
10148 @item
10149 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
10150 @end itemize
10151
10152 @node M2 Checks
10153 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
10154 @cindex Modula-2 checks
10155
10156 @quotation
10157 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
10158 range checking.
10159 @end quotation
10160 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
10161
10162 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
10163
10164 @itemize @bullet
10165 @item
10166 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
10167 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
10168
10169 @item
10170 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
10171 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
10172 @end itemize
10173
10174 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
10175 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
10176
10177 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
10178 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
10179
10180 @node M2 Scope
10181 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10182 @cindex scope
10183 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
10184 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
10185 @ifinfo
10186 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
10187 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
10188 @end ifinfo
10189 @iftex
10190 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
10191 @end iftex
10192
10193 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
10194 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
10195 similar syntax:
10196
10197 @smallexample
10198
10199 @var{module} . @var{id}
10200 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
10201 @end smallexample
10202
10203 @noindent
10204 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
10205 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
10206 identifier within your program, except another module.
10207
10208 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
10209 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
10210 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
10211 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
10212
10213 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
10214 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
10215 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
10216 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
10217 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
10218 @var{module}.
10219
10220 @node GDB/M2
10221 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10222
10223 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
10224 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
10225 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
10226 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
10227 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
10228 analogue in Modula-2.
10229
10230 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
10231 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
10232 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
10233 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
10234 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
10235 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
10236
10237 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
10238 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
10239 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
10240
10241 @node Ada
10242 @subsection Ada
10243 @cindex Ada
10244
10245 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
10246 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
10247 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
10248 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10249 to be difficult.
10250
10251
10252 @cindex expressions in Ada
10253 @menu
10254 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
10255 and semantics supported by Ada mode
10256 in @value{GDBN}.
10257 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
10258 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
10259 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
10260 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
10261 @end menu
10262
10263 @node Ada Mode Intro
10264 @subsubsection Introduction
10265 @cindex Ada mode, general
10266
10267 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
10268 syntax, with some extensions.
10269 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
10270
10271 @itemize @bullet
10272 @item
10273 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
10274 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
10275 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
10276 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
10277
10278 @item
10279 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
10280 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10281
10282 @item
10283 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
10284 @end itemize
10285
10286 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if there were
10287 implicit @code{with} and @code{use} clauses in effect for all user-written
10288 packages, making it unnecessary to fully qualify most names with
10289 their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes ambiguity,
10290 @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
10291
10292 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
10293 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
10294 was translated from an Ada source file.
10295
10296 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
10297 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
10298 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
10299 middle (to allow based literals).
10300
10301 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
10302 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
10303 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
10304 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
10305 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
10306 functions to procedures elsewhere.
10307
10308 @node Omissions from Ada
10309 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
10310 @cindex Ada, omissions from
10311
10312 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
10313
10314 @itemize @bullet
10315 @item
10316 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
10317
10318 @itemize @minus
10319 @item
10320 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
10321 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
10322
10323 @item
10324 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
10325
10326 @item
10327 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
10328
10329 @item
10330 @t{'Tag}.
10331
10332 @item
10333 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
10334 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
10335
10336 @item
10337 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
10338 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
10339
10340 @item
10341 @t{'Address}.
10342 @end itemize
10343
10344 @item
10345 The names in
10346 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
10347 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
10348 not currently available.
10349
10350 @item
10351 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
10352 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
10353 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
10354 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
10355 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
10356 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
10357 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
10358 indeterminate values.
10359
10360 @item
10361 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
10362 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
10363 are not implemented.
10364
10365 @item
10366 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
10367 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
10368 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
10369 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
10370 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
10371
10372 @smallexample
10373 set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
10374 set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
10375 set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
10376 set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
10377 set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
10378 set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
10379 @end smallexample
10380
10381 Changing a
10382 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
10383 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
10384 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
10385 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
10386 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
10387 declared to have a type such as:
10388
10389 @smallexample
10390 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
10391 Id : Integer;
10392 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
10393 end record;
10394 @end smallexample
10395
10396 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
10397 assignments:
10398
10399 @smallexample
10400 set A_Rec.Len := 4
10401 set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
10402 @end smallexample
10403
10404 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
10405 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
10406 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
10407 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
10408 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
10409 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
10410 redundant component associations, although which component values are
10411 assigned in such cases is not defined.
10412
10413 @item
10414 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
10415
10416 @item
10417 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
10418 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in which a subexpression
10419 appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much looser in its rules for allowing
10420 type matches. As a result, some function calls will be ambiguous, and the user
10421 will be asked to choose the proper resolution.
10422
10423 @item
10424 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
10425
10426 @item
10427 Entry calls are not implemented.
10428
10429 @item
10430 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
10431 formats are not supported.
10432
10433 @item
10434 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
10435 @end itemize
10436
10437 @node Additions to Ada
10438 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
10439 @cindex Ada, deviations from
10440
10441 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
10442 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
10443
10444 @itemize @bullet
10445 @item
10446 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory
10447 (typically a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is
10448 a positive integer, then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of
10449 @var{E} and the @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array.
10450 In Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use
10451 is in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in Ada.
10452 However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs
10453 in which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
10454
10455 @item
10456 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that appears
10457 in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name, you must typically
10458 surround it in single quotes.
10459
10460 @item
10461 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
10462 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
10463
10464 @item
10465 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
10466 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
10467 @end itemize
10468
10469 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright additions specific
10470 to Ada:
10471
10472 @itemize @bullet
10473 @item
10474 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
10475 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
10476
10477 @smallexample
10478 set x := y + 3
10479 print A(tmp := y + 1)
10480 @end smallexample
10481
10482 @item
10483 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
10484 the value of its right-hand operand.
10485 This allows, for example,
10486 complex conditional breaks:
10487
10488 @smallexample
10489 break f
10490 condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
10491 @end smallexample
10492
10493 @item
10494 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
10495 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
10496 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
10497 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
10498 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
10499 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
10500 in strings. For example,
10501 @smallexample
10502 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
10503 @end smallexample
10504 @noindent
10505 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF}) after each
10506 period.
10507
10508 @item
10509 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
10510 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
10511 to write
10512
10513 @smallexample
10514 print 'max(x, y)
10515 @end smallexample
10516
10517 @item
10518 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
10519 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
10520 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound of 3 might print as
10521
10522 @smallexample
10523 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
10524 @end smallexample
10525
10526 @noindent
10527 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
10528 clause.
10529
10530 @item
10531 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
10532 multi-character subsequence of
10533 their names (an exact match gets preference).
10534 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
10535 in place of @t{a'length}.
10536
10537 @item
10538 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
10539 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
10540 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
10541 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
10542 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
10543 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
10544 For example,
10545 @smallexample
10546 @value{GDBP} print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
10547 @end smallexample
10548
10549 @item
10550 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
10551 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
10552 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
10553 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
10554 object.
10555
10556 @end itemize
10557
10558 @node Stopping Before Main Program
10559 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
10560
10561 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
10562 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
10563 before reaching the main procedure.
10564 As defined in the Ada Reference
10565 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
10566 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
10567 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
10568 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
10569
10570 @node Ada Glitches
10571 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
10572 @cindex Ada, problems
10573
10574 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
10575 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
10576 @value{GDBN},
10577 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
10578 and the GNU Ada compiler.
10579
10580 @itemize @bullet
10581 @item
10582 Currently, the debugger
10583 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
10584 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
10585 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
10586 to get it printed properly.
10587
10588 @item
10589 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
10590 storage are invisible to the debugger.
10591
10592 @item
10593 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
10594 argument lists are treated as positional).
10595
10596 @item
10597 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
10598
10599 @item
10600 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
10601 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
10602 the host machine.
10603
10604 @item
10605 The type of the @t{'Address} attribute may not be @code{System.Address}.
10606
10607 @item
10608 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
10609 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
10610 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
10611 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
10612 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
10613 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
10614 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
10615 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
10616 you can usually resolve the confusion
10617 by qualifying the problematic names with package
10618 @code{Standard} explicitly.
10619 @end itemize
10620
10621 @node Unsupported languages
10622 @section Unsupported languages
10623
10624 @cindex unsupported languages
10625 @cindex minimal language
10626 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
10627 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
10628 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
10629 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
10630 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
10631 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
10632
10633 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
10634 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
10635 language.
10636
10637 @node Symbols
10638 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
10639
10640 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
10641 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
10642 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
10643 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
10644 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
10645 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
10646 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10647
10648 @cindex symbol names
10649 @cindex names of symbols
10650 @cindex quoting names
10651 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
10652 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
10653 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
10654 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
10655 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
10656 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
10657 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
10658 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
10659
10660 @smallexample
10661 p 'foo.c'::x
10662 @end smallexample
10663
10664 @noindent
10665 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
10666
10667 @table @code
10668 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
10669 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
10670 @kindex set case-sensitive
10671 @item set case-sensitive on
10672 @itemx set case-sensitive off
10673 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
10674 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
10675 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
10676 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
10677 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
10678 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
10679 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
10680 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
10681 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
10682 case-insensitive matches.
10683
10684 @kindex show case-sensitive
10685 @item show case-sensitive
10686 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
10687 lookups.
10688
10689 @kindex info address
10690 @cindex address of a symbol
10691 @item info address @var{symbol}
10692 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
10693 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
10694 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
10695 is always stored.
10696
10697 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
10698 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
10699 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
10700
10701 @kindex info symbol
10702 @cindex symbol from address
10703 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
10704 @item info symbol @var{addr}
10705 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
10706 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
10707 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
10708
10709 @smallexample
10710 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
10711 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
10712 @end smallexample
10713
10714 @noindent
10715 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
10716 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
10717
10718 @kindex whatis
10719 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
10720 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
10721 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
10722 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
10723 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
10724 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
10725 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
10726 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
10727 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
10728 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
10729 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10730
10731 @kindex ptype
10732 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
10733 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
10734 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
10735 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10736
10737 For example, for this variable declaration:
10738
10739 @smallexample
10740 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
10741 @end smallexample
10742
10743 @noindent
10744 the two commands give this output:
10745
10746 @smallexample
10747 @group
10748 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
10749 type = struct complex
10750 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
10751 type = struct complex @{
10752 double real;
10753 double imag;
10754 @}
10755 @end group
10756 @end smallexample
10757
10758 @noindent
10759 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
10760 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
10761
10762 @cindex incomplete type
10763 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
10764 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
10765 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
10766 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
10767 given these declarations:
10768
10769 @smallexample
10770 struct foo;
10771 struct foo *fooptr;
10772 @end smallexample
10773
10774 @noindent
10775 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
10776
10777 @smallexample
10778 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
10779 $1 = <incomplete type>
10780 @end smallexample
10781
10782 @noindent
10783 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
10784 completely specified.
10785
10786 @kindex info types
10787 @item info types @var{regexp}
10788 @itemx info types
10789 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
10790 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
10791 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
10792 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
10793 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
10794 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
10795 name is @code{value}.
10796
10797 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
10798 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
10799 lists all source files where a type is defined.
10800
10801 @kindex info scope
10802 @cindex local variables
10803 @item info scope @var{location}
10804 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
10805 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
10806 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
10807 to the scope defined by that location. For example:
10808
10809 @smallexample
10810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
10811 Scope for command_line_handler:
10812 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
10813 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
10814 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
10815 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
10816 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
10817 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
10818 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
10819 @end smallexample
10820
10821 @noindent
10822 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
10823 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
10824 collect}.
10825
10826 @kindex info source
10827 @item info source
10828 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
10829 the function containing the current point of execution:
10830 @itemize @bullet
10831 @item
10832 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
10833 @item
10834 the directory it was compiled in,
10835 @item
10836 its length, in lines,
10837 @item
10838 which programming language it is written in,
10839 @item
10840 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
10841 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
10842 @item
10843 whether the debugging information includes information about
10844 preprocessor macros.
10845 @end itemize
10846
10847
10848 @kindex info sources
10849 @item info sources
10850 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
10851 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
10852 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
10853
10854 @kindex info functions
10855 @item info functions
10856 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
10857
10858 @item info functions @var{regexp}
10859 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
10860 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
10861 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
10862 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
10863 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
10864 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
10865 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
10866
10867 @kindex info variables
10868 @item info variables
10869 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
10870 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
10871
10872 @item info variables @var{regexp}
10873 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
10874 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
10875 @var{regexp}.
10876
10877 @kindex info classes
10878 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
10879 @item info classes
10880 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
10881 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
10882 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10883 expression.
10884
10885 @kindex info selectors
10886 @item info selectors
10887 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
10888 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
10889 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
10890 expression.
10891
10892 @ignore
10893 This was never implemented.
10894 @kindex info methods
10895 @item info methods
10896 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
10897 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
10898 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
10899 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
10900 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
10901 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
10902 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
10903 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
10904 @end ignore
10905
10906 @cindex reloading symbols
10907 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
10908 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
10909 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
10910 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
10911 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
10912
10913 @table @code
10914 @kindex set symbol-reloading
10915 @item set symbol-reloading on
10916 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
10917 object file with a particular name is seen again.
10918
10919 @item set symbol-reloading off
10920 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
10921 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
10922 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
10923 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
10924 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
10925 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
10926 name.
10927
10928 @kindex show symbol-reloading
10929 @item show symbol-reloading
10930 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
10931 @end table
10932
10933 @cindex opaque data types
10934 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
10935 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
10936 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
10937 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
10938 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
10939 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
10940 another source file. The default is on.
10941
10942 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
10943 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
10944
10945 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
10946 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
10947 is printed as follows:
10948 @smallexample
10949 @{<no data fields>@}
10950 @end smallexample
10951
10952 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
10953 @item show opaque-type-resolution
10954 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
10955
10956 @kindex maint print symbols
10957 @cindex symbol dump
10958 @kindex maint print psymbols
10959 @cindex partial symbol dump
10960 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
10961 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
10962 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
10963 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
10964 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
10965 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
10966 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
10967 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
10968 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
10969 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
10970 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
10971 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
10972 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
10973 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
10974 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
10975 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
10976 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
10977
10978 @kindex maint info symtabs
10979 @kindex maint info psymtabs
10980 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
10981 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10982 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10983 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
10984 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10985 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
10986
10987 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
10988 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
10989 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
10990 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
10991 structure in more detail. For example:
10992
10993 @smallexample
10994 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
10995 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
10996 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
10997 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
10998 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
10999 readin no
11000 fullname (null)
11001 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
11002 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
11003 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
11004 dependencies (none)
11005 @}
11006 @}
11007 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11008 (@value{GDBP})
11009 @end smallexample
11010 @noindent
11011 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
11012 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
11013 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
11014 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
11015 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
11016
11017 @smallexample
11018 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
11019 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
11020 line 1574.
11021 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
11022 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
11023 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
11024 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
11025 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
11026 dirname (null)
11027 fullname (null)
11028 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
11029 debugformat DWARF 2
11030 @}
11031 @}
11032 (@value{GDBP})
11033 @end smallexample
11034 @end table
11035
11036
11037 @node Altering
11038 @chapter Altering Execution
11039
11040 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
11041 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
11042 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
11043 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
11044 program.
11045
11046 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
11047 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
11048 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
11049
11050 @menu
11051 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
11052 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
11053 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
11054 * Returning:: Returning from a function
11055 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
11056 * Patching:: Patching your program
11057 @end menu
11058
11059 @node Assignment
11060 @section Assignment to variables
11061
11062 @cindex assignment
11063 @cindex setting variables
11064 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
11065 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
11066
11067 @smallexample
11068 print x=4
11069 @end smallexample
11070
11071 @noindent
11072 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
11073 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
11074 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
11075 information on operators in supported languages.
11076
11077 @kindex set variable
11078 @cindex variables, setting
11079 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
11080 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
11081 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
11082 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
11083 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
11084
11085 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
11086 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
11087 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
11088 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
11089 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
11090 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
11091 command @code{set width}:
11092
11093 @smallexample
11094 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
11095 type = double
11096 (@value{GDBP}) p width
11097 $4 = 13
11098 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
11099 Invalid syntax in expression.
11100 @end smallexample
11101
11102 @noindent
11103 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
11104 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
11105
11106 @smallexample
11107 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
11108 @end smallexample
11109
11110 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
11111 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
11112 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
11113 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
11114 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
11115 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
11116
11117 @smallexample
11118 @group
11119 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
11120 type = double
11121 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11122 $1 = 1
11123 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
11124 (@value{GDBP}) p g
11125 $2 = 1
11126 (@value{GDBP}) r
11127 The program being debugged has been started already.
11128 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
11129 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
11130 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
11131 Invalid bfd target.
11132 (@value{GDBP}) show g
11133 The current BFD target is "=4".
11134 @end group
11135 @end smallexample
11136
11137 @noindent
11138 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
11139 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
11140 @code{g}, use
11141
11142 @smallexample
11143 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
11144 @end smallexample
11145
11146 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
11147 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
11148 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
11149 same length or shorter.
11150 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
11151 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
11152
11153 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
11154 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
11155 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
11156 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
11157 and representation in memory), and
11158
11159 @smallexample
11160 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
11161 @end smallexample
11162
11163 @noindent
11164 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
11165
11166 @node Jumping
11167 @section Continuing at a different address
11168
11169 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
11170 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
11171 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
11172
11173 @table @code
11174 @kindex jump
11175 @item jump @var{linespec}
11176 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
11177 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
11178 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
11179 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
11180 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
11181 breakpoints}.
11182
11183 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
11184 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
11185 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
11186 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
11187 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
11188 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
11189 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
11190 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
11191 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
11192
11193 @item jump *@var{address}
11194 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
11195 @end table
11196
11197 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
11198 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
11199 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
11200 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
11201 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
11202 example,
11203
11204 @smallexample
11205 set $pc = 0x485
11206 @end smallexample
11207
11208 @noindent
11209 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
11210 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
11211 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
11212
11213 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
11214 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
11215 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
11216 detail.
11217
11218 @c @group
11219 @node Signaling
11220 @section Giving your program a signal
11221 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
11222
11223 @table @code
11224 @kindex signal
11225 @item signal @var{signal}
11226 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
11227 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
11228 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
11229 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
11230
11231 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
11232 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
11233 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
11234 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
11235 signal.
11236
11237 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
11238 after executing the command.
11239 @end table
11240 @c @end group
11241
11242 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
11243 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
11244 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
11245 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
11246 passes the signal directly to your program.
11247
11248
11249 @node Returning
11250 @section Returning from a function
11251
11252 @table @code
11253 @cindex returning from a function
11254 @kindex return
11255 @item return
11256 @itemx return @var{expression}
11257 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
11258 command. If you give an
11259 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
11260 value.
11261 @end table
11262
11263 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
11264 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
11265 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
11266 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
11267
11268 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
11269 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
11270 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
11271 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
11272 of functions.
11273
11274 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
11275 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
11276 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
11277 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
11278 selected stack frame returns naturally.
11279
11280 @node Calling
11281 @section Calling program functions
11282
11283 @table @code
11284 @cindex calling functions
11285 @cindex inferior functions, calling
11286 @item print @var{expr}
11287 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resuling value.
11288 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
11289 debugged.
11290
11291 @kindex call
11292 @item call @var{expr}
11293 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
11294 returned values.
11295
11296 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
11297 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
11298 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
11299 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
11300 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
11301 value history.
11302 @end table
11303
11304 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
11305 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
11306 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
11307 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
11308
11309 @table @code
11310 @item set unwindonsignal
11311 @kindex set unwindonsignal
11312 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
11313 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
11314 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
11315 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
11316 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
11317 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
11318 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
11319 received.
11320
11321 @item show unwindonsignal
11322 @kindex show unwindonsignal
11323 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
11324 @value{GDBN}.
11325 @end table
11326
11327 @cindex weak alias functions
11328 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
11329 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
11330 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
11331 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
11332 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
11333 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
11334 function instead.
11335
11336 @node Patching
11337 @section Patching programs
11338
11339 @cindex patching binaries
11340 @cindex writing into executables
11341 @cindex writing into corefiles
11342
11343 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
11344 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
11345 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
11346 patching your program's binary.
11347
11348 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
11349 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
11350 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
11351 repairs.
11352
11353 @table @code
11354 @kindex set write
11355 @item set write on
11356 @itemx set write off
11357 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
11358 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
11359 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
11360
11361 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
11362 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
11363 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
11364
11365 @item show write
11366 @kindex show write
11367 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
11368 as well as reading.
11369 @end table
11370
11371 @node GDB Files
11372 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
11373
11374 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
11375 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
11376 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
11377 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
11378
11379 @menu
11380 * Files:: Commands to specify files
11381 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
11382 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
11383 @end menu
11384
11385 @node Files
11386 @section Commands to specify files
11387
11388 @cindex symbol table
11389 @cindex core dump file
11390
11391 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
11392 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
11393 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
11394 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
11395
11396 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
11397 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
11398 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
11399 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file}). In these situations the
11400 @value{GDBN} commands to specify new files are useful.
11401
11402 @table @code
11403 @cindex executable file
11404 @kindex file
11405 @item file @var{filename}
11406 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
11407 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
11408 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
11409 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
11410 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
11411 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
11412 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
11413 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
11414
11415 @cindex unlinked object files
11416 @cindex patching object files
11417 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
11418 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
11419 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
11420 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
11421 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
11422 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
11423 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
11424 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
11425
11426 @item file
11427 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
11428 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
11429
11430 @kindex exec-file
11431 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11432 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
11433 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
11434 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
11435 discard information on the executable file.
11436
11437 @kindex symbol-file
11438 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
11439 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
11440 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
11441 table and program to run from the same file.
11442
11443 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
11444 program's symbol table.
11445
11446 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
11447 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
11448 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
11449 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
11450 @value{GDBN}.
11451
11452 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
11453 executing it once.
11454
11455 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
11456 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
11457 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
11458 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
11459 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
11460 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
11461 optimized code.
11462
11463 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
11464 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
11465 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
11466 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
11467 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
11468
11469 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
11470 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
11471 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
11472 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
11473 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
11474 warnings and messages}.)
11475
11476 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
11477 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
11478 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
11479 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
11480 in stabs format.
11481
11482 @kindex readnow
11483 @cindex reading symbols immediately
11484 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
11485 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11486 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11487 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
11488 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
11489 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
11490 entire symbol table available.
11491
11492 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
11493 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
11494 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
11495 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
11496 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
11497 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
11498 @c files.
11499
11500 @kindex core-file
11501 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
11502 @itemx core
11503 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
11504 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
11505 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
11506 executable file itself for other parts.
11507
11508 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
11509 to be used.
11510
11511 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
11512 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
11513 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
11514 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
11515 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
11516
11517 @kindex add-symbol-file
11518 @cindex dynamic linking
11519 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
11520 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
11521 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
11522 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
11523 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
11524 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
11525 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
11526 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
11527 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
11528 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
11529 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
11530 @var{address} as an expression.
11531
11532 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
11533 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
11534 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
11535 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
11536 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
11537
11538 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
11539 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
11540 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
11541 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
11542 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
11543 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
11544 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
11545 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
11546 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
11547
11548 @itemize @bullet
11549 @item
11550 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
11551 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
11552 @item
11553 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
11554 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
11555 @item
11556 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
11557 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
11558 @end itemize
11559
11560 @noindent
11561 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
11562 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
11563 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
11564 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
11565 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
11566 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
11567 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
11568 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
11569 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
11570 way.
11571
11572 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
11573
11574 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
11575 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
11576 @cindex load symbols from memory
11577 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
11578 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
11579 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
11580 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
11581 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
11582 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
11583 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
11584 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
11585 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
11586
11587 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
11588 @kindex assf
11589 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
11590 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
11591 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
11592 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
11593 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
11594 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
11595 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
11596 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
11597 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
11598 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
11599
11600 @kindex section
11601 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
11602 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
11603 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
11604 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
11605 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
11606 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
11607 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
11608 their addresses.
11609
11610 @kindex info files
11611 @kindex info target
11612 @item info files
11613 @itemx info target
11614 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
11615 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
11616 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
11617 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
11618 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
11619 current ones.
11620
11621 @kindex maint info sections
11622 @item maint info sections
11623 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
11624 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
11625 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
11626 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
11627 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
11628 may be arbitrarily combined):
11629
11630 @table @code
11631 @item ALLOBJ
11632 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
11633 @item @var{sections}
11634 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
11635 @item @var{section-flags}
11636 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
11637 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
11638 @table @code
11639 @item ALLOC
11640 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
11641 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
11642 @item LOAD
11643 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
11644 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
11645 @item RELOC
11646 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
11647 @item READONLY
11648 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
11649 @item CODE
11650 Section contains executable code only.
11651 @item DATA
11652 Section contains data only (no executable code).
11653 @item ROM
11654 Section will reside in ROM.
11655 @item CONSTRUCTOR
11656 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
11657 @item HAS_CONTENTS
11658 Section is not empty.
11659 @item NEVER_LOAD
11660 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
11661 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
11662 A notification to the linker that the section contains
11663 COFF shared library information.
11664 @item IS_COMMON
11665 Section contains common symbols.
11666 @end table
11667 @end table
11668 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
11669 @cindex read-only sections
11670 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
11671 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
11672 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
11673 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
11674 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
11675 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
11676 enhancement to debugging performance.
11677
11678 The default is off.
11679
11680 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
11681 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
11682 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
11683 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
11684
11685 @item show trust-readonly-sections
11686 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
11687 @end table
11688
11689 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
11690 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
11691 name and remembers it that way.
11692
11693 @cindex shared libraries
11694 @value{GDBN} supports GNU/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
11695 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
11696
11697 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
11698 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
11699 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
11700 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
11701 debugging a core file).
11702
11703 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
11704 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
11705
11706 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
11707 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
11708 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
11709
11710 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
11711 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
11712 particularly large or there are many of them.
11713
11714 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
11715 commands:
11716
11717 @table @code
11718 @kindex set auto-solib-add
11719 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
11720 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
11721 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
11722 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
11723 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
11724 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
11725 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
11726
11727 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
11728 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
11729 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
11730 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
11731 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
11732 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
11733 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
11734 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expresion that matches
11735 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
11736
11737 @kindex show auto-solib-add
11738 @item show auto-solib-add
11739 Display the current autoloading mode.
11740 @end table
11741
11742 @cindex load shared library
11743 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
11744 command:
11745
11746 @table @code
11747 @kindex info sharedlibrary
11748 @kindex info share
11749 @item info share
11750 @itemx info sharedlibrary
11751 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
11752
11753 @kindex sharedlibrary
11754 @kindex share
11755 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
11756 @itemx share @var{regex}
11757 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
11758 Unix regular expression.
11759 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
11760 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
11761 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
11762 loaded.
11763
11764 @item nosharedlibrary
11765 @kindex nosharedlibrary
11766 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
11767 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
11768 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
11769 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
11770 discarded.
11771 @end table
11772
11773 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
11774 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
11775 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
11776
11777 @table @code
11778 @item set stop-on-solib-events
11779 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
11780 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
11781 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
11782 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
11783 shared library.
11784
11785 @item show stop-on-solib-events
11786 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
11787 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
11788 library events happen.
11789 @end table
11790
11791 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
11792 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
11793 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
11794 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
11795 not.
11796
11797 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
11798 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
11799 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
11800 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
11801 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
11802
11803 @table @code
11804 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
11805 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
11806 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
11807 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
11808 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
11809 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
11810 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
11811 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
11812 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
11813
11814 @cindex default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
11815 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
11816 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
11817 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
11818
11819 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
11820 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
11821 Display the current shared library prefix.
11822
11823 @kindex set solib-search-path
11824 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
11825 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
11826 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
11827 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
11828 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
11829 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
11830 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
11831 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
11832
11833 @kindex show solib-search-path
11834 @item show solib-search-path
11835 Display the current shared library search path.
11836 @end table
11837
11838
11839 @node Separate Debug Files
11840 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
11841 @cindex separate debugging information files
11842 @cindex debugging information in separate files
11843 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
11844 @cindex debugging information directory, global
11845 @cindex global debugging information directory
11846
11847 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
11848 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
11849 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
11850 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
11851 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
11852 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
11853 install only when they need to debug a problem.
11854
11855 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
11856 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
11857 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
11858 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
11859 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
11860 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
11861 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
11862 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
11863 places:
11864
11865 @itemize @bullet
11866 @item
11867 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
11868 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
11869 @item
11870 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
11871 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
11872 @item
11873 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
11874 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
11875 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
11876 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
11877 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
11878 @end itemize
11879 @noindent
11880 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
11881 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
11882 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
11883
11884 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
11885 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
11886 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
11887 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
11888 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
11889 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
11890
11891 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
11892 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
11893
11894 @table @code
11895
11896 @kindex set debug-file-directory
11897 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
11898 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11899 information files to @var{directory}.
11900
11901 @kindex show debug-file-directory
11902 @item show debug-file-directory
11903 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
11904 information files.
11905
11906 @end table
11907
11908 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
11909 @cindex debug links
11910 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
11911 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
11912
11913 @itemize
11914 @item
11915 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
11916 a zero byte,
11917 @item
11918 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
11919 boundary within the section, and
11920 @item
11921 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
11922 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
11923 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
11924 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
11925 @end itemize
11926
11927 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
11928 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
11929 described above.
11930
11931 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
11932 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
11933 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
11934 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
11935 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
11936 in an ordinary executable.
11937
11938 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
11939 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
11940 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
11941 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
11942 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
11943 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
11944 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
11945
11946 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
11947 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
11948 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
11949 complete code for a function that computes it:
11950
11951 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
11952 @smallexample
11953 unsigned long
11954 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
11955 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
11956 @{
11957 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
11958 @{
11959 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
11960 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
11961 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
11962 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
11963 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
11964 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
11965 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
11966 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
11967 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
11968 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
11969 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
11970 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
11971 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
11972 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
11973 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
11974 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
11975 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
11976 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
11977 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
11978 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
11979 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
11980 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
11981 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
11982 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
11983 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
11984 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
11985 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
11986 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
11987 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
11988 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
11989 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
11990 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
11991 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
11992 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
11993 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
11994 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
11995 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
11996 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
11997 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
11998 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
11999 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
12000 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
12001 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
12002 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
12003 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
12004 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
12005 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
12006 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
12007 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
12008 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
12009 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
12010 0x2d02ef8d
12011 @};
12012 unsigned char *end;
12013
12014 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12015 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
12016 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
12017 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
12018 @}
12019 @end smallexample
12020
12021
12022 @node Symbol Errors
12023 @section Errors reading symbol files
12024
12025 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
12026 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
12027 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
12028 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
12029 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
12030 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
12031 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
12032 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
12033 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
12034 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12035 messages}).
12036
12037 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
12038
12039 @table @code
12040 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
12041
12042 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
12043 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
12044 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
12045 in its outer scope blocks.
12046
12047 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
12048 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
12049 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
12050 function.
12051
12052 @item block at @var{address} out of order
12053
12054 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
12055 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
12056 do so.
12057
12058 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
12059 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
12060 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
12061 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
12062 messages}.)
12063
12064 @item bad block start address patched
12065
12066 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
12067 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
12068 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
12069
12070 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
12071 starting on the previous source line.
12072
12073 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
12074
12075 @cindex foo
12076 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
12077 larger than the size of the string table.
12078
12079 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
12080 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
12081 with this name.
12082
12083 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
12084
12085 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
12086 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
12087 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
12088
12089 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
12090 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
12091 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
12092 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
12093 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
12094 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
12095
12096 @item stub type has NULL name
12097
12098 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
12099
12100 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
12101 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
12102 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
12103 it.
12104
12105 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
12106
12107 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
12108
12109 @end table
12110
12111 @node Targets
12112 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
12113
12114 @cindex debugging target
12115 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
12116
12117 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
12118 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
12119 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
12120 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
12121 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
12122 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
12123 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
12124 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
12125
12126 @cindex target architecture
12127 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
12128 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
12129 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
12130 command.
12131
12132 @table @code
12133 @kindex set architecture
12134 @kindex show architecture
12135 @item set architecture @var{arch}
12136 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
12137 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
12138 supported architectures.
12139
12140 @item show architecture
12141 Show the current target architecture.
12142
12143 @item set processor
12144 @itemx processor
12145 @kindex set processor
12146 @kindex show processor
12147 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
12148 and @code{show architecture}.
12149 @end table
12150
12151 @menu
12152 * Active Targets:: Active targets
12153 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
12154 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
12155 * Remote:: Remote debugging
12156
12157 @end menu
12158
12159 @node Active Targets
12160 @section Active targets
12161
12162 @cindex stacking targets
12163 @cindex active targets
12164 @cindex multiple targets
12165
12166 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
12167 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
12168 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
12169 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
12170 a core file.
12171
12172 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
12173 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
12174 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
12175 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
12176 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
12177 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
12178 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
12179 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
12180 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
12181
12182 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
12183 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
12184 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
12185 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
12186 process target is active.
12187
12188 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
12189 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
12190 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
12191 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
12192 process}).
12193
12194 @node Target Commands
12195 @section Commands for managing targets
12196
12197 @table @code
12198 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
12199 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
12200 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
12201 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
12202 protocol of the target machine.
12203
12204 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
12205 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
12206 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
12207
12208 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
12209 after executing the command.
12210
12211 @kindex help target
12212 @item help target
12213 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
12214 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
12215 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
12216
12217 @item help target @var{name}
12218 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
12219 select it.
12220
12221 @kindex set gnutarget
12222 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
12223 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
12224 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
12225 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
12226 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
12227 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
12228
12229 @quotation
12230 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
12231 you must know the actual BFD name.
12232 @end quotation
12233
12234 @noindent
12235 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
12236
12237 @kindex show gnutarget
12238 @item show gnutarget
12239 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
12240 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
12241 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
12242 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
12243 @end table
12244
12245 @cindex common targets
12246 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
12247 configuration):
12248
12249 @table @code
12250 @kindex target
12251 @item target exec @var{program}
12252 @cindex executable file target
12253 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
12254 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
12255
12256 @item target core @var{filename}
12257 @cindex core dump file target
12258 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
12259 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
12260
12261 @item target remote @var{medium}
12262 @cindex remote target
12263 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
12264 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
12265 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
12266
12267 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
12268 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
12269
12270 @smallexample
12271 target remote /dev/ttya
12272 @end smallexample
12273
12274 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
12275 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
12276 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
12277 clobbered by the download.
12278
12279 @item target sim
12280 @cindex built-in simulator target
12281 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
12282 In general,
12283 @smallexample
12284 target sim
12285 load
12286 run
12287 @end smallexample
12288 @noindent
12289 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
12290 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
12291 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
12292 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
12293 Processors}.
12294
12295 @end table
12296
12297 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
12298
12299 @table @code
12300
12301 @item target nrom @var{dev}
12302 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
12303 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
12304
12305 @end table
12306
12307 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
12308 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
12309
12310 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
12311 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
12312 various aspects of this process.
12313
12314 @table @code
12315
12316 @item set hash
12317 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12318 @cindex hash mark while downloading
12319 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
12320 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
12321 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
12322 monitor.
12323
12324 @item show hash
12325 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
12326 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
12327
12328 @item set debug monitor
12329 @kindex set debug monitor
12330 @cindex display remote monitor communications
12331 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
12332 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12333
12334 @item show debug monitor
12335 @kindex show debug monitor
12336 Show the current status of displaying communications between
12337 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
12338 @end table
12339
12340 @table @code
12341
12342 @kindex load @var{filename}
12343 @item load @var{filename}
12344 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
12345 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
12346 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
12347 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
12348 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
12349 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12350
12351 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
12352 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
12353 target is @dots{}}''
12354
12355 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
12356 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
12357 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
12358 specifies a fixed address.
12359 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
12360
12361 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
12362 load programs into flash memory.
12363
12364 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
12365 @end table
12366
12367 @node Byte Order
12368 @section Choosing target byte order
12369
12370 @cindex choosing target byte order
12371 @cindex target byte order
12372
12373 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
12374 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
12375 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
12376 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
12377 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
12378 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
12379
12380 @table @code
12381 @kindex set endian
12382 @item set endian big
12383 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
12384
12385 @item set endian little
12386 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
12387
12388 @item set endian auto
12389 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
12390 executable.
12391
12392 @item show endian
12393 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
12394
12395 @end table
12396
12397 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
12398 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
12399 target system.
12400
12401 @node Remote
12402 @section Remote debugging
12403 @cindex remote debugging
12404
12405 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
12406 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
12407 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
12408 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
12409 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
12410
12411 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
12412 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
12413 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
12414 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
12415 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
12416 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
12417
12418 Other remote targets may be available in your
12419 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
12420
12421 Once you've connected to the remote target, @value{GDBN} allows you to
12422 send arbitrary commands to the remote monitor:
12423
12424 @table @code
12425 @item remote @var{command}
12426 @kindex remote@r{, a command}
12427 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12428 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the remote monitor.
12429 @end table
12430
12431
12432 @node Remote Debugging
12433 @chapter Debugging remote programs
12434
12435 @menu
12436 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
12437 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
12438 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
12439 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
12440 @end menu
12441
12442 @node Connecting
12443 @section Connecting to a remote target
12444
12445 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
12446 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
12447 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
12448 program as the first argument.
12449
12450 @cindex @code{target remote}
12451 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
12452 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
12453 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
12454 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
12455 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
12456 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
12457
12458 @table @code
12459
12460 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
12461 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
12462 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
12463 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
12464
12465 @smallexample
12466 target remote /dev/ttyb
12467 @end smallexample
12468
12469 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
12470 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
12471 (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
12472 @code{target} command.
12473
12474 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
12475 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12476 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
12477 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
12478 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
12479 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
12480 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
12481 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
12482 target.
12483
12484 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
12485 @code{manyfarms}:
12486
12487 @smallexample
12488 target remote manyfarms:2828
12489 @end smallexample
12490
12491 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
12492 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
12493 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
12494 port 1234 on your local machine:
12495
12496 @smallexample
12497 target remote :1234
12498 @end smallexample
12499 @noindent
12500
12501 Note that the colon is still required here.
12502
12503 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
12504 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
12505 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
12506 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
12507
12508 @smallexample
12509 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
12510 @end smallexample
12511
12512 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
12513 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
12514 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
12515 cause havoc with your debugging session.
12516
12517 @item target remote | @var{command}
12518 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
12519 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
12520 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
12521 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
12522 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
12523 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
12524 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
12525 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
12526
12527 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
12528 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
12529 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
12530
12531 @end table
12532
12533 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
12534 commands to examine and change data and to step and continue the
12535 remote program.
12536
12537 @cindex interrupting remote programs
12538 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
12539 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
12540 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
12541 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
12542 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
12543 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
12544
12545 @smallexample
12546 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
12547 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
12548 @end smallexample
12549
12550 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
12551 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
12552 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
12553 goes back to waiting.
12554
12555 @table @code
12556 @kindex detach (remote)
12557 @item detach
12558 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
12559 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
12560 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
12561 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
12562 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
12563
12564 @kindex disconnect
12565 @item disconnect
12566 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
12567 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
12568 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
12569 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
12570 another target.
12571
12572 @cindex send command to remote monitor
12573 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
12574 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
12575 @kindex monitor
12576 @item monitor @var{cmd}
12577 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
12578 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
12579 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
12580 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
12581 and implement.
12582 @end table
12583
12584 @node Server
12585 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
12586
12587 @kindex gdbserver
12588 @cindex remote connection without stubs
12589 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
12590 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
12591 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
12592
12593 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
12594 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
12595 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
12596 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
12597 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
12598 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
12599 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
12600 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
12601 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
12602 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
12603 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
12604 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
12605 choice for debugging.
12606
12607 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
12608 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
12609 protocol.
12610
12611 @table @emph
12612 @item On the target machine,
12613 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
12614 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
12615 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
12616 system does all the symbol handling.
12617
12618 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
12619 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
12620 syntax is:
12621
12622 @smallexample
12623 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
12624 @end smallexample
12625
12626 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
12627 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
12628 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
12629 @file{/dev/com1}:
12630
12631 @smallexample
12632 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
12633 @end smallexample
12634
12635 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
12636 with it.
12637
12638 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
12639
12640 @smallexample
12641 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
12642 @end smallexample
12643
12644 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
12645 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
12646 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
12647 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
12648 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
12649 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
12650 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
12651 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
12652 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
12653 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
12654 @code{target remote} command.
12655
12656 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
12657 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
12658
12659 @smallexample
12660 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
12661 @end smallexample
12662
12663 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
12664 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
12665
12666 @pindex pidof
12667 @cindex attach to a program by name
12668 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
12669 @code{pidof} utility:
12670
12671 @smallexample
12672 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
12673 @end smallexample
12674
12675 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
12676 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
12677 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
12678
12679 @item On the host machine,
12680 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
12681 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
12682 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
12683 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
12684 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
12685 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
12686 already on the target. However, if you want to load the symbols (as
12687 you normally would), do that with the @code{file} command, and issue
12688 it @emph{before} connecting to the server; otherwise, you will get an
12689 error message saying @code{"Program is already running"}, since the
12690 program is considered running after the connection.
12691
12692 @end table
12693
12694 @node Remote configuration
12695 @section Remote configuration
12696
12697 @kindex set remote
12698 @kindex show remote
12699 This section documents the configuration options available when
12700 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
12701 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
12702 system-call-allowed}.
12703
12704 @table @code
12705 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
12706 @cindex adress size for remote targets
12707 @cindex bits in remote address
12708 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
12709 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
12710 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
12711 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
12712
12713 @item show remoteaddresssize
12714 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
12715
12716 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
12717 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
12718 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
12719 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
12720 remote targets.
12721
12722 @item show remotebaud
12723 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
12724
12725 @item set remotebreak
12726 @cindex interrupt remote programs
12727 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
12728 @anchor{set remotebreak}
12729 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
12730 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
12731 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
12732 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
12733 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
12734
12735 @item show remotebreak
12736 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
12737 interrupt the remote program.
12738
12739 @item set remotedevice @var{device}
12740 @cindex serial port name
12741 Set the name of the serial port through which to communicate to the
12742 remote target to @var{device}. This is the device used by
12743 @value{GDBN} to open the serial communications line to the remote
12744 target. There's no default, so you must set a valid port name for the
12745 remote serial communications to work. (Some varieties of the
12746 @code{target} command accept the port name as part of their
12747 arguments.)
12748
12749 @item show remotedevice
12750 Show the current name of the serial port.
12751
12752 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
12753 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
12754 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
12755 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
12756 @code{ascii}.
12757
12758 @item show remotelogbase
12759 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
12760 protocol.
12761
12762 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
12763 @cindex record serial communications on file
12764 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
12765 default is not to record at all.
12766
12767 @item show remotelogfile.
12768 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
12769 serial communications.
12770
12771 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
12772 @cindex timeout for serial communications
12773 @cindex remote timeout
12774 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
12775 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
12776
12777 @item show remotetimeout
12778 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
12779 responses.
12780
12781 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
12782 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
12783 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
12784 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
12785 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
12786 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
12787 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
12788 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
12789 @end table
12790
12791 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
12792 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
12793 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
12794 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
12795 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
12796 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
12797 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
12798 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
12799 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
12800
12801 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
12802 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
12803 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
12804 @value{GDBN} developers.
12805
12806 The available settings are:
12807
12808 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.2 0.35
12809 @item Command Name
12810 @tab Remote Packet
12811 @tab Related Features
12812
12813 @item @code{fetch-register-packet}
12814 @tab @code{p}
12815 @tab @code{info registers}
12816
12817 @item @code{set-register-packet}
12818 @tab @code{P}
12819 @tab @code{set}
12820
12821 @item @code{binary-download-packet}
12822 @tab @code{X}
12823 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
12824
12825 @item @code{read-aux-vector-packet}
12826 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
12827 @tab @code{info auxv}
12828
12829 @item @code{symbol-lookup-packet}
12830 @tab @code{qSymbol}
12831 @tab Detecting multiple threads
12832
12833 @item @code{verbose-resume-packet}
12834 @tab @code{vCont}
12835 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
12836
12837 @item @code{software-breakpoint-packet}
12838 @tab @code{Z0}
12839 @tab @code{break}
12840
12841 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint-packet}
12842 @tab @code{Z1}
12843 @tab @code{hbreak}
12844
12845 @item @code{write-watchpoint-packet}
12846 @tab @code{Z2}
12847 @tab @code{watch}
12848
12849 @item @code{read-watchpoint-packet}
12850 @tab @code{Z3}
12851 @tab @code{rwatch}
12852
12853 @item @code{access-watchpoint-packet}
12854 @tab @code{Z4}
12855 @tab @code{awatch}
12856
12857 @item @code{get-thread-local-storage-address-packet}
12858 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
12859 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
12860
12861 @item @code{supported-packets}
12862 @tab @code{qSupported}
12863 @tab Remote communications parameters
12864
12865 @item @code{pass-signals-packet}
12866 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
12867 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
12868
12869 @end multitable
12870
12871 @node remote stub
12872 @section Implementing a remote stub
12873
12874 @cindex debugging stub, example
12875 @cindex remote stub, example
12876 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
12877 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
12878 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
12879 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
12880 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
12881 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
12882 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
12883 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
12884
12885 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
12886 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
12887 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
12888 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
12889 program, you need:
12890
12891 @enumerate
12892 @item
12893 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
12894 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
12895 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
12896
12897 @item
12898 A C subroutine library to support your program's
12899 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
12900
12901 @item
12902 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
12903 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
12904 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
12905 documentation.
12906 @end enumerate
12907
12908 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
12909 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
12910 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
12911
12912 @table @emph
12913 @item On the host,
12914 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
12915 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
12916 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
12917
12918 @item On the target,
12919 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
12920 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
12921 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
12922
12923 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
12924 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
12925 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
12926 @end table
12927
12928 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
12929 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
12930 @sc{sparc} boards.
12931
12932 @cindex remote serial stub list
12933 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
12934
12935 @table @code
12936
12937 @item i386-stub.c
12938 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
12939 @cindex Intel
12940 @cindex i386
12941 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
12942
12943 @item m68k-stub.c
12944 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
12945 @cindex Motorola 680x0
12946 @cindex m680x0
12947 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
12948
12949 @item sh-stub.c
12950 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
12951 @cindex Renesas
12952 @cindex SH
12953 For Renesas SH architectures.
12954
12955 @item sparc-stub.c
12956 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
12957 @cindex Sparc
12958 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
12959
12960 @item sparcl-stub.c
12961 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
12962 @cindex Fujitsu
12963 @cindex SparcLite
12964 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
12965
12966 @end table
12967
12968 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
12969 recently added stubs.
12970
12971 @menu
12972 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
12973 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
12974 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
12975 @end menu
12976
12977 @node Stub Contents
12978 @subsection What the stub can do for you
12979
12980 @cindex remote serial stub
12981 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
12982 subroutines:
12983
12984 @table @code
12985 @item set_debug_traps
12986 @findex set_debug_traps
12987 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
12988 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
12989 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
12990 beginning of your program.
12991
12992 @item handle_exception
12993 @findex handle_exception
12994 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
12995 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
12996 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
12997 run when a trap is triggered.
12998
12999 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
13000 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
13001 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
13002 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
13003 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
13004 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
13005 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
13006 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
13007 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
13008 machine.
13009
13010 @item breakpoint
13011 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
13012 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
13013 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
13014 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
13015 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
13016 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
13017 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
13018 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
13019 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
13020 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
13021 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
13022
13023 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
13024 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
13025 start of your debugging session.
13026 @end table
13027
13028 @node Bootstrapping
13029 @subsection What you must do for the stub
13030
13031 @cindex remote stub, support routines
13032 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
13033 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
13034 debugging target machine.
13035
13036 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
13037 serial port.
13038
13039 @table @code
13040 @item int getDebugChar()
13041 @findex getDebugChar
13042 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
13043 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
13044 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13045
13046 @item void putDebugChar(int)
13047 @findex putDebugChar
13048 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
13049 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
13050 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
13051 @end table
13052
13053 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
13054 @cindex interrupting remote targets
13055 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
13056 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
13057 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
13058 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
13059 remote system to stop.
13060
13061 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
13062 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
13063 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
13064 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
13065
13066 Other routines you need to supply are:
13067
13068 @table @code
13069 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
13070 @findex exceptionHandler
13071 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
13072 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
13073 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
13074 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
13075 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
13076 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
13077 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
13078 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
13079 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
13080 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
13081 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
13082 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
13083 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
13084
13085 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
13086 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
13087 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
13088 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
13089 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
13090
13091 @item void flush_i_cache()
13092 @findex flush_i_cache
13093 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
13094 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
13095 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
13096
13097 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
13098 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
13099 @end table
13100
13101 @noindent
13102 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
13103
13104 @table @code
13105 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
13106 @findex memset
13107 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
13108 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
13109 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
13110 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
13111 @end table
13112
13113 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
13114 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
13115 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
13116 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
13117
13118
13119 @node Debug Session
13120 @subsection Putting it all together
13121
13122 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
13123 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
13124 steps.
13125
13126 @enumerate
13127 @item
13128 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
13129 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
13130 @display
13131 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
13132 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
13133 @end display
13134
13135 @item
13136 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
13137
13138 @smallexample
13139 set_debug_traps();
13140 breakpoint();
13141 @end smallexample
13142
13143 @item
13144 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
13145 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
13146
13147 @smallexample
13148 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
13149 @end smallexample
13150
13151 @noindent
13152 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
13153 function in your program, that function is called when
13154 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
13155 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
13156 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
13157
13158 @item
13159 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
13160 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
13161
13162 @item
13163 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
13164 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
13165
13166 @item
13167 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
13168 @c document that. FIXME.
13169 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
13170 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
13171
13172 @item
13173 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
13174 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
13175
13176 @end enumerate
13177
13178 @node Configurations
13179 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
13180
13181 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
13182 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
13183 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
13184
13185 There are three major categories of configurations: native
13186 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
13187 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
13188 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
13189 are quite different from each other.
13190
13191 @menu
13192 * Native::
13193 * Embedded OS::
13194 * Embedded Processors::
13195 * Architectures::
13196 @end menu
13197
13198 @node Native
13199 @section Native
13200
13201 This section describes details specific to particular native
13202 configurations.
13203
13204 @menu
13205 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
13206 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
13207 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
13208 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
13209 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
13210 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
13211 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
13212 @end menu
13213
13214 @node HP-UX
13215 @subsection HP-UX
13216
13217 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
13218 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
13219 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
13220
13221
13222 @node BSD libkvm Interface
13223 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
13224
13225 @cindex libkvm
13226 @cindex kernel memory image
13227 @cindex kernel crash dump
13228
13229 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
13230 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
13231 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
13232 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
13233 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
13234 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
13235 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
13236 @code{kvm} target:
13237
13238 @smallexample
13239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
13240 @end smallexample
13241
13242 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
13243 argument:
13244
13245 @smallexample
13246 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
13247 @end smallexample
13248
13249 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
13250 available:
13251
13252 @table @code
13253 @kindex kvm
13254 @item kvm pcb
13255 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
13256
13257 @item kvm proc
13258 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
13259 modern FreeBSD systems.
13260 @end table
13261
13262 @node SVR4 Process Information
13263 @subsection SVR4 process information
13264 @cindex /proc
13265 @cindex examine process image
13266 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
13267
13268 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
13269 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
13270 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
13271 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
13272 proc} is available to report information about the process running
13273 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
13274 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
13275 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
13276 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
13277
13278 @table @code
13279 @kindex info proc
13280 @cindex process ID
13281 @item info proc
13282 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
13283 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
13284 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
13285 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
13286 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
13287 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
13288 executable file's absolute file name.
13289
13290 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
13291 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
13292 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
13293 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
13294 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
13295 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
13296
13297 @item info proc mappings
13298 @cindex memory address space mappings
13299 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
13300 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
13301 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
13302 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
13303 memory access rights to that range.
13304
13305 @item info proc stat
13306 @itemx info proc status
13307 @cindex process detailed status information
13308 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
13309 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
13310 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
13311 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
13312 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
13313 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
13314 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
13315
13316 @item info proc all
13317 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
13318 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
13319
13320 @ignore
13321 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
13322 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
13323 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
13324 @kindex info proc times
13325 @item info proc times
13326 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
13327 its children.
13328
13329 @kindex info proc id
13330 @item info proc id
13331 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
13332 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
13333 @end ignore
13334
13335 @item set procfs-trace
13336 @kindex set procfs-trace
13337 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
13338 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
13339
13340 @item show procfs-trace
13341 @kindex show procfs-trace
13342 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
13343
13344 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
13345 @kindex set procfs-file
13346 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
13347 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
13348 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
13349 standard output.
13350
13351 @item show procfs-file
13352 @kindex show procfs-file
13353 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
13354
13355 @item proc-trace-entry
13356 @itemx proc-trace-exit
13357 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
13358 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
13359 @kindex proc-trace-entry
13360 @kindex proc-trace-exit
13361 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
13362 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
13363 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
13364 from the @code{syscall} interface.
13365
13366 @item info pidlist
13367 @kindex info pidlist
13368 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
13369 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
13370 processes and all the threads within each process.
13371
13372 @item info meminfo
13373 @kindex info meminfo
13374 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
13375 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
13376 @end table
13377
13378 @node DJGPP Native
13379 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
13380 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
13381 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
13382 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
13383
13384 @cindex DPMI
13385 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
13386 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
13387 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
13388 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
13389
13390 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
13391 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
13392 subsection describes those commands.
13393
13394 @table @code
13395 @kindex info dos
13396 @item info dos
13397 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
13398 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13399
13400 @kindex sysinfo
13401 @cindex MS-DOS system info
13402 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
13403 @item info dos sysinfo
13404 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
13405 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
13406 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
13407
13408 @cindex GDT
13409 @cindex LDT
13410 @cindex IDT
13411 @cindex segment descriptor tables
13412 @cindex descriptor tables display
13413 @item info dos gdt
13414 @itemx info dos ldt
13415 @itemx info dos idt
13416 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
13417 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
13418 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
13419 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
13420 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
13421 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
13422 rights.
13423
13424 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
13425 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
13426 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
13427 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
13428 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
13429
13430 @cindex garbled pointers
13431 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
13432 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
13433 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
13434 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
13435 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
13436 debugged program's data segment:
13437
13438 @smallexample
13439 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
13440 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
13441 @end smallexample
13442
13443 @noindent
13444 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
13445 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
13446
13447 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
13448 @item info dos pde
13449 @itemx info dos pte
13450 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
13451 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
13452 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
13453 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
13454 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
13455 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
13456 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
13457 that is currently in use.
13458
13459 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
13460 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
13461 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
13462 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
13463 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
13464 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
13465 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
13466
13467 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
13468 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
13469 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
13470 controller.
13471
13472 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
13473
13474 @cindex physical address from linear address
13475 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
13476 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
13477 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
13478 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
13479 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
13480 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
13481 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
13482
13483 @smallexample
13484 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
13485 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
13486 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
13487 @end smallexample
13488
13489 @noindent
13490 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
13491 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
13492 attributes of that page.
13493
13494 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
13495 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
13496 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
13497 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
13498 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
13499 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
13500
13501 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
13502 transfer buffer:
13503
13504 @smallexample
13505 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
13506 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
13507 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
13508 @end smallexample
13509
13510 @noindent
13511 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
13512 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
13513 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
13514 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
13515 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
13516
13517 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
13518 @end table
13519
13520 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
13521 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
13522 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
13523 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
13524
13525 @table @code
13526 @kindex set com1base
13527 @kindex set com1irq
13528 @kindex set com2base
13529 @kindex set com2irq
13530 @kindex set com3base
13531 @kindex set com3irq
13532 @kindex set com4base
13533 @kindex set com4irq
13534 @item set com1base @var{addr}
13535 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
13536 port.
13537
13538 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
13539 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
13540 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
13541
13542 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
13543 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
13544 other 3 COM ports.
13545
13546 @kindex show com1base
13547 @kindex show com1irq
13548 @kindex show com2base
13549 @kindex show com2irq
13550 @kindex show com3base
13551 @kindex show com3irq
13552 @kindex show com4base
13553 @kindex show com4irq
13554 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
13555 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
13556 lines used by the COM ports.
13557
13558 @item info serial
13559 @kindex info serial
13560 @cindex DOS serial port status
13561 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
13562 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
13563 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
13564 counts of various errors encountered so far.
13565 @end table
13566
13567
13568 @node Cygwin Native
13569 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
13570 @cindex MS Windows debugging
13571 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
13572 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
13573
13574 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
13575 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
13576 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
13577 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
13578 that have no debugging symbols.
13579
13580
13581 @table @code
13582 @kindex info w32
13583 @item info w32
13584 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
13585 information about the target system and important OS structures.
13586
13587 @item info w32 selector
13588 This command displays information returned by
13589 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
13590 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
13591 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
13592 Without argument, this command displays information
13593 about the the six segment registers.
13594
13595 @kindex info dll
13596 @item info dll
13597 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
13598
13599 @kindex dll-symbols
13600 @item dll-symbols
13601 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
13602 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
13603
13604 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
13605 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
13606 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
13607 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
13608 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
13609 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
13610 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
13611 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
13612 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
13613 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
13614 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
13615
13616 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
13617 @item show cygwin-exceptions
13618 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
13619 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
13620
13621 @kindex set new-console
13622 @item set new-console @var{mode}
13623 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
13624 be started in a new console on next start.
13625 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
13626 be started in the same console as the debugger.
13627
13628 @kindex show new-console
13629 @item show new-console
13630 Displays whether a new console is used
13631 when the debuggee is started.
13632
13633 @kindex set new-group
13634 @item set new-group @var{mode}
13635 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
13636 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
13637 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
13638 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
13639
13640 @kindex show new-group
13641 @item show new-group
13642 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
13643
13644 @kindex set debugevents
13645 @item set debugevents
13646 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
13647 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
13648 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
13649 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
13650 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
13651
13652 @kindex set debugexec
13653 @item set debugexec
13654 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
13655 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
13656
13657 @kindex set debugexceptions
13658 @item set debugexceptions
13659 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
13660 debuggee seen by the debugger.
13661
13662 @kindex set debugmemory
13663 @item set debugmemory
13664 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
13665 and writes by the debugger.
13666
13667 @kindex set shell
13668 @item set shell
13669 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
13670 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
13671
13672 @kindex show shell
13673 @item show shell
13674 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
13675
13676 @end table
13677
13678 @menu
13679 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13680 @end menu
13681
13682 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
13683 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
13684 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
13685 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
13686
13687 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
13688 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
13689 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
13690 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
13691 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
13692 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
13693 ``minimal symbols''.
13694
13695 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
13696 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
13697 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
13698 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
13699 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
13700 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
13701 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
13702 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
13703 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
13704 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
13705
13706 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
13707
13708 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
13709 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
13710 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
13711 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
13712 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
13713 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
13714 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
13715 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
13716 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
13717
13718 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
13719 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
13720 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
13721 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
13722 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
13723 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
13724
13725 @smallexample
13726 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
13727 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
13728
13729 Non-debugging symbols:
13730 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
13731 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
13732 @end smallexample
13733
13734 @smallexample
13735 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
13736 All functions matching regular expression "!":
13737
13738 Non-debugging symbols:
13739 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
13740 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
13741 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
13742 [etc...]
13743 @end smallexample
13744
13745 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
13746
13747 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
13748 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
13749 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
13750 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
13751 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
13752 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
13753 a function within a DLL without a running program.
13754
13755 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
13756 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
13757 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
13758 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
13759 problem:
13760
13761 @smallexample
13762 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
13763 $1 = 268572168
13764 @end smallexample
13765
13766 @smallexample
13767 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
13768 0x10021610: "\230y\""
13769 @end smallexample
13770
13771 And two possible solutions:
13772
13773 @smallexample
13774 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
13775 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13776 @end smallexample
13777
13778 @smallexample
13779 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
13780 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
13781 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
13782 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
13783 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
13784 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
13785 @end smallexample
13786
13787 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
13788 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
13789 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
13790 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
13791 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
13792
13793 @smallexample
13794 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
13795 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
13796 @end smallexample
13797
13798 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
13799 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
13800 safe.
13801
13802 @node Hurd Native
13803 @subsection Commands specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd systems
13804 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
13805
13806 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
13807 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
13808
13809 @table @code
13810 @item set signals
13811 @itemx set sigs
13812 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
13813 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13814 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
13815 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
13816 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
13817 @code{signals}.
13818
13819 @item show signals
13820 @itemx show sigs
13821 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
13822 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
13823 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
13824
13825 @item set signal-thread
13826 @itemx set sigthread
13827 @kindex set signal-thread
13828 @kindex set sigthread
13829 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
13830 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
13831 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
13832 signal-thread}.
13833
13834 @item show signal-thread
13835 @itemx show sigthread
13836 @kindex show signal-thread
13837 @kindex show sigthread
13838 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
13839 delivered a signal.
13840
13841 @item set stopped
13842 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13843 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
13844 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
13845 continued by delivering a signal to it.
13846
13847 @item show stopped
13848 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
13849 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
13850 stopped.
13851
13852 @item set exceptions
13853 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13854 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
13855 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
13856 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
13857 trapping on.
13858
13859 @item show exceptions
13860 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
13861 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
13862
13863 @item set task pause
13864 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
13865 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13866 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13867 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
13868 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
13869 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
13870 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
13871 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
13872 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
13873
13874 @item show task pause
13875 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
13876 Show the current state of task suspension.
13877
13878 @item set task detach-suspend-count
13879 @cindex task suspend count
13880 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13881 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
13882 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
13883
13884 @item show task detach-suspend-count
13885 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
13886
13887 @item set task exception-port
13888 @itemx set task excp
13889 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13890 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
13891 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
13892 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
13893
13894 @item set noninvasive
13895 @cindex noninvasive task options
13896 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
13897 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
13898 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
13899 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
13900
13901 @item info send-rights
13902 @itemx info receive-rights
13903 @itemx info port-rights
13904 @itemx info port-sets
13905 @itemx info dead-names
13906 @itemx info ports
13907 @itemx info psets
13908 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13909 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13910 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13911 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13912 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13913 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
13914 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
13915 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
13916 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
13917
13918 @item set thread pause
13919 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
13920 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13921 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
13922 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
13923 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
13924 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
13925 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
13926 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
13927 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
13928 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
13929 only the current thread.
13930
13931 @item show thread pause
13932 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
13933 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
13934
13935 @item set thread run
13936 This comamnd sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13937
13938 @item show thread run
13939 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
13940
13941 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
13942 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13943 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13944 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
13945 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
13946 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
13947 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
13948
13949 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
13950 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
13951 detaching.
13952
13953 @item set thread exception-port
13954 @itemx set thread excp
13955 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
13956 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
13957 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
13958
13959 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
13960 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
13961 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
13962 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
13963
13964 @item set thread default
13965 @itemx show thread default
13966 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
13967 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
13968 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
13969 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
13970 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
13971 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
13972 the non-default commands.
13973 @end table
13974
13975
13976 @node Neutrino
13977 @subsection QNX Neutrino
13978 @cindex QNX Neutrino
13979
13980 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
13981 Neutrino target:
13982
13983 @table @code
13984 @item set debug nto-debug
13985 @kindex set debug nto-debug
13986 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
13987 Neutrino support.
13988
13989 @item show debug nto-debug
13990 @kindex show debug nto-debug
13991 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
13992 @end table
13993
13994
13995 @node Embedded OS
13996 @section Embedded Operating Systems
13997
13998 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
13999 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
14000 architectures.
14001
14002 @menu
14003 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14004 @end menu
14005
14006 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
14007 various real-time operating systems.
14008
14009 @node VxWorks
14010 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
14011
14012 @cindex VxWorks
14013
14014 @table @code
14015
14016 @kindex target vxworks
14017 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
14018 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
14019 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
14020
14021 @end table
14022
14023 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
14024 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
14025
14026 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
14027 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
14028 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
14029 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
14030 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
14031 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
14032 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
14033
14034 @table @code
14035 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
14036 @kindex vxworks-timeout
14037 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
14038 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
14039 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
14040 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
14041 of a thin network line.
14042 @end table
14043
14044 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
14045 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
14046 procedures.
14047
14048 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
14049 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
14050 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
14051 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
14052 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
14053 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
14054 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
14055 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
14056 manual.
14057 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
14058
14059 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
14060 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
14061 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
14062 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
14063
14064 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
14065
14066 @smallexample
14067 (vxgdb)
14068 @end smallexample
14069
14070 @menu
14071 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
14072 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
14073 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
14074 @end menu
14075
14076 @node VxWorks Connection
14077 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
14078
14079 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
14080 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
14081
14082 @smallexample
14083 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
14084 @end smallexample
14085
14086 @need 750
14087 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
14088
14089 @smallexample
14090 Attaching remote machine across net...
14091 Connected to tt.
14092 @end smallexample
14093
14094 @need 1000
14095 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
14096 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
14097 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
14098 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
14099 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
14100
14101 @smallexample
14102 prog.o: No such file or directory.
14103 @end smallexample
14104
14105 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
14106 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
14107 command again.
14108
14109 @node VxWorks Download
14110 @subsubsection VxWorks download
14111
14112 @cindex download to VxWorks
14113 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
14114 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
14115 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
14116 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
14117 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
14118 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
14119 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
14120 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
14121 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
14122 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
14123 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
14124 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
14125 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
14126 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
14127 program, type this on VxWorks:
14128
14129 @smallexample
14130 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
14131 @end smallexample
14132
14133 @noindent
14134 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
14135
14136 @smallexample
14137 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
14138 (vxgdb) load prog.o
14139 @end smallexample
14140
14141 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
14142
14143 @smallexample
14144 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
14145 @end smallexample
14146
14147 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
14148 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
14149 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
14150 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
14151 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
14152 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
14153 table.)
14154
14155 @node VxWorks Attach
14156 @subsubsection Running tasks
14157
14158 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
14159 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
14160 follows:
14161
14162 @smallexample
14163 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
14164 @end smallexample
14165
14166 @noindent
14167 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
14168 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
14169 the time of attachment.
14170
14171 @node Embedded Processors
14172 @section Embedded Processors
14173
14174 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
14175 configurations.
14176
14177 @cindex send command to simulator
14178 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
14179 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
14180
14181 @table @code
14182 @item sim @var{command}
14183 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
14184 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
14185 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
14186 acceptable commands.
14187 @end table
14188
14189
14190 @menu
14191 * ARM:: ARM RDI
14192 * H8/300:: Renesas H8/300
14193 * H8/500:: Renesas H8/500
14194 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
14195 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
14196 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
14197 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
14198 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
14199 * PowerPC: PowerPC
14200 * SH:: Renesas SH
14201 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
14202 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
14203 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
14204 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
14205 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
14206 * CRIS:: CRIS
14207 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
14208 * WinCE:: Windows CE child processes
14209 @end menu
14210
14211 @node ARM
14212 @subsection ARM
14213 @cindex ARM RDI
14214
14215 @table @code
14216 @kindex target rdi
14217 @item target rdi @var{dev}
14218 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
14219 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
14220 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
14221
14222 @kindex target rdp
14223 @item target rdp @var{dev}
14224 ARM Demon monitor.
14225
14226 @end table
14227
14228 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
14229
14230 @table @code
14231 @item set arm disassembler
14232 @kindex set arm
14233 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
14234 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
14235
14236 @item show arm disassembler
14237 @kindex show arm
14238 Show the current disassembly style.
14239
14240 @item set arm apcs32
14241 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
14242 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
14243
14244 @item show arm apcs32
14245 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
14246
14247 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
14248 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
14249 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
14250
14251 @table @code
14252 @item auto
14253 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
14254 @item softfpa
14255 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
14256 processors.
14257 @item fpa
14258 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
14259 @item softvfp
14260 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
14261 @item vfp
14262 VFP co-processor.
14263 @end table
14264
14265 @item show arm fpu
14266 Show the current type of the FPU.
14267
14268 @item set arm abi
14269 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
14270
14271 @item show arm abi
14272 Show the currently used ABI.
14273
14274 @item set debug arm
14275 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
14276 target support subsystem.
14277
14278 @item show debug arm
14279 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
14280 @end table
14281
14282 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
14283 using the RDI interface:
14284
14285 @table @code
14286 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14287 @kindex rdilogfile
14288 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
14289 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
14290 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
14291 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
14292 @file{rdi.log}.
14293
14294 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
14295 @kindex rdilogenable
14296 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
14297 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
14298 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
14299 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
14300 are logged to a file.
14301
14302 @item set rdiromatzero
14303 @kindex set rdiromatzero
14304 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
14305 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
14306 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
14307 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
14308 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
14309
14310 @item show rdiromatzero
14311 @kindex show rdiromatzero
14312 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
14313
14314 @item set rdiheartbeat
14315 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
14316 @cindex RDI heartbeat
14317 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
14318 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
14319 well as the Angel monitor.
14320
14321 @item show rdiheartbeat
14322 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
14323 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
14324 @end table
14325
14326
14327 @node H8/300
14328 @subsection Renesas H8/300
14329
14330 @table @code
14331
14332 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
14333 @item target hms @var{dev}
14334 A Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
14335 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
14336 line and the communications speed used.
14337
14338 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
14339 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
14340 E7000 emulator for Renesas H8 and SH.
14341
14342 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
14343 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
14344 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
14345 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
14346 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
14347
14348 @end table
14349
14350 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
14351 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
14352 @cindex download to Renesas SH
14353 @cindex Renesas SH download
14354 When you select remote debugging to a Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500
14355 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Renesas
14356 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
14357 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
14358
14359 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
14360 Renesas SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
14361
14362 @enumerate
14363 @item
14364 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
14365 for Renesas microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
14366 emulator for the Renesas SH and the Renesas 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
14367 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Renesas SH,
14368 H8/300, or H8/500.)
14369
14370 @item
14371 what serial device connects your host to your Renesas board (the first
14372 serial device available on your host is the default).
14373
14374 @item
14375 what speed to use over the serial device.
14376 @end enumerate
14377
14378 @menu
14379 * Renesas Boards:: Connecting to Renesas boards.
14380 * Renesas ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
14381 * Renesas Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros.
14382 @end menu
14383
14384 @node Renesas Boards
14385 @subsubsection Connecting to Renesas boards
14386
14387 @c only for Unix hosts
14388 @kindex device
14389 @cindex serial device, Renesas micros
14390 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
14391 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
14392 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
14393 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
14394
14395 @kindex speed
14396 @cindex serial line speed, Renesas micros
14397 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
14398 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
14399 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
14400 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
14401 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
14402
14403 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
14404 use a Unix host to debug your Renesas microprocessor programs. If you
14405 use a DOS host,
14406 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
14407 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
14408 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
14409 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
14410
14411 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
14412 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
14413 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
14414 the Renesas SH and the H8/500.
14415
14416 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
14417 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
14418 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
14419 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
14420 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
14421 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
14422 @code{COM2}.
14423
14424 @smallexample
14425 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
14426 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
14427
14428 Resident portion of MODE loaded
14429
14430 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
14431
14432 @end smallexample
14433
14434 @quotation
14435 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
14436 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
14437 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
14438 your development board.
14439 @end quotation
14440
14441 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
14442 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
14443 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBN}} with
14444 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
14445 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
14446 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
14447 cross-debugging to the Renesas board, and the @code{load} command to
14448 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
14449 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
14450 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
14451 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
14452 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
14453 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
14454
14455 @smallexample
14456 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
14457 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
14458 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
14459 the conditions.
14460 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
14461 for details.
14462 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
14463 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
14464 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
14465 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
14466 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
14467 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
14468 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
14469 @end smallexample
14470
14471 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
14472 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
14473 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
14474 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
14475 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
14476 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
14477
14478 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
14479 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
14480 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
14481
14482 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
14483 @itemize @bullet
14484 @item
14485 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{Ctrl-c} on the DOS host---it has
14486 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
14487
14488 @item
14489 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
14490 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
14491 to detect program completion.
14492 @end itemize
14493
14494 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
14495 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
14496
14497 @node Renesas ICE
14498 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
14499
14500 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas ICE}
14501 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
14502 Renesas SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
14503 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
14504
14505 @table @code
14506 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
14507 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
14508 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
14509 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
14510 (for example, @samp{9600}).
14511
14512 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
14513 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
14514 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
14515 @end table
14516
14517 The following special commands are available when debugging with the
14518 Renesas E7000 ICE:
14519
14520 @table @code
14521 @item e7000 @var{command}
14522 @kindex e7000
14523 @cindex send command to E7000 monitor
14524 This sends the specified @var{command} to the E7000 monitor.
14525
14526 @item ftplogin @var{machine} @var{username} @var{password} @var{dir}
14527 @kindex ftplogin@r{, E7000}
14528 This command records information for subsequent interface with the
14529 E7000 monitor via the FTP protocol: @value{GDBN} will log into the
14530 named @var{machine} using specified @var{username} and @var{password},
14531 and then chdir to the named directory @var{dir}.
14532
14533 @item ftpload @var{file}
14534 @kindex ftpload@r{, E7000}
14535 This command uses credentials recorded by @code{ftplogin} to fetch and
14536 load the named @var{file} from the E7000 monitor.
14537
14538 @item drain
14539 @kindex drain@r{, E7000}
14540 This command drains any pending text buffers stored on the E7000.
14541
14542 @item set usehardbreakpoints
14543 @itemx show usehardbreakpoints
14544 @kindex set usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14545 @kindex show usehardbreakpoints@r{, E7000}
14546 @cindex hardware breakpoints, and E7000
14547 These commands set and show the use of hardware breakpoints for all
14548 breakpoints. @xref{Set Breaks, hardware-assisted breakpoint}, for
14549 more information about using hardware breakpoints selectively.
14550 @end table
14551
14552 @node Renesas Special
14553 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Renesas micros
14554
14555 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
14556
14557 @table @code
14558
14559 @kindex set machine
14560 @kindex show machine
14561 @item set machine h8300
14562 @itemx set machine h8300h
14563 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
14564 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
14565 to check which variant is currently in effect.
14566
14567 @end table
14568
14569 @node H8/500
14570 @subsection H8/500
14571
14572 @table @code
14573
14574 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
14575 @cindex memory models, H8/500
14576 @item set memory @var{mod}
14577 @itemx show memory
14578 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
14579 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
14580 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
14581 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
14582
14583 @end table
14584
14585 @node M32R/D
14586 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
14587
14588 @table @code
14589 @kindex target m32r
14590 @item target m32r @var{dev}
14591 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
14592
14593 @kindex target m32rsdi
14594 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
14595 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
14596 @end table
14597
14598 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
14599
14600 @table @code
14601 @item set download-path @var{path}
14602 @kindex set download-path
14603 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
14604 Set the default path for finding donwloadable @sc{srec} files.
14605
14606 @item show download-path
14607 @kindex show download-path
14608 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
14609
14610 @item set board-address @var{addr}
14611 @kindex set board-address
14612 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
14613 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
14614
14615 @item show board-address
14616 @kindex show board-address
14617 Show the current IP address of the target board.
14618
14619 @item set server-address @var{addr}
14620 @kindex set server-address
14621 @cindex download server address (M32R)
14622 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
14623 host machine.
14624
14625 @item show server-address
14626 @kindex show server-address
14627 Display the IP address of the download server.
14628
14629 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14630 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
14631 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
14632 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
14633 executable file is uploaded.
14634
14635 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
14636 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
14637 Test the @code{upload} command.
14638 @end table
14639
14640 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
14641
14642 @table @code
14643 @item sdireset
14644 @kindex sdireset
14645 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
14646 This command resets the SDI connection.
14647
14648 @item sdistatus
14649 @kindex sdistatus
14650 This command shows the SDI connection status.
14651
14652 @item debug_chaos
14653 @kindex debug_chaos
14654 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
14655 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
14656
14657 @item use_debug_dma
14658 @kindex use_debug_dma
14659 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
14660
14661 @item use_mon_code
14662 @kindex use_mon_code
14663 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
14664
14665 @item use_ib_break
14666 @kindex use_ib_break
14667 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
14668
14669 @item use_dbt_break
14670 @kindex use_dbt_break
14671 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
14672 @end table
14673
14674 @node M68K
14675 @subsection M68k
14676
14677 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
14678 target command for the following ROM monitors.
14679
14680 @table @code
14681
14682 @kindex target abug
14683 @item target abug @var{dev}
14684 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
14685
14686 @kindex target cpu32bug
14687 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
14688 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14689
14690 @kindex target dbug
14691 @item target dbug @var{dev}
14692 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
14693
14694 @kindex target est
14695 @item target est @var{dev}
14696 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
14697
14698 @kindex target rom68k
14699 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
14700 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
14701
14702 @end table
14703
14704 @table @code
14705
14706 @kindex target rombug
14707 @item target rombug @var{dev}
14708 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
14709
14710 @end table
14711
14712 @node MIPS Embedded
14713 @subsection MIPS Embedded
14714
14715 @cindex MIPS boards
14716 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
14717 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
14718 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
14719
14720 @need 1000
14721 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
14722
14723 @table @code
14724 @item target mips @var{port}
14725 @kindex target mips @var{port}
14726 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
14727 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
14728 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
14729 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
14730 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
14731 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
14732
14733 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
14734 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
14735 debugger:
14736
14737 @smallexample
14738 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
14739 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
14740 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
14741 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
14742 (@value{GDBP}) run
14743 @end smallexample
14744
14745 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
14746 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
14747 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
14748 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
14749 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
14750
14751 @item target pmon @var{port}
14752 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
14753 PMON ROM monitor.
14754
14755 @item target ddb @var{port}
14756 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
14757 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
14758
14759 @item target lsi @var{port}
14760 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
14761 LSI variant of PMON.
14762
14763 @kindex target r3900
14764 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
14765 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
14766
14767 @kindex target array
14768 @item target array @var{dev}
14769 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
14770
14771 @end table
14772
14773
14774 @noindent
14775 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
14776
14777 @table @code
14778 @item set mipsfpu double
14779 @itemx set mipsfpu single
14780 @itemx set mipsfpu none
14781 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
14782 @itemx show mipsfpu
14783 @kindex set mipsfpu
14784 @kindex show mipsfpu
14785 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
14786 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
14787 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
14788 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
14789 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
14790 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
14791 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
14792 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
14793 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
14794 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
14795 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
14796 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
14797 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
14798
14799 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
14800 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
14801 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
14802
14803 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
14804 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
14805
14806 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
14807 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
14808 @itemx show timeout
14809 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
14810 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
14811 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
14812 @kindex set timeout
14813 @kindex show timeout
14814 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
14815 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
14816 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
14817 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
14818 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
14819 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
14820 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
14821 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
14822 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
14823 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
14824
14825 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
14826 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
14827 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
14828 to run before stopping.
14829
14830 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
14831 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14832 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
14833 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
14834 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
14835 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
14836
14837 @item show syn-garbage-limit
14838 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
14839 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
14840 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
14841
14842 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
14843 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14844 @cindex remote monitor prompt
14845 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
14846 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
14847 @table @asis
14848 @item pmon target
14849 @samp{PMON}
14850 @item ddb target
14851 @samp{NEC010}
14852 @item lsi target
14853 @samp{PMON>}
14854 @end table
14855
14856 @item show monitor-prompt
14857 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
14858 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
14859 remote monitor.
14860
14861 @item set monitor-warnings
14862 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14863 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
14864 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
14865 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
14866 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
14867
14868 @item show monitor-warnings
14869 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
14870 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
14871
14872 @item pmon @var{command}
14873 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
14874 @cindex send PMON command
14875 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
14876 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
14877 @end table
14878
14879 @node OpenRISC 1000
14880 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
14881 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
14882
14883 @cindex or1k boards
14884 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
14885 about platform and commands.
14886
14887 @table @code
14888
14889 @kindex target jtag
14890 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
14891
14892 Connects to remote JTAG server.
14893 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
14894 connected via parallel port to the board.
14895
14896 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
14897
14898 @kindex or1ksim
14899 @item or1ksim @var{command}
14900 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
14901 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
14902
14903 @kindex info or1k spr
14904 @item info or1k spr
14905 Displays spr groups.
14906
14907 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
14908 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
14909 Displays register names in selected group.
14910
14911 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
14912 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
14913 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
14914 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
14915 Shows information about specified spr register.
14916
14917 @kindex spr
14918 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
14919 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
14920 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
14921 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
14922 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
14923 @end table
14924
14925 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
14926 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
14927 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
14928 triggers can be set using:
14929 @table @code
14930 @item $LEA/$LDATA
14931 Load effective address/data
14932 @item $SEA/$SDATA
14933 Store effective address/data
14934 @item $AEA/$ADATA
14935 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
14936 @item $FETCH
14937 Fetch data
14938 @end table
14939
14940 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
14941 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
14942
14943 @code{htrace} commands:
14944 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
14945 @table @code
14946 @kindex hwatch
14947 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
14948 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
14949 or Data. For example:
14950
14951 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14952
14953 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
14954
14955 @kindex htrace
14956 @item htrace info
14957 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
14958
14959 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
14960 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
14961
14962 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
14963 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
14964
14965 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
14966 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
14967
14968 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
14969 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
14970 triggered.
14971
14972 @item htrace enable
14973 @itemx htrace disable
14974 Enables/disables the HW trace.
14975
14976 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
14977 Clears currently recorded trace data.
14978
14979 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
14980 will be written there.
14981
14982 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
14983 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
14984
14985 @item htrace mode continuous
14986 Set continuous trace mode.
14987
14988 @item htrace mode suspend
14989 Set suspend trace mode.
14990
14991 @end table
14992
14993 @node PowerPC
14994 @subsection PowerPC
14995
14996 @table @code
14997 @kindex target dink32
14998 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
14999 DINK32 ROM monitor.
15000
15001 @kindex target ppcbug
15002 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
15003 @kindex target ppcbug1
15004 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
15005 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
15006
15007 @kindex target sds
15008 @item target sds @var{dev}
15009 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
15010 @end table
15011
15012 @cindex SDS protocol
15013 The following commands specifi to the SDS protocol are supported
15014 by@value{GDBN}:
15015
15016 @table @code
15017 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
15018 @kindex set sdstimeout
15019 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
15020 default is 2 seconds.
15021
15022 @item show sdstimeout
15023 @kindex show sdstimeout
15024 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
15025
15026 @item sds @var{command}
15027 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
15028 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
15029 @end table
15030
15031
15032 @node PA
15033 @subsection HP PA Embedded
15034
15035 @table @code
15036
15037 @kindex target op50n
15038 @item target op50n @var{dev}
15039 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
15040
15041 @kindex target w89k
15042 @item target w89k @var{dev}
15043 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
15044
15045 @end table
15046
15047 @node SH
15048 @subsection Renesas SH
15049
15050 @table @code
15051
15052 @kindex target hms@r{, with Renesas SH}
15053 @item target hms @var{dev}
15054 A Renesas SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
15055 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
15056 the communications speed used.
15057
15058 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Renesas SH}
15059 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
15060 E7000 emulator for Renesas SH.
15061
15062 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
15063 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
15064 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
15065 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
15066 Renesas SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
15067
15068 @end table
15069
15070 @node Sparclet
15071 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
15072
15073 @cindex Sparclet
15074
15075 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
15076 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
15077 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15078 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
15079 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
15080
15081 @table @code
15082 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
15083 @kindex remotetimeout
15084 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
15085 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15086 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
15087 @end table
15088
15089 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
15090 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
15091 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
15092 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
15093 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
15094
15095 @smallexample
15096 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
15097 @end smallexample
15098
15099 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
15100
15101 @smallexample
15102 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
15103 @end smallexample
15104
15105 @cindex running, on Sparclet
15106 Once you have set
15107 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15108 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
15109 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
15110
15111 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15112
15113 @smallexample
15114 (gdbslet)
15115 @end smallexample
15116
15117 @menu
15118 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
15119 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
15120 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
15121 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
15122 @end menu
15123
15124 @node Sparclet File
15125 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
15126
15127 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
15128
15129 @smallexample
15130 (gdbslet) file prog
15131 @end smallexample
15132
15133 @need 1000
15134 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
15135 @value{GDBN} locates
15136 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
15137 path.
15138 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
15139 files will be searched as well.
15140 @value{GDBN} locates
15141 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
15142 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
15143 If it fails
15144 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
15145
15146 @smallexample
15147 prog: No such file or directory.
15148 @end smallexample
15149
15150 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
15151 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
15152 @code{target} command again.
15153
15154 @node Sparclet Connection
15155 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
15156
15157 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
15158 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
15159
15160 @smallexample
15161 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
15162 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
15163 main () at ../prog.c:3
15164 @end smallexample
15165
15166 @need 750
15167 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15168
15169 @smallexample
15170 Connected to ttya.
15171 @end smallexample
15172
15173 @node Sparclet Download
15174 @subsubsection Sparclet download
15175
15176 @cindex download to Sparclet
15177 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
15178 you can use the @value{GDBN}
15179 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
15180 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
15181 command.
15182 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
15183 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
15184 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
15185 of each of the file's sections.
15186 For instance, if the program
15187 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
15188 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15189
15190 @smallexample
15191 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
15192 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
15193 @end smallexample
15194
15195 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
15196 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
15197 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
15198
15199 @node Sparclet Execution
15200 @subsubsection Running and debugging
15201
15202 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
15203 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
15204 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
15205 manual for the list of commands.
15206
15207 @smallexample
15208 (gdbslet) b main
15209 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
15210 (gdbslet) run
15211 Starting program: prog
15212 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
15213 3 char *symarg = 0;
15214 (gdbslet) step
15215 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
15216 (gdbslet)
15217 @end smallexample
15218
15219 @node Sparclite
15220 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
15221
15222 @table @code
15223
15224 @kindex target sparclite
15225 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
15226 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
15227 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
15228 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
15229 remote protocol.
15230
15231 @end table
15232
15233 @node ST2000
15234 @subsection Tandem ST2000
15235
15236 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
15237 STDBUG protocol.
15238
15239 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
15240 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
15241
15242 @smallexample
15243 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
15244 @end smallexample
15245
15246 @noindent
15247 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
15248 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
15249 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
15250 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
15251 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
15252
15253 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
15254 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
15255 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
15256 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
15257 available on your host computer.
15258 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
15259 @c basically hearsay.
15260
15261 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
15262 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
15263 environment:
15264
15265 @table @code
15266 @item st2000 @var{command}
15267 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
15268 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
15269 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
15270 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
15271 manual for available commands.
15272
15273 @item connect
15274 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
15275 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
15276 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
15277 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
15278 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ .} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
15279 @kbd{@key{RET} ~ Ctrl-d} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
15280 @end table
15281
15282 @node Z8000
15283 @subsection Zilog Z8000
15284
15285 @cindex Z8000
15286 @cindex simulator, Z8000
15287 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
15288
15289 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
15290 a Z8000 simulator.
15291
15292 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
15293 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
15294 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
15295 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
15296
15297 @table @code
15298 @item target sim @var{args}
15299 @kindex sim
15300 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
15301 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
15302 options, specify them via @var{args}.
15303 @end table
15304
15305 @noindent
15306 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
15307 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
15308 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
15309 to run your program, and so on.
15310
15311 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
15312 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
15313 additional items of information as specially named registers:
15314
15315 @table @code
15316
15317 @item cycles
15318 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
15319
15320 @item insts
15321 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
15322
15323 @item time
15324 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
15325
15326 @end table
15327
15328 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
15329 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
15330 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
15331 simulated clock ticks.
15332
15333 @node AVR
15334 @subsection Atmel AVR
15335 @cindex AVR
15336
15337 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
15338 following AVR-specific commands:
15339
15340 @table @code
15341 @item info io_registers
15342 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
15343 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
15344 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
15345 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
15346 @end table
15347
15348 @node CRIS
15349 @subsection CRIS
15350 @cindex CRIS
15351
15352 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
15353 following CRIS-specific commands:
15354
15355 @table @code
15356 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
15357 @cindex CRIS version
15358 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
15359 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
15360 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
15361
15362 @item show cris-version
15363 Show the current CRIS version.
15364
15365 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
15366 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
15367 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
15368 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
15369 @code{R59}.
15370
15371 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
15372 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
15373
15374 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
15375 @cindex CRIS mode
15376 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
15377 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
15378 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
15379
15380 @item show cris-mode
15381 Show the current CRIS mode.
15382 @end table
15383
15384 @node Super-H
15385 @subsection Renesas Super-H
15386 @cindex Super-H
15387
15388 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
15389 commands:
15390
15391 @table @code
15392 @item regs
15393 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
15394 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
15395 @end table
15396
15397 @node WinCE
15398 @subsection Windows CE
15399 @cindex Windows CE
15400
15401 The following commands are available for Windows CE:
15402
15403 @table @code
15404 @item set remotedirectory @var{dir}
15405 @kindex set remotedirectory
15406 Tell @value{GDBN} to upload files from the named directory @var{dir}.
15407 The default is @file{/gdb}, i.e.@: the root directory on the current
15408 drive.
15409
15410 @item show remotedirectory
15411 @kindex show remotedirectory
15412 Show the current value of the upload directory.
15413
15414 @item set remoteupload @var{method}
15415 @kindex set remoteupload
15416 Set the method used to upload files to remote device. Valid values
15417 for @var{method} are @samp{always}, @samp{newer}, and @samp{never}.
15418 The default is @samp{newer}.
15419
15420 @item show remoteupload
15421 @kindex show remoteupload
15422 Show the current setting of the upload method.
15423
15424 @item set remoteaddhost
15425 @kindex set remoteaddhost
15426 Tell @value{GDBN} whether to add this host to the remote stub's
15427 arguments when you debug over a network.
15428
15429 @item show remoteaddhost
15430 @kindex show remoteaddhost
15431 Show whether to add this host to remote stub's arguments when
15432 debugging over a network.
15433 @end table
15434
15435
15436 @node Architectures
15437 @section Architectures
15438
15439 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
15440 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
15441
15442 @menu
15443 * i386::
15444 * A29K::
15445 * Alpha::
15446 * MIPS::
15447 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
15448 @end menu
15449
15450 @node i386
15451 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific issues.
15452
15453 @table @code
15454 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
15455 @kindex set struct-convention
15456 @cindex struct return convention
15457 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
15458 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
15459 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
15460 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
15461 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
15462 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
15463 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
15464 be returned in a register.
15465
15466 @item show struct-convention
15467 @kindex show struct-convention
15468 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
15469 from functions.
15470 @end table
15471
15472 @node A29K
15473 @subsection A29K
15474
15475 @table @code
15476
15477 @kindex set rstack_high_address
15478 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
15479 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
15480 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
15481 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
15482 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
15483 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
15484 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
15485 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
15486 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
15487 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
15488 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
15489 hexadecimal.
15490
15491 @kindex show rstack_high_address
15492 @item show rstack_high_address
15493 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
15494 processors.
15495
15496 @end table
15497
15498 @node Alpha
15499 @subsection Alpha
15500
15501 See the following section.
15502
15503 @node MIPS
15504 @subsection MIPS
15505
15506 @cindex stack on Alpha
15507 @cindex stack on MIPS
15508 @cindex Alpha stack
15509 @cindex MIPS stack
15510 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
15511 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
15512 find the beginning of a function.
15513
15514 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
15515 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
15516 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
15517 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
15518 commands:
15519
15520 @table @code
15521 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
15522 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
15523 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
15524 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
15525 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
15526 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
15527 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
15528 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
15529
15530 @item show heuristic-fence-post
15531 Display the current limit.
15532 @end table
15533
15534 @noindent
15535 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
15536 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
15537
15538 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
15539 programs:
15540
15541 @table @code
15542 @item set mips saved-gpreg-size @var{size}
15543 @kindex set mips saved-gpreg-size
15544 @cindex MIPS GP register size on stack
15545 Set the size of MIPS general-purpose registers saved on the stack.
15546 The argument @var{size} can be one of the following:
15547
15548 @table @samp
15549 @item 32
15550 32-bit GP registers
15551 @item 64
15552 64-bit GP registers
15553 @item auto
15554 Use the target's default setting or autodetect the saved size from the
15555 information contained in the executable. This is the default
15556 @end table
15557
15558 @item show mips saved-gpreg-size
15559 @kindex show mips saved-gpreg-size
15560 Show the current size of MIPS GP registers on the stack.
15561
15562 @item set mips stack-arg-size @var{size}
15563 @kindex set mips stack-arg-size
15564 @cindex MIPS stack space for arguments
15565 Set the amount of stack space reserved for arguments to functions.
15566 The argument can be one of @code{"32"}, @code{"64"} or @code{"auto"}
15567 (the default).
15568
15569 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
15570 @kindex set mips abi
15571 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
15572 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
15573 values of @var{arg} are:
15574
15575 @table @samp
15576 @item auto
15577 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
15578 default).
15579 @item o32
15580 @item o64
15581 @item n32
15582 @item n64
15583 @item eabi32
15584 @item eabi64
15585 @item auto
15586 @end table
15587
15588 @item show mips abi
15589 @kindex show mips abi
15590 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
15591
15592 @item set mipsfpu
15593 @itemx show mipsfpu
15594 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
15595
15596 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
15597 @kindex set mips mask-address
15598 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
15599 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
15600 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
15601 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
15602 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
15603
15604 @item show mips mask-address
15605 @kindex show mips mask-address
15606 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
15607 not.
15608
15609 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15610 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15611 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
15612 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
15613 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
15614 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
15615
15616 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15617 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
15618 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
15619
15620 @item set debug mips
15621 @kindex set debug mips
15622 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
15623 target code in @value{GDBN}.
15624
15625 @item show debug mips
15626 @kindex show debug mips
15627 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
15628 @end table
15629
15630
15631 @node HPPA
15632 @subsection HPPA
15633 @cindex HPPA support
15634
15635 When @value{GDBN} is debugging te HP PA architecture, it provides the
15636 following special commands:
15637
15638 @table @code
15639 @item set debug hppa
15640 @kindex set debug hppa
15641 THis command determines whether HPPA architecture specific debugging
15642 messages are to be displayed.
15643
15644 @item show debug hppa
15645 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
15646
15647 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
15648 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
15649 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
15650 given @var{address}.
15651
15652 @end table
15653
15654
15655 @node Controlling GDB
15656 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
15657
15658 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
15659 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
15660 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
15661 described here.
15662
15663 @menu
15664 * Prompt:: Prompt
15665 * Editing:: Command editing
15666 * Command History:: Command history
15667 * Screen Size:: Screen size
15668 * Numbers:: Numbers
15669 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
15670 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
15671 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
15672 @end menu
15673
15674 @node Prompt
15675 @section Prompt
15676
15677 @cindex prompt
15678
15679 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
15680 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
15681 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
15682 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
15683 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
15684 which one you are talking to.
15685
15686 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
15687 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
15688 or a prompt that does not.
15689
15690 @table @code
15691 @kindex set prompt
15692 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
15693 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
15694
15695 @kindex show prompt
15696 @item show prompt
15697 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
15698 @end table
15699
15700 @node Editing
15701 @section Command editing
15702 @cindex readline
15703 @cindex command line editing
15704
15705 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
15706 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
15707 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
15708 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
15709 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
15710 debugging sessions.
15711
15712 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
15713 command @code{set}.
15714
15715 @table @code
15716 @kindex set editing
15717 @cindex editing
15718 @item set editing
15719 @itemx set editing on
15720 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
15721
15722 @item set editing off
15723 Disable command line editing.
15724
15725 @kindex show editing
15726 @item show editing
15727 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
15728 @end table
15729
15730 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
15731 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
15732 encouraged to read that chapter.
15733
15734 @node Command History
15735 @section Command history
15736 @cindex command history
15737
15738 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
15739 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
15740 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
15741 history facility.
15742
15743 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
15744 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
15745 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
15746
15747 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
15748 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
15749 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
15750 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
15751 pressed on a line by itself.
15752
15753 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
15754 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
15755 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
15756 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
15757
15758 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
15759 history.
15760
15761 @table @code
15762 @cindex history substitution
15763 @cindex history file
15764 @kindex set history filename
15765 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
15766 @item set history filename @var{fname}
15767 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
15768 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
15769 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
15770 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
15771 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
15772 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
15773 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
15774 is not set.
15775
15776 @cindex save command history
15777 @kindex set history save
15778 @item set history save
15779 @itemx set history save on
15780 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
15781 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
15782
15783 @item set history save off
15784 Stop recording command history in a file.
15785
15786 @cindex history size
15787 @kindex set history size
15788 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
15789 @item set history size @var{size}
15790 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
15791 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
15792 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
15793 @end table
15794
15795 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
15796 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
15797
15798 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
15799 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
15800 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
15801 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
15802 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
15803 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
15804 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
15805 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
15806
15807 The commands to control history expansion are:
15808
15809 @table @code
15810 @item set history expansion on
15811 @itemx set history expansion
15812 @kindex set history expansion
15813 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
15814
15815 @item set history expansion off
15816 Disable history expansion.
15817
15818 @c @group
15819 @kindex show history
15820 @item show history
15821 @itemx show history filename
15822 @itemx show history save
15823 @itemx show history size
15824 @itemx show history expansion
15825 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
15826 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
15827 @c @end group
15828 @end table
15829
15830 @table @code
15831 @kindex show commands
15832 @cindex show last commands
15833 @cindex display command history
15834 @item show commands
15835 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
15836
15837 @item show commands @var{n}
15838 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
15839
15840 @item show commands +
15841 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
15842 @end table
15843
15844 @node Screen Size
15845 @section Screen size
15846 @cindex size of screen
15847 @cindex pauses in output
15848
15849 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
15850 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
15851 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
15852 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
15853 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
15854 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
15855 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
15856 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
15857
15858 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
15859 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
15860 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
15861 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
15862 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
15863 width} commands:
15864
15865 @table @code
15866 @kindex set height
15867 @kindex set width
15868 @kindex show width
15869 @kindex show height
15870 @item set height @var{lpp}
15871 @itemx show height
15872 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
15873 @itemx show width
15874 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
15875 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
15876 commands display the current settings.
15877
15878 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
15879 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
15880 file or to an editor buffer.
15881
15882 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
15883 from wrapping its output.
15884
15885 @item set pagination on
15886 @itemx set pagination off
15887 @kindex set pagination
15888 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
15889 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
15890
15891 @item show pagination
15892 @kindex show pagination
15893 Show the current pagination mode.
15894 @end table
15895
15896 @node Numbers
15897 @section Numbers
15898 @cindex number representation
15899 @cindex entering numbers
15900
15901 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
15902 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
15903 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
15904 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
15905 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
15906 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
15907 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
15908 both input and output with the commands described below.
15909
15910 @table @code
15911 @kindex set input-radix
15912 @item set input-radix @var{base}
15913 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
15914 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15915 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
15916 example, any of
15917
15918 @smallexample
15919 set input-radix 012
15920 set input-radix 10.
15921 set input-radix 0xa
15922 @end smallexample
15923
15924 @noindent
15925 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
15926 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
15927 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
15928 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
15929 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
15930 change the radix.
15931
15932 @kindex set output-radix
15933 @item set output-radix @var{base}
15934 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
15935 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
15936 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
15937
15938 @kindex show input-radix
15939 @item show input-radix
15940 Display the current default base for numeric input.
15941
15942 @kindex show output-radix
15943 @item show output-radix
15944 Display the current default base for numeric display.
15945
15946 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
15947 @itemx show radix
15948 @kindex set radix
15949 @kindex show radix
15950 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
15951 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
15952 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
15953 default value of 10.
15954
15955 @end table
15956
15957 @node ABI
15958 @section Configuring the current ABI
15959
15960 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
15961 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
15962 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
15963 current ABI.
15964
15965 @cindex OS ABI
15966 @kindex set osabi
15967 @kindex show osabi
15968
15969 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
15970 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
15971 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
15972 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
15973 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
15974 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
15975 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
15976 platform provides.
15977
15978 @table @code
15979 @item show osabi
15980 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
15981
15982 @item set osabi
15983 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
15984
15985 @item set osabi @var{abi}
15986 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
15987 @end table
15988
15989 @cindex float promotion
15990
15991 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
15992 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
15993 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
15994 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
15995 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
15996 @code{double} and then passed.
15997
15998 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
15999 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
16000 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
16001
16002 @table @code
16003 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
16004 @item set coerce-float-to-double
16005 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
16006 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
16007 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
16008
16009 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
16010 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
16011 functions.
16012
16013 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
16014 @item show coerce-float-to-double
16015 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
16016 @end table
16017
16018 @kindex set cp-abi
16019 @kindex show cp-abi
16020 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
16021 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
16022 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
16023 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
16024 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
16025 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
16026 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
16027 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
16028 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
16029 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
16030 ``auto''.
16031
16032 @table @code
16033 @item show cp-abi
16034 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
16035
16036 @item set cp-abi
16037 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
16038
16039 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
16040 @itemx set cp-abi auto
16041 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
16042 @end table
16043
16044 @node Messages/Warnings
16045 @section Optional warnings and messages
16046
16047 @cindex verbose operation
16048 @cindex optional warnings
16049 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
16050 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
16051 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
16052 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
16053
16054 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
16055 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
16056 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
16057
16058 @table @code
16059 @kindex set verbose
16060 @item set verbose on
16061 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16062
16063 @item set verbose off
16064 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
16065
16066 @kindex show verbose
16067 @item show verbose
16068 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
16069 @end table
16070
16071 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
16072 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
16073 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
16074 symbol files}).
16075
16076 @table @code
16077
16078 @kindex set complaints
16079 @item set complaints @var{limit}
16080 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
16081 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
16082 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
16083 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
16084
16085 @kindex show complaints
16086 @item show complaints
16087 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
16088
16089 @end table
16090
16091 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
16092 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
16093 you try to run a program which is already running:
16094
16095 @smallexample
16096 (@value{GDBP}) run
16097 The program being debugged has been started already.
16098 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
16099 @end smallexample
16100
16101 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
16102 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
16103
16104 @table @code
16105
16106 @kindex set confirm
16107 @cindex flinching
16108 @cindex confirmation
16109 @cindex stupid questions
16110 @item set confirm off
16111 Disables confirmation requests.
16112
16113 @item set confirm on
16114 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
16115
16116 @kindex show confirm
16117 @item show confirm
16118 Displays state of confirmation requests.
16119
16120 @end table
16121
16122 @cindex command tracing
16123 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
16124 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
16125 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
16126 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
16127
16128 @table @code
16129 @kindex set trace-commands
16130 @cindex command scripts, debugging
16131 @item set trace-commands on
16132 Enable command tracing.
16133 @item set trace-commands off
16134 Disable command tracing.
16135 @item show trace-commands
16136 Display the current state of command tracing.
16137 @end table
16138
16139 @node Debugging Output
16140 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
16141 @cindex optional debugging messages
16142
16143 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
16144 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
16145 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
16146 section documents those commands.
16147
16148 @table @code
16149 @kindex set exec-done-display
16150 @item set exec-done-display
16151 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
16152 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
16153 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
16154 @kindex show exec-done-display
16155 @item show exec-done-display
16156 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
16157 notification.
16158 @kindex set debug
16159 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
16160 @cindex architecture debugging info
16161 @item set debug arch
16162 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
16163 @kindex show debug
16164 @item show debug arch
16165 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
16166 @item set debug aix-thread
16167 @cindex AIX threads
16168 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
16169 module.
16170 @item show debug aix-thread
16171 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
16172 @item set debug event
16173 @cindex event debugging info
16174 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
16175 default is off.
16176 @item show debug event
16177 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
16178 info.
16179 @item set debug expression
16180 @cindex expression debugging info
16181 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
16182 expression parsing. The default is off.
16183 @item show debug expression
16184 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
16185 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
16186 @item set debug frame
16187 @cindex frame debugging info
16188 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
16189 default is off.
16190 @item show debug frame
16191 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
16192 info.
16193 @item set debug infrun
16194 @cindex inferior debugging info
16195 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
16196 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
16197 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
16198 @item show debug infrun
16199 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
16200 @item set debug lin-lwp
16201 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
16202 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
16203 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
16204 @item show debug lin-lwp
16205 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
16206 @item set debug observer
16207 @cindex observer debugging info
16208 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
16209 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
16210 @item show debug observer
16211 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
16212 @item set debug overload
16213 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
16214 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
16215 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
16216 is off.
16217 @item show debug overload
16218 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
16219 debugging info.
16220 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
16221 @cindex serial connections, debugging
16222 @cindex debug remote protocol
16223 @cindex remote protocol debugging
16224 @cindex display remote packets
16225 @item set debug remote
16226 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
16227 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
16228 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
16229 @item show debug remote
16230 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
16231 @item set debug serial
16232 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
16233 default is off.
16234 @item show debug serial
16235 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
16236 info.
16237 @item set debug solib-frv
16238 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
16239 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
16240 @item show debug solib-frv
16241 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
16242 messages.
16243 @item set debug target
16244 @cindex target debugging info
16245 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
16246 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
16247 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
16248 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
16249 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
16250 @item show debug target
16251 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
16252 info.
16253 @item set debugvarobj
16254 @cindex variable object debugging info
16255 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
16256 info. The default is off.
16257 @item show debugvarobj
16258 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
16259 debugging info.
16260 @end table
16261
16262 @node Sequences
16263 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
16264
16265 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
16266 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
16267 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
16268 files.
16269
16270 @menu
16271 * Define:: How to define your own commands
16272 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
16273 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
16274 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
16275 @end menu
16276
16277 @node Define
16278 @section User-defined commands
16279
16280 @cindex user-defined command
16281 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
16282 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
16283 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
16284 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
16285 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
16286 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
16287
16288 @smallexample
16289 define adder
16290 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16291 end
16292 @end smallexample
16293
16294 @noindent
16295 To execute the command use:
16296
16297 @smallexample
16298 adder 1 2 3
16299 @end smallexample
16300
16301 @noindent
16302 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
16303 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
16304 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
16305 functions calls.
16306
16307 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
16308 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
16309 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
16310 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
16311
16312 @smallexample
16313 define adder
16314 if $argc == 2
16315 print $arg0 + $arg1
16316 end
16317 if $argc == 3
16318 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
16319 end
16320 end
16321 @end smallexample
16322
16323 @table @code
16324
16325 @kindex define
16326 @item define @var{commandname}
16327 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
16328 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
16329
16330 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
16331 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
16332 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16333
16334 @kindex document
16335 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
16336 @item document @var{commandname}
16337 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
16338 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
16339 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
16340 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
16341 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
16342 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
16343
16344 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
16345 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
16346 does not change the documentation.
16347
16348 @kindex dont-repeat
16349 @cindex don't repeat command
16350 @item dont-repeat
16351 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
16352 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
16353 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
16354
16355 @kindex help user-defined
16356 @item help user-defined
16357 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
16358 (if any) for each.
16359
16360 @kindex show user
16361 @item show user
16362 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
16363 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
16364 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
16365 definitions for all user-defined commands.
16366
16367 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
16368 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
16369 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
16370 @item show max-user-call-depth
16371 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
16372 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
16373 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
16374 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
16375 @end table
16376
16377 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
16378 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
16379
16380 When user-defined commands are executed, the
16381 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
16382 stops execution of the user-defined command.
16383
16384 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
16385 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
16386 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
16387 messages when used in a user-defined command.
16388
16389 @node Hooks
16390 @section User-defined command hooks
16391 @cindex command hooks
16392 @cindex hooks, for commands
16393 @cindex hooks, pre-command
16394
16395 @kindex hook
16396 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
16397 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
16398 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
16399 before that command.
16400
16401 @cindex hooks, post-command
16402 @kindex hookpost
16403 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
16404 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
16405 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
16406 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
16407 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
16408
16409 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
16410 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
16411
16412 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
16413 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
16414
16415 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
16416 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
16417 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
16418 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
16419 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
16420
16421 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
16422 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
16423 you could define:
16424
16425 @smallexample
16426 define hook-stop
16427 handle SIGALRM nopass
16428 end
16429
16430 define hook-run
16431 handle SIGALRM pass
16432 end
16433
16434 define hook-continue
16435 handle SIGLARM pass
16436 end
16437 @end smallexample
16438
16439 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
16440 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
16441 you could define:
16442
16443 @smallexample
16444 define hook-echo
16445 echo <<<---
16446 end
16447
16448 define hookpost-echo
16449 echo --->>>\n
16450 end
16451
16452 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
16453 <<<---Hello World--->>>
16454 (@value{GDBP})
16455
16456 @end smallexample
16457
16458 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
16459 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
16460 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
16461 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
16462 @c or not?
16463 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
16464 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
16465 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
16466
16467 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
16468 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
16469
16470 @node Command Files
16471 @section Command files
16472
16473 @cindex command files
16474 @cindex scripting commands
16475 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
16476 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
16477 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
16478 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
16479 terminal.
16480
16481 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
16482 command:
16483
16484 @table @code
16485 @kindex source
16486 @cindex execute commands from a file
16487 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
16488 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
16489 @end table
16490
16491 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
16492 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
16493 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
16494 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
16495 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
16496
16497 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
16498 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
16499
16500 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
16501 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
16502 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
16503
16504 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
16505 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
16506 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
16507 when called from command files.
16508
16509 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
16510 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
16511 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
16512 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
16513 the next command.
16514
16515 @smallexample
16516 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
16517 @end smallexample
16518
16519 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
16520 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
16521 would be directed to @file{log}.
16522
16523 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
16524 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
16525 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
16526 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
16527 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
16528 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
16529 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
16530 conditionally, etc.
16531
16532 @table @code
16533 @kindex if
16534 @kindex else
16535 @item if
16536 @itemx else
16537 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
16538 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
16539 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
16540 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
16541 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
16542 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
16543 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
16544
16545 @kindex while
16546 @item while
16547 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
16548 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
16549 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
16550 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
16551 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
16552 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
16553
16554 @kindex loop_break
16555 @item loop_break
16556 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
16557 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
16558 line.
16559
16560 @kindex loop_continue
16561 @item loop_continue
16562 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
16563 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
16564 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
16565 the controlling expression.
16566
16567 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
16568 @item end
16569 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
16570 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
16571 @end table
16572
16573
16574 @node Output
16575 @section Commands for controlled output
16576
16577 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
16578 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
16579 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
16580 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
16581 want.
16582
16583 @table @code
16584 @kindex echo
16585 @item echo @var{text}
16586 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
16587 @c because it is not in ANSI.
16588 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
16589 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
16590 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
16591 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
16592 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
16593 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
16594 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
16595 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
16596 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
16597
16598 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
16599 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
16600
16601 @smallexample
16602 echo This is some text\n\
16603 which is continued\n\
16604 onto several lines.\n
16605 @end smallexample
16606
16607 produces the same output as
16608
16609 @smallexample
16610 echo This is some text\n
16611 echo which is continued\n
16612 echo onto several lines.\n
16613 @end smallexample
16614
16615 @kindex output
16616 @item output @var{expression}
16617 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
16618 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
16619 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
16620 on expressions.
16621
16622 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
16623 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
16624 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
16625 formats}, for more information.
16626
16627 @kindex printf
16628 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
16629 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
16630 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
16631 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
16632 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
16633 subroutine
16634 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
16635 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
16636 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
16637 @c supported.
16638
16639 @smallexample
16640 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
16641 @end smallexample
16642
16643 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
16644
16645 @smallexample
16646 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
16647 @end smallexample
16648
16649 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
16650 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
16651 letter.
16652 @end table
16653
16654 @node Interpreters
16655 @chapter Command Interpreters
16656 @cindex command interpreters
16657
16658 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
16659 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
16660 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
16661
16662 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
16663 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
16664 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
16665 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
16666
16667 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
16668 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
16669 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
16670 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
16671
16672 @table @code
16673 @item console
16674 @cindex console interpreter
16675 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
16676 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
16677 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
16678
16679 @item mi
16680 @cindex mi interpreter
16681 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
16682 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
16683 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
16684 Interface}.
16685
16686 @item mi2
16687 @cindex mi2 interpreter
16688 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
16689
16690 @item mi1
16691 @cindex mi1 interpreter
16692 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
16693
16694 @end table
16695
16696 @cindex invoke another interpreter
16697 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
16698 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
16699 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
16700 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
16701 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
16702 the IDE inoperable!
16703
16704 @kindex interpreter-exec
16705 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
16706 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
16707 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
16708 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
16709
16710 @smallexample
16711 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
16712 @end smallexample
16713
16714 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
16715 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
16716
16717 @node TUI
16718 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
16719 @cindex TUI
16720 @cindex Text User Interface
16721
16722 @menu
16723 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
16724 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
16725 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
16726 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
16727 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
16728 @end menu
16729
16730 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short, is a terminal
16731 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
16732 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
16733 commands in separate text windows.
16734
16735 The TUI is enabled by invoking @value{GDBN} using either
16736 @pindex gdbtui
16737 @samp{gdbtui} or @samp{gdb -tui}.
16738
16739 @node TUI Overview
16740 @section TUI overview
16741
16742 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
16743 @value{GDBN} runs:
16744
16745 @itemize @bullet
16746 @item
16747 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
16748 windows on the terminal.
16749
16750 @item
16751 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
16752 the TUI.
16753 @end itemize
16754
16755 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
16756 on the terminal:
16757
16758 @table @emph
16759 @item command
16760 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
16761 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
16762 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
16763 window is always visible.
16764
16765 @item source
16766 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
16767 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
16768
16769 @item assembly
16770 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
16771
16772 @item register
16773 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
16774 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
16775 changed are highlighted.
16776
16777 @end table
16778
16779 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
16780 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
16781 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
16782 indicates the breakpoint type:
16783
16784 @table @code
16785 @item B
16786 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16787
16788 @item b
16789 Breakpoint which was never hit.
16790
16791 @item H
16792 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
16793
16794 @item h
16795 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
16796
16797 @end table
16798
16799 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
16800
16801 @table @code
16802 @item +
16803 Breakpoint is enabled.
16804
16805 @item -
16806 Breakpoint is disabled.
16807
16808 @end table
16809
16810 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
16811 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
16812 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
16813 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
16814 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
16815 The following layouts are available:
16816
16817 @itemize @bullet
16818 @item
16819 source
16820
16821 @item
16822 assembly
16823
16824 @item
16825 source and assembly
16826
16827 @item
16828 source and registers
16829
16830 @item
16831 assembly and registers
16832
16833 @end itemize
16834
16835 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
16836 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
16837 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
16838 are displayed:
16839
16840 @table @emph
16841 @item target
16842 Indicates the current gdb target
16843 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
16844
16845 @item process
16846 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
16847 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
16848
16849 @item function
16850 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
16851 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
16852 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
16853 the string @code{??} is displayed.
16854
16855 @item line
16856 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
16857 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
16858
16859 @item pc
16860 Indicates the current program counter address.
16861
16862 @end table
16863
16864 @node TUI Keys
16865 @section TUI Key Bindings
16866 @cindex TUI key bindings
16867
16868 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
16869 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
16870 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
16871 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
16872 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
16873 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
16874 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
16875
16876 @table @kbd
16877 @kindex C-x C-a
16878 @item C-x C-a
16879 @kindex C-x a
16880 @itemx C-x a
16881 @kindex C-x A
16882 @itemx C-x A
16883 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
16884 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
16885 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
16886 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
16887 The screen is then refreshed.
16888
16889 @kindex C-x 1
16890 @item C-x 1
16891 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
16892 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
16893 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
16894
16895 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
16896
16897 @kindex C-x 2
16898 @item C-x 2
16899 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
16900 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
16901 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
16902 previous layout and the new one.
16903
16904 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
16905
16906 @kindex C-x o
16907 @item C-x o
16908 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
16909 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
16910 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
16911
16912 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
16913
16914 @kindex C-x s
16915 @item C-x s
16916 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
16917 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
16918
16919 @end table
16920
16921 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
16922
16923 @table @key
16924 @kindex PgUp
16925 @item PgUp
16926 Scroll the active window one page up.
16927
16928 @kindex PgDn
16929 @item PgDn
16930 Scroll the active window one page down.
16931
16932 @kindex Up
16933 @item Up
16934 Scroll the active window one line up.
16935
16936 @kindex Down
16937 @item Down
16938 Scroll the active window one line down.
16939
16940 @kindex Left
16941 @item Left
16942 Scroll the active window one column left.
16943
16944 @kindex Right
16945 @item Right
16946 Scroll the active window one column right.
16947
16948 @kindex C-L
16949 @item C-L
16950 Refresh the screen.
16951
16952 @end table
16953
16954 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
16955 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
16956 active window is the command window. When the command window
16957 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
16958 key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b} and @kbd{C-f}.
16959
16960 @node TUI Single Key Mode
16961 @section TUI Single Key Mode
16962 @cindex TUI single key mode
16963
16964 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
16965 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
16966 some gdb commands.
16967
16968 @table @kbd
16969 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16970 @item c
16971 continue
16972
16973 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16974 @item d
16975 down
16976
16977 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16978 @item f
16979 finish
16980
16981 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16982 @item n
16983 next
16984
16985 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16986 @item q
16987 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
16988
16989 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16990 @item r
16991 run
16992
16993 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16994 @item s
16995 step
16996
16997 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
16998 @item u
16999 up
17000
17001 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17002 @item v
17003 info locals
17004
17005 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
17006 @item w
17007 where
17008
17009 @end table
17010
17011 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
17012 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
17013 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
17014 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
17015 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
17016 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
17017
17018
17019 @node TUI Commands
17020 @section TUI specific commands
17021 @cindex TUI commands
17022
17023 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
17024 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
17025 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
17026 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
17027 in the TUI mode.
17028
17029 @table @code
17030 @item info win
17031 @kindex info win
17032 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
17033
17034 @item layout next
17035 @kindex layout
17036 Display the next layout.
17037
17038 @item layout prev
17039 Display the previous layout.
17040
17041 @item layout src
17042 Display the source window only.
17043
17044 @item layout asm
17045 Display the assembly window only.
17046
17047 @item layout split
17048 Display the source and assembly window.
17049
17050 @item layout regs
17051 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
17052
17053 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
17054 @kindex focus
17055 Set the focus to the named window.
17056 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
17057 can be affected to another window.
17058
17059 @item refresh
17060 @kindex refresh
17061 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
17062
17063 @item tui reg float
17064 @kindex tui reg
17065 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
17066
17067 @item tui reg general
17068 Show the general registers in the register window.
17069
17070 @item tui reg next
17071 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
17072 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
17073 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
17074 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
17075
17076 @item tui reg system
17077 Show the system registers in the register window.
17078
17079 @item update
17080 @kindex update
17081 Update the source window and the current execution point.
17082
17083 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
17084 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
17085 @kindex winheight
17086 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
17087 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
17088 decrease it.
17089
17090 @item tabset
17091 @kindex tabset @var{nchars}
17092 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
17093
17094 @end table
17095
17096 @node TUI Configuration
17097 @section TUI configuration variables
17098 @cindex TUI configuration variables
17099
17100 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
17101 appearance of windows on the terminal.
17102
17103 @table @code
17104 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
17105 @kindex set tui border-kind
17106 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
17107 The possible values are the following:
17108 @table @code
17109 @item space
17110 Use a space character to draw the border.
17111
17112 @item ascii
17113 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
17114
17115 @item acs
17116 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
17117 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
17118
17119 @end table
17120
17121 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
17122 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
17123 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
17124 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
17125 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
17126
17127 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
17128 @kindex set tui border-mode
17129 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
17130 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
17131 @table @code
17132 @item normal
17133 Use normal attributes to display the border.
17134
17135 @item standout
17136 Use standout mode.
17137
17138 @item reverse
17139 Use reverse video mode.
17140
17141 @item half
17142 Use half bright mode.
17143
17144 @item half-standout
17145 Use half bright and standout mode.
17146
17147 @item bold
17148 Use extra bright or bold mode.
17149
17150 @item bold-standout
17151 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
17152
17153 @end table
17154
17155 @end table
17156
17157 @node Emacs
17158 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
17159
17160 @cindex Emacs
17161 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
17162 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
17163 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
17164 @value{GDBN}.
17165
17166 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
17167 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
17168 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
17169 created Emacs buffer.
17170 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
17171
17172 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
17173 things:
17174
17175 @itemize @bullet
17176 @item
17177 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
17178 @end itemize
17179
17180 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
17181 and output done by the program you are debugging.
17182
17183 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
17184 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
17185 in this way.
17186
17187 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
17188 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
17189 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
17190 stop.
17191
17192 @itemize @bullet
17193 @item
17194 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
17195 @end itemize
17196
17197 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
17198 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
17199 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
17200 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
17201 and the source.
17202
17203 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
17204 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
17205
17206 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
17207 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
17208 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
17209 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
17210 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
17211 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
17212 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
17213 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
17214 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
17215
17216 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
17217 line of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer and this serves as a default for
17218 the commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate
17219 on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
17220
17221 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
17222 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
17223 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
17224 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
17225 one you want.
17226
17227 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
17228 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
17229
17230 @table @kbd
17231 @item C-h m
17232 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
17233
17234 @item C-c C-s
17235 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
17236 update the display window to show the current file and location.
17237
17238 @item C-c C-n
17239 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
17240 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
17241 to show the current file and location.
17242
17243 @item C-c C-i
17244 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
17245 display window accordingly.
17246
17247 @item C-c C-f
17248 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
17249 @code{finish} command.
17250
17251 @item C-c C-r
17252 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
17253 command.
17254
17255 @item C-c <
17256 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
17257 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
17258 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
17259
17260 @item C-c >
17261 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
17262 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
17263 @end table
17264
17265 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
17266 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
17267
17268 If you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, then Emacs displays a separate frame which
17269 shows a backtrace when the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer is current. Move
17270 point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it become the
17271 current frame and display the associated source in the source buffer.
17272 Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the selected frame become the
17273 current one.
17274
17275 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
17276 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
17277 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
17278 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
17279 frame.
17280
17281 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
17282 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
17283 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
17284 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
17285 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
17286 to correspond properly with the code.
17287
17288 The description given here is for GNU Emacs version 21.3 and a more
17289 detailed description of its interaction with @value{GDBN} is given in
17290 the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}).
17291
17292 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
17293 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
17294 @ignore
17295 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
17296 @kindex Epoch
17297 @kindex inspect
17298
17299 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
17300 called the @code{epoch}
17301 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
17302 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
17303 each value is printed in its own window.
17304 @end ignore
17305
17306
17307 @node GDB/MI
17308 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
17309
17310 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
17311
17312 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
17313 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
17314 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
17315 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
17316 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
17317 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
17318
17319 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
17320 in the form of a reference manual.
17321
17322 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
17323 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
17324 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
17325
17326 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
17327
17328 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
17329 This chapter uses the following notation:
17330
17331 @itemize @bullet
17332 @item
17333 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
17334
17335 @item
17336 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
17337 it may or may not be given.
17338
17339 @item
17340 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17341 may repeat zero or more times.
17342
17343 @item
17344 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
17345 may repeat one or more times.
17346
17347 @item
17348 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
17349 @end itemize
17350
17351 @ignore
17352 @heading Dependencies
17353 @end ignore
17354
17355 @menu
17356 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
17357 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
17358 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
17359 * GDB/MI Output Records::
17360 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
17361 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
17362 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
17363 * GDB/MI Program Context::
17364 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
17365 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
17366 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
17367 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
17368 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
17369 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
17370 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
17371 * GDB/MI File Commands::
17372 @ignore
17373 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
17374 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
17375 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
17376 @end ignore
17377 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
17378 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
17379 @end menu
17380
17381 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17382 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
17383 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
17384
17385 @menu
17386 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
17387 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
17388 @end menu
17389
17390 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
17391 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
17392
17393 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
17394 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
17395 @table @code
17396 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
17397 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
17398
17399 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
17400 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
17401 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
17402
17403 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
17404 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
17405 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
17406
17407 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17408 "any sequence of digits"
17409
17410 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
17411 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
17412
17413 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
17414 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
17415
17416 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
17417 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
17418
17419 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
17420 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
17421 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
17422
17423 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
17424 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
17425
17426 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17427 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17428 @end table
17429
17430 @noindent
17431 Notes:
17432
17433 @itemize @bullet
17434 @item
17435 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
17436 output is described below.
17437
17438 @item
17439 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
17440 finishes.
17441
17442 @item
17443 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
17444 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
17445 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
17446 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
17447 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
17448 @end itemize
17449
17450 Pragmatics:
17451
17452 @itemize @bullet
17453 @item
17454 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
17455
17456 @item
17457 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
17458 @end itemize
17459
17460 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
17461 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
17462
17463 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
17464 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
17465 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
17466 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
17467 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
17468 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
17469
17470 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
17471 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
17472 @var{token}.
17473
17474 @table @code
17475 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
17476 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
17477
17478 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
17479 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17480
17481 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
17482 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
17483
17484 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
17485 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
17486
17487 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
17488 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
17489
17490 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
17491 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
17492
17493 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
17494 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
17495
17496 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
17497 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
17498
17499 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
17500 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
17501
17502 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
17503 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
17504 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
17505
17506 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
17507 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
17508
17509 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
17510 @code{ @var{string} }
17511
17512 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
17513 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
17514
17515 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
17516 @code{@var{c-string}}
17517
17518 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
17519 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
17520
17521 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
17522 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
17523 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
17524
17525 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
17526 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
17527
17528 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
17529 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
17530
17531 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
17532 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
17533
17534 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
17535 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
17536
17537 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
17538 @code{CR | CR-LF}
17539
17540 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
17541 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
17542 @end table
17543
17544 @noindent
17545 Notes:
17546
17547 @itemize @bullet
17548 @item
17549 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
17550
17551 @item
17552 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
17553 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
17554 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
17555 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
17556
17557 @item
17558 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17559 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
17560 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
17561 prefixed by @samp{+}.
17562
17563 @item
17564 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17565 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
17566 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
17567 @samp{*}.
17568
17569 @item
17570 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17571 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
17572 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
17573 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
17574
17575 @item
17576 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17577 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
17578 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
17579 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
17580
17581 @item
17582 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17583 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
17584 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
17585
17586 @item
17587 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17588 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
17589 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
17590 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
17591
17592 @item
17593 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
17594 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
17595 @var{values}.
17596
17597
17598 @end itemize
17599
17600 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
17601 details about the various output records.
17602
17603 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17604 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
17605 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
17606
17607 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
17608 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
17609
17610 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
17611 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
17612 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
17613 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
17614 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
17615 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
17616
17617 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
17618 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
17619 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
17620
17621 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17622 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
17623 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
17624 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
17625
17626 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
17627 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
17628
17629 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
17630 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
17631 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
17632 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
17633 might change.
17634
17635 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
17636 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
17637 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
17638 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
17639
17640 @itemize @bullet
17641 @item
17642 New MI commands may be added.
17643
17644 @item
17645 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
17646
17647 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
17648 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
17649
17650 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
17651 @c resolve inconsistencies.
17652 @end itemize
17653
17654 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
17655 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
17656 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
17657 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
17658 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
17659
17660 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
17661 @c version?
17662
17663 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
17664 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
17665 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
17666 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}. There is also the mailing list
17667 @email{dmi-discuss@@lists.freestandards.org}, hosted by the Free Standards
17668 Group, which has the aim of creating a a more general MI protocol
17669 called Debugger Machine Interface (DMI) that will become a standard
17670 for all debuggers, not just @value{GDBN}.
17671 @cindex mailing lists
17672
17673 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17674 @node GDB/MI Output Records
17675 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
17676
17677 @menu
17678 * GDB/MI Result Records::
17679 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
17680 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
17681 @end menu
17682
17683 @node GDB/MI Result Records
17684 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
17685
17686 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17687 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
17688 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
17689 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
17690
17691 @table @code
17692 @findex ^done
17693 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
17694 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
17695 values.
17696
17697 @item "^running"
17698 @findex ^running
17699 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
17700 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
17701 running.
17702
17703 @item "^connected"
17704 @findex ^connected
17705 GDB has connected to a remote target.
17706
17707 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
17708 @findex ^error
17709 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
17710 error message.
17711
17712 @item "^exit"
17713 @findex ^exit
17714 GDB has terminated.
17715
17716 @end table
17717
17718 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
17719 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
17720
17721 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
17722 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17723 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
17724 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
17725 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
17726
17727 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
17728 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
17729 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
17730 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
17731 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
17732
17733 @table @code
17734 @item "~" @var{string-output}
17735 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
17736 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
17737
17738 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
17739 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
17740 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
17741 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
17742
17743 @item "&" @var{string-output}
17744 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
17745 internals.
17746 @end table
17747
17748 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
17749 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
17750
17751 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
17752 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
17753 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
17754 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
17755 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
17756 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
17757
17758 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
17759 In particular, the @var{exec-async-output} records.
17760
17761 @table @code
17762 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}"
17763 @end table
17764
17765 @var{reason} can be one of the following:
17766
17767 @table @code
17768 @item breakpoint-hit
17769 A breakpoint was reached.
17770 @item watchpoint-trigger
17771 A watchpoint was triggered.
17772 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
17773 A read watchpoint was triggered.
17774 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
17775 An access watchpoint was triggered.
17776 @item function-finished
17777 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17778 @item location-reached
17779 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
17780 @item watchpoint-scope
17781 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
17782 @item end-stepping-range
17783 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
17784 similar CLI command was accomplished.
17785 @item exited-signalled
17786 The inferior exited because of a signal.
17787 @item exited
17788 The inferior exited.
17789 @item exited-normally
17790 The inferior exited normally.
17791 @item signal-received
17792 A signal was received by the inferior.
17793 @end table
17794
17795
17796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17797 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
17798 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
17799 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
17800
17801 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
17802 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
17803 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
17804 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
17805
17806 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
17807 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
17808
17809 @subheading Setting a breakpoint
17810
17811 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
17812 information of the breakpoint.
17813
17814 @smallexample
17815 -> -break-insert main
17816 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
17817 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
17818 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
17819 <- (gdb)
17820 @end smallexample
17821
17822 @subheading Program Execution
17823
17824 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
17825 reason that execution stopped.
17826
17827 @smallexample
17828 -> -exec-run
17829 <- ^running
17830 <- (gdb)
17831 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
17832 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
17833 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
17834 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
17835 <- (gdb)
17836 -> -exec-continue
17837 <- ^running
17838 <- (gdb)
17839 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
17840 <- (gdb)
17841 @end smallexample
17842
17843 @subheading Quitting GDB
17844
17845 Quitting GDB just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
17846
17847 @smallexample
17848 -> (gdb)
17849 <- -gdb-exit
17850 <- ^exit
17851 @end smallexample
17852
17853 @subheading A Bad Command
17854
17855 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
17856
17857 @smallexample
17858 -> -rubbish
17859 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
17860 <- (gdb)
17861 @end smallexample
17862
17863
17864 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17865 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
17866 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
17867
17868 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
17869 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
17870
17871 @subheading Motivation
17872
17873 The motivation for this collection of commands.
17874
17875 @subheading Introduction
17876
17877 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
17878
17879 @subheading Commands
17880
17881 For each command in the block, the following is described:
17882
17883 @subsubheading Synopsis
17884
17885 @smallexample
17886 -command @var{args}@dots{}
17887 @end smallexample
17888
17889 @subsubheading Result
17890
17891 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17892
17893 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
17894
17895 @subsubheading Example
17896
17897 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
17898 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
17899
17900
17901 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17902 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
17903 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
17904
17905 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
17906 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
17907 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
17908 breakpoints.
17909
17910 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
17911 @findex -break-after
17912
17913 @subsubheading Synopsis
17914
17915 @smallexample
17916 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
17917 @end smallexample
17918
17919 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
17920 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
17921 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
17922 @samp{-break-list} command below.
17923
17924 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17925
17926 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
17927
17928 @subsubheading Example
17929
17930 @smallexample
17931 (gdb)
17932 -break-insert main
17933 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",
17934 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
17935 (gdb)
17936 -break-after 1 3
17937 ~
17938 ^done
17939 (gdb)
17940 -break-list
17941 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17942 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17943 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17944 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17945 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17946 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17947 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17948 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17949 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17950 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17951 (gdb)
17952 @end smallexample
17953
17954 @ignore
17955 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
17956 @findex -break-catch
17957
17958 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
17959 @findex -break-commands
17960 @end ignore
17961
17962
17963 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
17964 @findex -break-condition
17965
17966 @subsubheading Synopsis
17967
17968 @smallexample
17969 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
17970 @end smallexample
17971
17972 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
17973 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
17974 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
17975 command below).
17976
17977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17978
17979 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
17980
17981 @subsubheading Example
17982
17983 @smallexample
17984 (gdb)
17985 -break-condition 1 1
17986 ^done
17987 (gdb)
17988 -break-list
17989 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
17990 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
17991 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
17992 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
17993 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
17994 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
17995 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
17996 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
17997 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
17998 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
17999 (gdb)
18000 @end smallexample
18001
18002 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
18003 @findex -break-delete
18004
18005 @subsubheading Synopsis
18006
18007 @smallexample
18008 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18009 @end smallexample
18010
18011 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
18012 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
18013
18014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18015
18016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
18017
18018 @subsubheading Example
18019
18020 @smallexample
18021 (gdb)
18022 -break-delete 1
18023 ^done
18024 (gdb)
18025 -break-list
18026 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18027 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18028 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18029 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18030 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18031 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18032 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18033 body=[]@}
18034 (gdb)
18035 @end smallexample
18036
18037 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
18038 @findex -break-disable
18039
18040 @subsubheading Synopsis
18041
18042 @smallexample
18043 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18044 @end smallexample
18045
18046 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
18047 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
18048
18049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18050
18051 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
18052
18053 @subsubheading Example
18054
18055 @smallexample
18056 (gdb)
18057 -break-disable 2
18058 ^done
18059 (gdb)
18060 -break-list
18061 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18062 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18063 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18064 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18065 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18066 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18067 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18068 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
18069 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18070 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18071 (gdb)
18072 @end smallexample
18073
18074 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
18075 @findex -break-enable
18076
18077 @subsubheading Synopsis
18078
18079 @smallexample
18080 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
18081 @end smallexample
18082
18083 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
18084
18085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18086
18087 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
18088
18089 @subsubheading Example
18090
18091 @smallexample
18092 (gdb)
18093 -break-enable 2
18094 ^done
18095 (gdb)
18096 -break-list
18097 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18098 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18099 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18100 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18101 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18102 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18103 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18104 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18105 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18106 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
18107 (gdb)
18108 @end smallexample
18109
18110 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
18111 @findex -break-info
18112
18113 @subsubheading Synopsis
18114
18115 @smallexample
18116 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
18117 @end smallexample
18118
18119 @c REDUNDANT???
18120 Get information about a single breakpoint.
18121
18122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18123
18124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
18125
18126 @subsubheading Example
18127 N.A.
18128
18129 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
18130 @findex -break-insert
18131
18132 @subsubheading Synopsis
18133
18134 @smallexample
18135 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
18136 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
18137 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
18138 @end smallexample
18139
18140 @noindent
18141 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
18142
18143 @itemize @bullet
18144 @item function
18145 @c @item +offset
18146 @c @item -offset
18147 @c @item linenum
18148 @item filename:linenum
18149 @item filename:function
18150 @item *address
18151 @end itemize
18152
18153 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
18154
18155 @table @samp
18156 @item -t
18157 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
18158 @item -h
18159 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
18160 @item -c @var{condition}
18161 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
18162 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
18163 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
18164 @item -r
18165 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
18166 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
18167 expresson.
18168 @end table
18169
18170 @subsubheading Result
18171
18172 The result is in the form:
18173
18174 @smallexample
18175 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
18176 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
18177 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
18178 times="@var{times}"@}
18179 @end smallexample
18180
18181 @noindent
18182 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
18183 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
18184 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
18185 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
18186 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
18187 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
18188 which use the same output).
18189
18190 Note: this format is open to change.
18191 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
18192
18193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18194
18195 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
18196 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
18197
18198 @subsubheading Example
18199
18200 @smallexample
18201 (gdb)
18202 -break-insert main
18203 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
18204 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
18205 (gdb)
18206 -break-insert -t foo
18207 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
18208 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
18209 (gdb)
18210 -break-list
18211 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18212 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18213 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18214 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18215 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18216 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18217 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18218 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18219 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
18220 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
18221 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
18222 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
18223 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
18224 (gdb)
18225 -break-insert -r foo.*
18226 ~int foo(int, int);
18227 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
18228 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
18229 (gdb)
18230 @end smallexample
18231
18232 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
18233 @findex -break-list
18234
18235 @subsubheading Synopsis
18236
18237 @smallexample
18238 -break-list
18239 @end smallexample
18240
18241 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
18242
18243 @table @samp
18244 @item Number
18245 number of the breakpoint
18246 @item Type
18247 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
18248 @item Disposition
18249 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
18250 or @samp{nokeep}
18251 @item Enabled
18252 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
18253 @item Address
18254 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
18255 @item What
18256 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
18257 name, line number
18258 @item Times
18259 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
18260 @end table
18261
18262 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
18263 @code{body} field is an empty list.
18264
18265 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18266
18267 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
18268
18269 @subsubheading Example
18270
18271 @smallexample
18272 (gdb)
18273 -break-list
18274 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18275 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18276 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18277 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18278 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18279 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18280 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18281 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18282 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
18283 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18284 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
18285 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
18286 (gdb)
18287 @end smallexample
18288
18289 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
18290
18291 @smallexample
18292 (gdb)
18293 -break-list
18294 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
18295 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18296 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18297 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18298 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18299 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18300 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18301 body=[]@}
18302 (gdb)
18303 @end smallexample
18304
18305 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
18306 @findex -break-watch
18307
18308 @subsubheading Synopsis
18309
18310 @smallexample
18311 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
18312 @end smallexample
18313
18314 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
18315 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
18316 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
18317 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
18318 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
18319 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
18320 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
18321 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
18322
18323 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
18324 breakpoints inserted.
18325
18326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18327
18328 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
18329 @samp{rwatch}.
18330
18331 @subsubheading Example
18332
18333 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
18334
18335 @smallexample
18336 (gdb)
18337 -break-watch x
18338 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
18339 (gdb)
18340 -exec-continue
18341 ^running
18342 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
18343 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
18344 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
18345 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
18346 (gdb)
18347 @end smallexample
18348
18349 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
18350 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
18351 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
18352
18353 @smallexample
18354 (gdb)
18355 -break-watch C
18356 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
18357 (gdb)
18358 -exec-continue
18359 ^running
18360 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
18361 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18362 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18363 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18364 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18365 (gdb)
18366 -exec-continue
18367 ^running
18368 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
18369 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18370 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18371 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18372 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18373 (gdb)
18374 @end smallexample
18375
18376 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
18377 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
18378 deleted.
18379
18380 @smallexample
18381 (gdb)
18382 -break-watch C
18383 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
18384 (gdb)
18385 -break-list
18386 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18387 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18388 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18389 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18390 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18391 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18392 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18393 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18394 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18395 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18396 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
18397 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18398 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
18399 (gdb)
18400 -exec-continue
18401 ^running
18402 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
18403 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
18404 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18405 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18406 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
18407 (gdb)
18408 -break-list
18409 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
18410 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18411 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18412 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18413 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18414 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18415 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18416 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18417 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18418 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18419 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
18420 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
18421 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
18422 (gdb)
18423 -exec-continue
18424 ^running
18425 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
18426 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
18427 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18428 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18429 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18430 (gdb)
18431 -break-list
18432 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
18433 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
18434 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
18435 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
18436 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
18437 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
18438 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
18439 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
18440 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
18441 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18442 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
18443 times="1"@}]@}
18444 (gdb)
18445 @end smallexample
18446
18447 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18448 @node GDB/MI Program Context
18449 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
18450
18451 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
18452 @findex -exec-arguments
18453
18454
18455 @subsubheading Synopsis
18456
18457 @smallexample
18458 -exec-arguments @var{args}
18459 @end smallexample
18460
18461 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
18462 @samp{-exec-run}.
18463
18464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18465
18466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
18467
18468 @subsubheading Example
18469
18470 @c FIXME!
18471 Don't have one around.
18472
18473
18474 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
18475 @findex -exec-show-arguments
18476
18477 @subsubheading Synopsis
18478
18479 @smallexample
18480 -exec-show-arguments
18481 @end smallexample
18482
18483 Print the arguments of the program.
18484
18485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18486
18487 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
18488
18489 @subsubheading Example
18490 N.A.
18491
18492
18493 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
18494 @findex -environment-cd
18495
18496 @subsubheading Synopsis
18497
18498 @smallexample
18499 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
18500 @end smallexample
18501
18502 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
18503
18504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18505
18506 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
18507
18508 @subsubheading Example
18509
18510 @smallexample
18511 (gdb)
18512 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18513 ^done
18514 (gdb)
18515 @end smallexample
18516
18517
18518 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
18519 @findex -environment-directory
18520
18521 @subsubheading Synopsis
18522
18523 @smallexample
18524 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18525 @end smallexample
18526
18527 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
18528 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
18529 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
18530 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18531 occurs as normal.
18532 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18533 multiple directories in a single command
18534 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18535 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18536 If blanks are needed as
18537 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18538 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18539 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18540 character must not be used
18541 in any directory name.
18542 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
18543
18544 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18545
18546 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
18547
18548 @subsubheading Example
18549
18550 @smallexample
18551 (gdb)
18552 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
18553 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18554 (gdb)
18555 -environment-directory ""
18556 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
18557 (gdb)
18558 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
18559 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
18560 (gdb)
18561 -environment-directory -r
18562 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
18563 (gdb)
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566
18567 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
18568 @findex -environment-path
18569
18570 @subsubheading Synopsis
18571
18572 @smallexample
18573 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
18574 @end smallexample
18575
18576 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
18577 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
18578 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
18579 supplied in addition to the
18580 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
18581 occurs as normal.
18582 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
18583 multiple directories in a single command
18584 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
18585 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
18586 If blanks are needed as
18587 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
18588 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
18589 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
18590 character must not be used
18591 in any directory name.
18592 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
18593
18594
18595 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18596
18597 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
18598
18599 @subsubheading Example
18600
18601 @smallexample
18602 (gdb)
18603 -environment-path
18604 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
18605 (gdb)
18606 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
18607 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
18608 (gdb)
18609 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
18610 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
18611 (gdb)
18612 @end smallexample
18613
18614
18615 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
18616 @findex -environment-pwd
18617
18618 @subsubheading Synopsis
18619
18620 @smallexample
18621 -environment-pwd
18622 @end smallexample
18623
18624 Show the current working directory.
18625
18626 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18627
18628 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
18629
18630 @subsubheading Example
18631
18632 @smallexample
18633 (gdb)
18634 -environment-pwd
18635 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
18636 (gdb)
18637 @end smallexample
18638
18639 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18640 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
18641 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
18642
18643
18644 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
18645 @findex -thread-info
18646
18647 @subsubheading Synopsis
18648
18649 @smallexample
18650 -thread-info
18651 @end smallexample
18652
18653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
18654
18655 No equivalent.
18656
18657 @subsubheading Example
18658 N.A.
18659
18660
18661 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
18662 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
18663
18664 @subsubheading Synopsis
18665
18666 @smallexample
18667 -thread-list-all-threads
18668 @end smallexample
18669
18670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18671
18672 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
18673
18674 @subsubheading Example
18675 N.A.
18676
18677
18678 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
18679 @findex -thread-list-ids
18680
18681 @subsubheading Synopsis
18682
18683 @smallexample
18684 -thread-list-ids
18685 @end smallexample
18686
18687 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
18688 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
18689
18690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18691
18692 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
18693
18694 @subsubheading Example
18695
18696 No threads present, besides the main process:
18697
18698 @smallexample
18699 (gdb)
18700 -thread-list-ids
18701 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
18702 (gdb)
18703 @end smallexample
18704
18705
18706 Several threads:
18707
18708 @smallexample
18709 (gdb)
18710 -thread-list-ids
18711 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18712 number-of-threads="3"
18713 (gdb)
18714 @end smallexample
18715
18716
18717 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
18718 @findex -thread-select
18719
18720 @subsubheading Synopsis
18721
18722 @smallexample
18723 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
18724 @end smallexample
18725
18726 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
18727 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
18728
18729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18730
18731 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
18732
18733 @subsubheading Example
18734
18735 @smallexample
18736 (gdb)
18737 -exec-next
18738 ^running
18739 (gdb)
18740 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
18741 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
18742 (gdb)
18743 -thread-list-ids
18744 ^done,
18745 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
18746 number-of-threads="3"
18747 (gdb)
18748 -thread-select 3
18749 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
18750 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
18751 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
18752 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
18753 (gdb)
18754 @end smallexample
18755
18756 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
18757 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
18758 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
18759
18760 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
18761 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently GDB only really executes
18762 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
18763 other cases.
18764
18765 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
18766 @findex -exec-continue
18767
18768 @subsubheading Synopsis
18769
18770 @smallexample
18771 -exec-continue
18772 @end smallexample
18773
18774 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
18775 encountered, or until the inferior exits.
18776
18777 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18778
18779 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
18780
18781 @subsubheading Example
18782
18783 @smallexample
18784 -exec-continue
18785 ^running
18786 (gdb)
18787 @@Hello world
18788 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
18789 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="13"@}
18790 (gdb)
18791 @end smallexample
18792
18793
18794 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
18795 @findex -exec-finish
18796
18797 @subsubheading Synopsis
18798
18799 @smallexample
18800 -exec-finish
18801 @end smallexample
18802
18803 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
18804 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
18805
18806 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18807
18808 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
18809
18810 @subsubheading Example
18811
18812 Function returning @code{void}.
18813
18814 @smallexample
18815 -exec-finish
18816 ^running
18817 (gdb)
18818 @@hello from foo
18819 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
18820 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
18821 (gdb)
18822 @end smallexample
18823
18824 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
18825 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
18826 value itself.
18827
18828 @smallexample
18829 -exec-finish
18830 ^running
18831 (gdb)
18832 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
18833 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
18834 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
18835 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
18836 (gdb)
18837 @end smallexample
18838
18839
18840 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
18841 @findex -exec-interrupt
18842
18843 @subsubheading Synopsis
18844
18845 @smallexample
18846 -exec-interrupt
18847 @end smallexample
18848
18849 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
18850 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
18851 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
18852 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
18853 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
18854
18855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18856
18857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
18858
18859 @subsubheading Example
18860
18861 @smallexample
18862 (gdb)
18863 111-exec-continue
18864 111^running
18865
18866 (gdb)
18867 222-exec-interrupt
18868 222^done
18869 (gdb)
18870 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
18871 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
18872 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
18873 (gdb)
18874
18875 (gdb)
18876 -exec-interrupt
18877 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
18878 (gdb)
18879 @end smallexample
18880
18881
18882 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
18883 @findex -exec-next
18884
18885 @subsubheading Synopsis
18886
18887 @smallexample
18888 -exec-next
18889 @end smallexample
18890
18891 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
18892 of the next source line is reached.
18893
18894 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18895
18896 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
18897
18898 @subsubheading Example
18899
18900 @smallexample
18901 -exec-next
18902 ^running
18903 (gdb)
18904 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
18905 (gdb)
18906 @end smallexample
18907
18908
18909 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
18910 @findex -exec-next-instruction
18911
18912 @subsubheading Synopsis
18913
18914 @smallexample
18915 -exec-next-instruction
18916 @end smallexample
18917
18918 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
18919 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
18920 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
18921 printed as well.
18922
18923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18924
18925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
18926
18927 @subsubheading Example
18928
18929 @smallexample
18930 (gdb)
18931 -exec-next-instruction
18932 ^running
18933
18934 (gdb)
18935 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
18936 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
18937 (gdb)
18938 @end smallexample
18939
18940
18941 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
18942 @findex -exec-return
18943
18944 @subsubheading Synopsis
18945
18946 @smallexample
18947 -exec-return
18948 @end smallexample
18949
18950 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
18951 Displays the new current frame.
18952
18953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
18954
18955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
18956
18957 @subsubheading Example
18958
18959 @smallexample
18960 (gdb)
18961 200-break-insert callee4
18962 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
18963 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18964 (gdb)
18965 000-exec-run
18966 000^running
18967 (gdb)
18968 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
18969 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
18970 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18971 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
18972 (gdb)
18973 205-break-delete
18974 205^done
18975 (gdb)
18976 111-exec-return
18977 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
18978 args=[@{name="strarg",
18979 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
18980 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
18981 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
18982 (gdb)
18983 @end smallexample
18984
18985
18986 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
18987 @findex -exec-run
18988
18989 @subsubheading Synopsis
18990
18991 @smallexample
18992 -exec-run
18993 @end smallexample
18994
18995 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
18996 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
18997 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
18998 the program has exited exceptionally.
18999
19000 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19001
19002 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
19003
19004 @subsubheading Examples
19005
19006 @smallexample
19007 (gdb)
19008 -break-insert main
19009 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19010 (gdb)
19011 -exec-run
19012 ^running
19013 (gdb)
19014 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
19015 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
19016 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
19017 (gdb)
19018 @end smallexample
19019
19020 @noindent
19021 Program exited normally:
19022
19023 @smallexample
19024 (gdb)
19025 -exec-run
19026 ^running
19027 (gdb)
19028 x = 55
19029 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
19030 (gdb)
19031 @end smallexample
19032
19033 @noindent
19034 Program exited exceptionally:
19035
19036 @smallexample
19037 (gdb)
19038 -exec-run
19039 ^running
19040 (gdb)
19041 x = 55
19042 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
19043 (gdb)
19044 @end smallexample
19045
19046 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
19047 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
19048
19049 @smallexample
19050 (gdb)
19051 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
19052 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
19053 @end smallexample
19054
19055
19056 @c @subheading -exec-signal
19057
19058
19059 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
19060 @findex -exec-step
19061
19062 @subsubheading Synopsis
19063
19064 @smallexample
19065 -exec-step
19066 @end smallexample
19067
19068 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
19069 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
19070 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
19071 function.
19072
19073 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19074
19075 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
19076
19077 @subsubheading Example
19078
19079 Stepping into a function:
19080
19081 @smallexample
19082 -exec-step
19083 ^running
19084 (gdb)
19085 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19086 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
19087 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
19088 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
19089 (gdb)
19090 @end smallexample
19091
19092 Regular stepping:
19093
19094 @smallexample
19095 -exec-step
19096 ^running
19097 (gdb)
19098 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
19099 (gdb)
19100 @end smallexample
19101
19102
19103 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
19104 @findex -exec-step-instruction
19105
19106 @subsubheading Synopsis
19107
19108 @smallexample
19109 -exec-step-instruction
19110 @end smallexample
19111
19112 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
19113 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
19114 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
19115 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
19116 well.
19117
19118 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19119
19120 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
19121
19122 @subsubheading Example
19123
19124 @smallexample
19125 (gdb)
19126 -exec-step-instruction
19127 ^running
19128
19129 (gdb)
19130 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19131 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19132 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19133 (gdb)
19134 -exec-step-instruction
19135 ^running
19136
19137 (gdb)
19138 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
19139 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
19140 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
19141 (gdb)
19142 @end smallexample
19143
19144
19145 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
19146 @findex -exec-until
19147
19148 @subsubheading Synopsis
19149
19150 @smallexample
19151 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
19152 @end smallexample
19153
19154 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
19155 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
19156 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
19157 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
19158
19159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19160
19161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
19162
19163 @subsubheading Example
19164
19165 @smallexample
19166 (gdb)
19167 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
19168 ^running
19169 (gdb)
19170 x = 55
19171 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
19172 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
19173 (gdb)
19174 @end smallexample
19175
19176 @ignore
19177 @subheading -file-clear
19178 Is this going away????
19179 @end ignore
19180
19181 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19182 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
19183 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
19184
19185
19186 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
19187 @findex -stack-info-frame
19188
19189 @subsubheading Synopsis
19190
19191 @smallexample
19192 -stack-info-frame
19193 @end smallexample
19194
19195 Get info on the selected frame.
19196
19197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19198
19199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
19200 (without arguments).
19201
19202 @subsubheading Example
19203
19204 @smallexample
19205 (gdb)
19206 -stack-info-frame
19207 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19208 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19209 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
19210 (gdb)
19211 @end smallexample
19212
19213 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
19214 @findex -stack-info-depth
19215
19216 @subsubheading Synopsis
19217
19218 @smallexample
19219 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
19220 @end smallexample
19221
19222 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
19223 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
19224
19225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19226
19227 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
19228
19229 @subsubheading Example
19230
19231 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
19232
19233 @smallexample
19234 (gdb)
19235 -stack-info-depth
19236 ^done,depth="12"
19237 (gdb)
19238 -stack-info-depth 4
19239 ^done,depth="4"
19240 (gdb)
19241 -stack-info-depth 12
19242 ^done,depth="12"
19243 (gdb)
19244 -stack-info-depth 11
19245 ^done,depth="11"
19246 (gdb)
19247 -stack-info-depth 13
19248 ^done,depth="12"
19249 (gdb)
19250 @end smallexample
19251
19252 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
19253 @findex -stack-list-arguments
19254
19255 @subsubheading Synopsis
19256
19257 @smallexample
19258 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
19259 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19260 @end smallexample
19261
19262 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
19263 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
19264 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
19265 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
19266 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
19267 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
19268 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
19269 which case only existing frames will be returned.
19270
19271 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
19272 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
19273 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
19274
19275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19276
19277 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
19278 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
19279 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
19280
19281 @subsubheading Example
19282
19283 @smallexample
19284 (gdb)
19285 -stack-list-frames
19286 ^done,
19287 stack=[
19288 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
19289 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19290 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
19291 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
19292 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19293 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
19294 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
19295 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19296 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
19297 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
19298 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19299 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
19300 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
19301 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
19302 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
19303 (gdb)
19304 -stack-list-arguments 0
19305 ^done,
19306 stack-args=[
19307 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19308 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
19309 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
19310 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
19311 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19312 (gdb)
19313 -stack-list-arguments 1
19314 ^done,
19315 stack-args=[
19316 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
19317 frame=@{level="1",
19318 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19319 frame=@{level="2",args=[
19320 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19321 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
19322 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
19323 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19324 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
19325 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
19326 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
19327 (gdb)
19328 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
19329 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
19330 (gdb)
19331 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
19332 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
19333 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
19334 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
19335 (gdb)
19336 @end smallexample
19337
19338 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
19339
19340
19341 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
19342 @findex -stack-list-frames
19343
19344 @subsubheading Synopsis
19345
19346 @smallexample
19347 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
19348 @end smallexample
19349
19350 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
19351 following info:
19352
19353 @table @samp
19354 @item @var{level}
19355 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
19356 @item @var{addr}
19357 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
19358 @item @var{func}
19359 Function name.
19360 @item @var{file}
19361 File name of the source file where the function lives.
19362 @item @var{line}
19363 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
19364 @end table
19365
19366 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
19367 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
19368 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
19369 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
19370 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
19371 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
19372 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
19373
19374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19375
19376 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
19377
19378 @subsubheading Example
19379
19380 Full stack backtrace:
19381
19382 @smallexample
19383 (gdb)
19384 -stack-list-frames
19385 ^done,stack=
19386 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
19387 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
19388 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19389 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19390 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19391 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19392 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19393 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19394 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19395 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19396 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19397 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19398 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19399 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19400 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19401 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19402 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19403 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19404 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19405 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19406 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19407 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19408 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
19409 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
19410 (gdb)
19411 @end smallexample
19412
19413 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
19414
19415 @smallexample
19416 (gdb)
19417 -stack-list-frames 3 5
19418 ^done,stack=
19419 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19420 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19421 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19422 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
19423 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19424 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19425 (gdb)
19426 @end smallexample
19427
19428 Show a single frame:
19429
19430 @smallexample
19431 (gdb)
19432 -stack-list-frames 3 3
19433 ^done,stack=
19434 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
19435 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
19436 (gdb)
19437 @end smallexample
19438
19439
19440 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
19441 @findex -stack-list-locals
19442
19443 @subsubheading Synopsis
19444
19445 @smallexample
19446 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
19447 @end smallexample
19448
19449 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
19450 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
19451 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
19452 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
19453 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
19454 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
19455 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
19456 other data types when the the user wishes to explore their values in
19457 more detail.
19458
19459 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19460
19461 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
19462
19463 @subsubheading Example
19464
19465 @smallexample
19466 (gdb)
19467 -stack-list-locals 0
19468 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
19469 (gdb)
19470 -stack-list-locals --all-values
19471 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
19472 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
19473 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
19474 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
19475 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
19476 (gdb)
19477 @end smallexample
19478
19479
19480 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
19481 @findex -stack-select-frame
19482
19483 @subsubheading Synopsis
19484
19485 @smallexample
19486 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
19487 @end smallexample
19488
19489 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
19490 the stack.
19491
19492 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19493
19494 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
19495 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
19496
19497 @subsubheading Example
19498
19499 @smallexample
19500 (gdb)
19501 -stack-select-frame 2
19502 ^done
19503 (gdb)
19504 @end smallexample
19505
19506 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19507 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
19508 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
19509
19510
19511 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19512
19513 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
19514 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
19515 used by @code{Insight}.
19516
19517 The two main reasons for that are:
19518
19519 @enumerate 1
19520 @item
19521 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
19522
19523 @item
19524 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
19525 now).
19526 @end enumerate
19527
19528 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
19529 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
19530 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
19531 hints about their use.
19532
19533 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
19534 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
19535 least, the following operations:
19536
19537 @itemize @bullet
19538 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
19539 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
19540 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
19541 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
19542 @end itemize
19543
19544 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19545
19546 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
19547 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
19548 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
19549 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
19550 examining or changing its properties.
19551
19552 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
19553 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
19554 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
19555 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
19556 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
19557
19558 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
19559 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
19560 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
19561 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
19562 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
19563 for pointers, etc.).
19564
19565 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
19566 access this functionality:
19567
19568 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
19569 @item @strong{Operation}
19570 @tab @strong{Description}
19571
19572 @item @code{-var-create}
19573 @tab create a variable object
19574 @item @code{-var-delete}
19575 @tab delete the variable object and its children
19576 @item @code{-var-set-format}
19577 @tab set the display format of this variable
19578 @item @code{-var-show-format}
19579 @tab show the display format of this variable
19580 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
19581 @tab tells how many children this object has
19582 @item @code{-var-list-children}
19583 @tab return a list of the object's children
19584 @item @code{-var-info-type}
19585 @tab show the type of this variable object
19586 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
19587 @tab print what this variable object represents
19588 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
19589 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
19590 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
19591 @tab get the value of this variable
19592 @item @code{-var-assign}
19593 @tab set the value of this variable
19594 @item @code{-var-update}
19595 @tab update the variable and its children
19596 @end multitable
19597
19598 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
19599 how it can be used.
19600
19601 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
19602
19603 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
19604 @findex -var-create
19605
19606 @subsubheading Synopsis
19607
19608 @smallexample
19609 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
19610 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
19611 @end smallexample
19612
19613 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
19614 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
19615 register.
19616
19617 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
19618 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
19619 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
19620 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
19621 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
19622
19623 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
19624 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
19625 frame should be used.
19626
19627 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
19628 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
19629
19630 @itemize @bullet
19631 @item
19632 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
19633
19634 @item
19635 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
19636
19637 @item
19638 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
19639 @end itemize
19640
19641 @subsubheading Result
19642
19643 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
19644 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
19645 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
19646
19647 @smallexample
19648 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
19649 @end smallexample
19650
19651
19652 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
19653 @findex -var-delete
19654
19655 @subsubheading Synopsis
19656
19657 @smallexample
19658 -var-delete @var{name}
19659 @end smallexample
19660
19661 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
19662
19663 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
19664
19665
19666 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
19667 @findex -var-set-format
19668
19669 @subsubheading Synopsis
19670
19671 @smallexample
19672 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
19673 @end smallexample
19674
19675 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
19676 @var{format-spec}.
19677
19678 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
19679
19680 @smallexample
19681 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
19682 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
19683 @end smallexample
19684
19685
19686 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
19687 @findex -var-show-format
19688
19689 @subsubheading Synopsis
19690
19691 @smallexample
19692 -var-show-format @var{name}
19693 @end smallexample
19694
19695 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
19696
19697 @smallexample
19698 @var{format} @expansion{}
19699 @var{format-spec}
19700 @end smallexample
19701
19702
19703 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
19704 @findex -var-info-num-children
19705
19706 @subsubheading Synopsis
19707
19708 @smallexample
19709 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
19710 @end smallexample
19711
19712 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
19713
19714 @smallexample
19715 numchild=@var{n}
19716 @end smallexample
19717
19718
19719 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
19720 @findex -var-list-children
19721
19722 @subsubheading Synopsis
19723
19724 @smallexample
19725 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
19726 @end smallexample
19727 @anchor{-var-list-children}
19728
19729 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
19730 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
19731 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
19732 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
19733 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
19734 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
19735 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
19736 and unions.
19737
19738 @subsubheading Example
19739
19740 @smallexample
19741 (gdb)
19742 -var-list-children n
19743 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19744 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19745 (gdb)
19746 -var-list-children --all-values n
19747 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
19748 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
19749 @end smallexample
19750
19751
19752 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
19753 @findex -var-info-type
19754
19755 @subsubheading Synopsis
19756
19757 @smallexample
19758 -var-info-type @var{name}
19759 @end smallexample
19760
19761 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
19762 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
19763 @value{GDBN} CLI:
19764
19765 @smallexample
19766 type=@var{typename}
19767 @end smallexample
19768
19769
19770 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
19771 @findex -var-info-expression
19772
19773 @subsubheading Synopsis
19774
19775 @smallexample
19776 -var-info-expression @var{name}
19777 @end smallexample
19778
19779 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
19780
19781 @smallexample
19782 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
19783 @end smallexample
19784
19785 @noindent
19786 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
19787
19788 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
19789 @findex -var-show-attributes
19790
19791 @subsubheading Synopsis
19792
19793 @smallexample
19794 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
19795 @end smallexample
19796
19797 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
19798
19799 @smallexample
19800 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
19801 @end smallexample
19802
19803 @noindent
19804 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
19805
19806 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
19807 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
19808
19809 @subsubheading Synopsis
19810
19811 @smallexample
19812 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
19813 @end smallexample
19814
19815 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
19816 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
19817 for the object:
19818
19819 @smallexample
19820 value=@var{value}
19821 @end smallexample
19822
19823 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
19824 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
19825
19826 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
19827 @findex -var-assign
19828
19829 @subsubheading Synopsis
19830
19831 @smallexample
19832 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
19833 @end smallexample
19834
19835 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
19836 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
19837 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
19838 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
19839
19840 @subsubheading Example
19841
19842 @smallexample
19843 (gdb)
19844 -var-assign var1 3
19845 ^done,value="3"
19846 (gdb)
19847 -var-update *
19848 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
19849 (gdb)
19850 @end smallexample
19851
19852 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
19853 @findex -var-update
19854
19855 @subsubheading Synopsis
19856
19857 @smallexample
19858 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
19859 @end smallexample
19860
19861 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
19862 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
19863 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated. The
19864 option @var{print-values} determines whether names both and values, or
19865 just names are printed in the manner described for
19866 @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}).
19867
19868 @subsubheading Example
19869
19870 @smallexample
19871 (gdb)
19872 -var-assign var1 3
19873 ^done,value="3"
19874 (gdb)
19875 -var-update --all-values var1
19876 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
19877 type_changed="false"@}]
19878 (gdb)
19879 @end smallexample
19880
19881 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19882 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
19883 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
19884
19885 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
19886 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
19887 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
19888 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
19889
19890 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
19891 @c @subheading -data-assign
19892 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
19893 @c @subsubheading GDB command
19894 @c set variable
19895 @c @subsubheading Example
19896 @c N.A.
19897
19898 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
19899 @findex -data-disassemble
19900
19901 @subsubheading Synopsis
19902
19903 @smallexample
19904 -data-disassemble
19905 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
19906 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
19907 -- @var{mode}
19908 @end smallexample
19909
19910 @noindent
19911 Where:
19912
19913 @table @samp
19914 @item @var{start-addr}
19915 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
19916 @item @var{end-addr}
19917 is the end address
19918 @item @var{filename}
19919 is the name of the file to disassemble
19920 @item @var{linenum}
19921 is the line number to disassemble around
19922 @item @var{lines}
19923 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
19924 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
19925 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
19926 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
19927 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
19928 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
19929 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
19930 are displayed.
19931 @item @var{mode}
19932 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
19933 disassembly).
19934 @end table
19935
19936 @subsubheading Result
19937
19938 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
19939
19940 @itemize @bullet
19941 @item Address
19942 @item Func-name
19943 @item Offset
19944 @item Instruction
19945 @end itemize
19946
19947 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
19948 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
19949
19950 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
19951
19952 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
19953
19954 @subsubheading Example
19955
19956 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
19957
19958 @smallexample
19959 (gdb)
19960 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
19961 ^done,
19962 asm_insns=[
19963 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19964 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19965 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19966 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19967 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
19968 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
19969 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
19970 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19971 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
19972 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
19973 (gdb)
19974 @end smallexample
19975
19976 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
19977 @code{main}.
19978
19979 @smallexample
19980 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
19981 ^done,asm_insns=[
19982 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
19983 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
19984 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
19985 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
19986 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
19987 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
19988 [@dots{}]
19989 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
19990 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
19991 (gdb)
19992 @end smallexample
19993
19994 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
19995
19996 @smallexample
19997 (gdb)
19998 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
19999 ^done,asm_insns=[
20000 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20001 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
20002 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20003 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20004 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20005 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
20006 (gdb)
20007 @end smallexample
20008
20009 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
20010
20011 @smallexample
20012 (gdb)
20013 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
20014 ^done,asm_insns=[
20015 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
20016 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20017 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20018 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
20019 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
20020 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
20021 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
20022 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
20023 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
20024 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
20025 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
20026 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
20027 (gdb)
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030
20031 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
20032 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
20033
20034 @subsubheading Synopsis
20035
20036 @smallexample
20037 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
20038 @end smallexample
20039
20040 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
20041 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
20042 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
20043
20044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20045
20046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
20047 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
20048 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
20049
20050 @subsubheading Example
20051
20052 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
20053 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
20054 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
20055 output.
20056
20057 @smallexample
20058 211-data-evaluate-expression A
20059 211^done,value="1"
20060 (gdb)
20061 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
20062 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
20063 (gdb)
20064 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
20065 411^done,value="4"
20066 (gdb)
20067 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
20068 511^done,value="4"
20069 (gdb)
20070 @end smallexample
20071
20072
20073 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
20074 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
20075
20076 @subsubheading Synopsis
20077
20078 @smallexample
20079 -data-list-changed-registers
20080 @end smallexample
20081
20082 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
20083
20084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20085
20086 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
20087 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
20088
20089 @subsubheading Example
20090
20091 On a PPC MBX board:
20092
20093 @smallexample
20094 (gdb)
20095 -exec-continue
20096 ^running
20097
20098 (gdb)
20099 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
20100 args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="5"@}
20101 (gdb)
20102 -data-list-changed-registers
20103 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
20104 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
20105 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
20106 (gdb)
20107 @end smallexample
20108
20109
20110 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
20111 @findex -data-list-register-names
20112
20113 @subsubheading Synopsis
20114
20115 @smallexample
20116 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
20117 @end smallexample
20118
20119 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
20120 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
20121 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
20122 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
20123 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
20124 include empty register names.
20125
20126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20127
20128 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
20129 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
20130 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
20131
20132 @subsubheading Example
20133
20134 For the PPC MBX board:
20135 @smallexample
20136 (gdb)
20137 -data-list-register-names
20138 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
20139 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
20140 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
20141 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
20142 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
20143 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
20144 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
20145 (gdb)
20146 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
20147 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
20148 (gdb)
20149 @end smallexample
20150
20151 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
20152 @findex -data-list-register-values
20153
20154 @subsubheading Synopsis
20155
20156 @smallexample
20157 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
20158 @end smallexample
20159
20160 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
20161 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
20162 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
20163 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
20164
20165 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
20166
20167 @table @code
20168 @item x
20169 Hexadecimal
20170 @item o
20171 Octal
20172 @item t
20173 Binary
20174 @item d
20175 Decimal
20176 @item r
20177 Raw
20178 @item N
20179 Natural
20180 @end table
20181
20182 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20183
20184 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
20185 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
20186
20187 @subsubheading Example
20188
20189 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
20190 don't appear in the actual output):
20191
20192 @smallexample
20193 (gdb)
20194 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
20195 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20196 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
20197 (gdb)
20198 -data-list-register-values x
20199 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
20200 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20201 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
20202 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
20203 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
20204 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
20205 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
20206 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
20207 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
20208 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
20209 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
20210 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
20211 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
20212 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
20213 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
20214 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
20215 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
20216 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
20217 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
20218 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
20219 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
20220 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
20221 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
20222 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
20223 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
20224 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
20225 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
20226 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
20227 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
20228 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
20229 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
20230 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
20231 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
20232 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
20233 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
20234 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
20235 (gdb)
20236 @end smallexample
20237
20238
20239 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
20240 @findex -data-read-memory
20241
20242 @subsubheading Synopsis
20243
20244 @smallexample
20245 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
20246 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
20247 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
20248 @end smallexample
20249
20250 @noindent
20251 where:
20252
20253 @table @samp
20254 @item @var{address}
20255 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
20256 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
20257 quoted using the C convention.
20258
20259 @item @var{word-format}
20260 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
20261 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
20262 ,Output formats}).
20263
20264 @item @var{word-size}
20265 The size of each memory word in bytes.
20266
20267 @item @var{nr-rows}
20268 The number of rows in the output table.
20269
20270 @item @var{nr-cols}
20271 The number of columns in the output table.
20272
20273 @item @var{aschar}
20274 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
20275 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
20276 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
20277 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
20278
20279 @item @var{byte-offset}
20280 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
20281 @end table
20282
20283 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
20284 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
20285 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
20286 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
20287 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
20288 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
20289 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
20290 @samp{addr}.
20291
20292 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
20293 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
20294 @samp{prev-page}.
20295
20296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20297
20298 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
20299 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
20300
20301 @subsubheading Example
20302
20303 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
20304 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
20305 word. Display each word in hex.
20306
20307 @smallexample
20308 (gdb)
20309 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
20310 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
20311 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
20312 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
20313 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
20314 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
20315 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
20316 (gdb)
20317 @end smallexample
20318
20319 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
20320 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
20321
20322 @smallexample
20323 (gdb)
20324 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
20325 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
20326 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
20327 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
20328 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
20329 (gdb)
20330 @end smallexample
20331
20332 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
20333 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
20334 used as the non-printable character.
20335
20336 @smallexample
20337 (gdb)
20338 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
20339 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
20340 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
20341 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
20342 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20343 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20344 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20345 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
20346 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
20347 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
20348 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
20349 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
20350 (gdb)
20351 @end smallexample
20352
20353 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20354 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
20355 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
20356
20357 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
20358
20359 @c @subheading -trace-actions
20360
20361 @c @subheading -trace-delete
20362
20363 @c @subheading -trace-disable
20364
20365 @c @subheading -trace-dump
20366
20367 @c @subheading -trace-enable
20368
20369 @c @subheading -trace-exists
20370
20371 @c @subheading -trace-find
20372
20373 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
20374
20375 @c @subheading -trace-info
20376
20377 @c @subheading -trace-insert
20378
20379 @c @subheading -trace-list
20380
20381 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
20382
20383 @c @subheading -trace-save
20384
20385 @c @subheading -trace-start
20386
20387 @c @subheading -trace-stop
20388
20389
20390 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20391 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
20392 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
20393
20394
20395 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
20396 @findex -symbol-info-address
20397
20398 @subsubheading Synopsis
20399
20400 @smallexample
20401 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
20402 @end smallexample
20403
20404 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
20405
20406 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20407
20408 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
20409
20410 @subsubheading Example
20411 N.A.
20412
20413
20414 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
20415 @findex -symbol-info-file
20416
20417 @subsubheading Synopsis
20418
20419 @smallexample
20420 -symbol-info-file
20421 @end smallexample
20422
20423 Show the file for the symbol.
20424
20425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20426
20427 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
20428 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
20429
20430 @subsubheading Example
20431 N.A.
20432
20433
20434 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
20435 @findex -symbol-info-function
20436
20437 @subsubheading Synopsis
20438
20439 @smallexample
20440 -symbol-info-function
20441 @end smallexample
20442
20443 Show which function the symbol lives in.
20444
20445 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20446
20447 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
20448
20449 @subsubheading Example
20450 N.A.
20451
20452
20453 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
20454 @findex -symbol-info-line
20455
20456 @subsubheading Synopsis
20457
20458 @smallexample
20459 -symbol-info-line
20460 @end smallexample
20461
20462 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
20463
20464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20465
20466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
20467 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
20468
20469 @subsubheading Example
20470 N.A.
20471
20472
20473 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
20474 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
20475
20476 @subsubheading Synopsis
20477
20478 @smallexample
20479 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
20480 @end smallexample
20481
20482 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
20483
20484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20485
20486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
20487
20488 @subsubheading Example
20489 N.A.
20490
20491
20492 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
20493 @findex -symbol-list-functions
20494
20495 @subsubheading Synopsis
20496
20497 @smallexample
20498 -symbol-list-functions
20499 @end smallexample
20500
20501 List the functions in the executable.
20502
20503 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20504
20505 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
20506 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20507
20508 @subsubheading Example
20509 N.A.
20510
20511
20512 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
20513 @findex -symbol-list-lines
20514
20515 @subsubheading Synopsis
20516
20517 @smallexample
20518 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
20519 @end smallexample
20520
20521 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
20522 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
20523 ascending PC order.
20524
20525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20526
20527 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
20528
20529 @subsubheading Example
20530 @smallexample
20531 (gdb)
20532 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
20533 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
20534 (gdb)
20535 @end smallexample
20536
20537
20538 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
20539 @findex -symbol-list-types
20540
20541 @subsubheading Synopsis
20542
20543 @smallexample
20544 -symbol-list-types
20545 @end smallexample
20546
20547 List all the type names.
20548
20549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20550
20551 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
20552 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20553
20554 @subsubheading Example
20555 N.A.
20556
20557
20558 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
20559 @findex -symbol-list-variables
20560
20561 @subsubheading Synopsis
20562
20563 @smallexample
20564 -symbol-list-variables
20565 @end smallexample
20566
20567 List all the global and static variable names.
20568
20569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20570
20571 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
20572
20573 @subsubheading Example
20574 N.A.
20575
20576
20577 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
20578 @findex -symbol-locate
20579
20580 @subsubheading Synopsis
20581
20582 @smallexample
20583 -symbol-locate
20584 @end smallexample
20585
20586 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20587
20588 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
20589
20590 @subsubheading Example
20591 N.A.
20592
20593
20594 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
20595 @findex -symbol-type
20596
20597 @subsubheading Synopsis
20598
20599 @smallexample
20600 -symbol-type @var{variable}
20601 @end smallexample
20602
20603 Show type of @var{variable}.
20604
20605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20606
20607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
20608 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
20609
20610 @subsubheading Example
20611 N.A.
20612
20613
20614 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20615 @node GDB/MI File Commands
20616 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
20617
20618 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
20619 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
20620
20621 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
20622 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
20623
20624 @subsubheading Synopsis
20625
20626 @smallexample
20627 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
20628 @end smallexample
20629
20630 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
20631 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
20632 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
20633 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
20634 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
20635 notification.
20636
20637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20638
20639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
20640
20641 @subsubheading Example
20642
20643 @smallexample
20644 (gdb)
20645 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20646 ^done
20647 (gdb)
20648 @end smallexample
20649
20650
20651 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
20652 @findex -file-exec-file
20653
20654 @subsubheading Synopsis
20655
20656 @smallexample
20657 -file-exec-file @var{file}
20658 @end smallexample
20659
20660 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
20661 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
20662 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
20663 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
20664 notification.
20665
20666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20667
20668 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
20669
20670 @subsubheading Example
20671
20672 @smallexample
20673 (gdb)
20674 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20675 ^done
20676 (gdb)
20677 @end smallexample
20678
20679
20680 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
20681 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
20682
20683 @subsubheading Synopsis
20684
20685 @smallexample
20686 -file-list-exec-sections
20687 @end smallexample
20688
20689 List the sections of the current executable file.
20690
20691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20692
20693 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
20694 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
20695 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
20696
20697 @subsubheading Example
20698 N.A.
20699
20700
20701 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
20702 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
20703
20704 @subsubheading Synopsis
20705
20706 @smallexample
20707 -file-list-exec-source-file
20708 @end smallexample
20709
20710 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
20711 to the current source file for the current executable.
20712
20713 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20714
20715 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
20716
20717 @subsubheading Example
20718
20719 @smallexample
20720 (gdb)
20721 123-file-list-exec-source-file
20722 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
20723 (gdb)
20724 @end smallexample
20725
20726
20727 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
20728 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
20729
20730 @subsubheading Synopsis
20731
20732 @smallexample
20733 -file-list-exec-source-files
20734 @end smallexample
20735
20736 List the source files for the current executable.
20737
20738 It will always output the filename, but only when GDB can find the absolute
20739 file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
20740
20741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20742
20743 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
20744 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
20745
20746 @subsubheading Example
20747 @smallexample
20748 (gdb)
20749 -file-list-exec-source-files
20750 ^done,files=[
20751 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
20752 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
20753 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
20754 (gdb)
20755 @end smallexample
20756
20757 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
20758 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
20759
20760 @subsubheading Synopsis
20761
20762 @smallexample
20763 -file-list-shared-libraries
20764 @end smallexample
20765
20766 List the shared libraries in the program.
20767
20768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20769
20770 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
20771
20772 @subsubheading Example
20773 N.A.
20774
20775
20776 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
20777 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
20778
20779 @subsubheading Synopsis
20780
20781 @smallexample
20782 -file-list-symbol-files
20783 @end smallexample
20784
20785 List symbol files.
20786
20787 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20788
20789 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
20790
20791 @subsubheading Example
20792 N.A.
20793
20794
20795 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
20796 @findex -file-symbol-file
20797
20798 @subsubheading Synopsis
20799
20800 @smallexample
20801 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
20802 @end smallexample
20803
20804 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
20805 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
20806 produced, except for a completion notification.
20807
20808 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20809
20810 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
20811
20812 @subsubheading Example
20813
20814 @smallexample
20815 (gdb)
20816 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
20817 ^done
20818 (gdb)
20819 @end smallexample
20820
20821 @ignore
20822 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20823 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
20824 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
20825
20826 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
20827
20828 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
20829
20830 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
20831
20832 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
20833
20834 @c @subheading -overlay-map
20835
20836 @c @subheading -overlay-off
20837
20838 @c @subheading -overlay-on
20839
20840 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
20841
20842 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20843 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
20844 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
20845
20846 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
20847
20848 @c @subheading -signal-handle
20849
20850 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
20851
20852 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
20853 @end ignore
20854
20855
20856 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20857 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
20858 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
20859
20860
20861 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
20862 @findex -target-attach
20863
20864 @subsubheading Synopsis
20865
20866 @smallexample
20867 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
20868 @end smallexample
20869
20870 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
20871
20872 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20873
20874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
20875
20876 @subsubheading Example
20877 N.A.
20878
20879
20880 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
20881 @findex -target-compare-sections
20882
20883 @subsubheading Synopsis
20884
20885 @smallexample
20886 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
20887 @end smallexample
20888
20889 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
20890 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
20891
20892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20893
20894 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
20895
20896 @subsubheading Example
20897 N.A.
20898
20899
20900 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
20901 @findex -target-detach
20902
20903 @subsubheading Synopsis
20904
20905 @smallexample
20906 -target-detach
20907 @end smallexample
20908
20909 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
20910 There's no output.
20911
20912 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20913
20914 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
20915
20916 @subsubheading Example
20917
20918 @smallexample
20919 (gdb)
20920 -target-detach
20921 ^done
20922 (gdb)
20923 @end smallexample
20924
20925
20926 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
20927 @findex -target-disconnect
20928
20929 @subsubheading Synopsis
20930
20931 @example
20932 -target-disconnect
20933 @end example
20934
20935 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
20936 generally not resumed.
20937
20938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
20939
20940 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
20941
20942 @subsubheading Example
20943
20944 @smallexample
20945 (gdb)
20946 -target-disconnect
20947 ^done
20948 (gdb)
20949 @end smallexample
20950
20951
20952 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
20953 @findex -target-download
20954
20955 @subsubheading Synopsis
20956
20957 @smallexample
20958 -target-download
20959 @end smallexample
20960
20961 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
20962 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
20963
20964 @table @samp
20965 @item section
20966 The name of the section.
20967 @item section-sent
20968 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
20969 @item section-size
20970 The size of the section.
20971 @item total-sent
20972 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
20973 @item total-size
20974 The size of the overall executable to download.
20975 @end table
20976
20977 @noindent
20978 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
20979 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
20980
20981 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
20982 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
20983
20984 @table @samp
20985 @item section
20986 The name of the section.
20987 @item section-size
20988 The size of the section.
20989 @item total-size
20990 The size of the overall executable to download.
20991 @end table
20992
20993 @noindent
20994 At the end, a summary is printed.
20995
20996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20997
20998 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
20999
21000 @subsubheading Example
21001
21002 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
21003 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
21004
21005 @smallexample
21006 (gdb)
21007 -target-download
21008 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
21009 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
21010 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
21011 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
21012 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
21013 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
21014 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
21015 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
21016 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
21017 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
21018 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
21019 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
21020 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
21021 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
21022 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
21023 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
21024 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
21025 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
21026 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
21027 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
21028 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
21029 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
21030 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
21031 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
21032 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
21033 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
21034 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
21035 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21036 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
21037 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
21038 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
21039 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
21040 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
21041 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
21042 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
21043 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
21044 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
21045 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
21046 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
21047 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
21048 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
21049 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
21050 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
21051 write-rate="429"
21052 (gdb)
21053 @end smallexample
21054
21055
21056 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
21057 @findex -target-exec-status
21058
21059 @subsubheading Synopsis
21060
21061 @smallexample
21062 -target-exec-status
21063 @end smallexample
21064
21065 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
21066 not, for instance).
21067
21068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21069
21070 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21071
21072 @subsubheading Example
21073 N.A.
21074
21075
21076 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
21077 @findex -target-list-available-targets
21078
21079 @subsubheading Synopsis
21080
21081 @smallexample
21082 -target-list-available-targets
21083 @end smallexample
21084
21085 List the possible targets to connect to.
21086
21087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21088
21089 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
21090
21091 @subsubheading Example
21092 N.A.
21093
21094
21095 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
21096 @findex -target-list-current-targets
21097
21098 @subsubheading Synopsis
21099
21100 @smallexample
21101 -target-list-current-targets
21102 @end smallexample
21103
21104 Describe the current target.
21105
21106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21107
21108 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
21109 other things).
21110
21111 @subsubheading Example
21112 N.A.
21113
21114
21115 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
21116 @findex -target-list-parameters
21117
21118 @subsubheading Synopsis
21119
21120 @smallexample
21121 -target-list-parameters
21122 @end smallexample
21123
21124 @c ????
21125
21126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21127
21128 No equivalent.
21129
21130 @subsubheading Example
21131 N.A.
21132
21133
21134 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
21135 @findex -target-select
21136
21137 @subsubheading Synopsis
21138
21139 @smallexample
21140 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
21141 @end smallexample
21142
21143 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
21144
21145 @table @samp
21146 @item @var{type}
21147 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
21148 @item @var{parameters}
21149 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
21150 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
21151 @end table
21152
21153 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
21154 which the target program is, in the following form:
21155
21156 @smallexample
21157 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
21158 args=[@var{arg list}]
21159 @end smallexample
21160
21161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21162
21163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
21164
21165 @subsubheading Example
21166
21167 @smallexample
21168 (gdb)
21169 -target-select async /dev/ttya
21170 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
21171 (gdb)
21172 @end smallexample
21173
21174 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21175 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
21176 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
21177
21178 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
21179
21180 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
21181 @findex -gdb-exit
21182
21183 @subsubheading Synopsis
21184
21185 @smallexample
21186 -gdb-exit
21187 @end smallexample
21188
21189 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
21190
21191 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21192
21193 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
21194
21195 @subsubheading Example
21196
21197 @smallexample
21198 (gdb)
21199 -gdb-exit
21200 ^exit
21201 @end smallexample
21202
21203
21204 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
21205 @findex -exec-abort
21206
21207 @subsubheading Synopsis
21208
21209 @smallexample
21210 -exec-abort
21211 @end smallexample
21212
21213 Kill the inferior running program.
21214
21215 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21216
21217 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
21218
21219 @subsubheading Example
21220 N.A.
21221
21222
21223 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
21224 @findex -gdb-set
21225
21226 @subsubheading Synopsis
21227
21228 @smallexample
21229 -gdb-set
21230 @end smallexample
21231
21232 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
21233 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
21234
21235 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21236
21237 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
21238
21239 @subsubheading Example
21240
21241 @smallexample
21242 (gdb)
21243 -gdb-set $foo=3
21244 ^done
21245 (gdb)
21246 @end smallexample
21247
21248
21249 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
21250 @findex -gdb-show
21251
21252 @subsubheading Synopsis
21253
21254 @smallexample
21255 -gdb-show
21256 @end smallexample
21257
21258 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
21259
21260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
21261
21262 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
21263
21264 @subsubheading Example
21265
21266 @smallexample
21267 (gdb)
21268 -gdb-show annotate
21269 ^done,value="0"
21270 (gdb)
21271 @end smallexample
21272
21273 @c @subheading -gdb-source
21274
21275
21276 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
21277 @findex -gdb-version
21278
21279 @subsubheading Synopsis
21280
21281 @smallexample
21282 -gdb-version
21283 @end smallexample
21284
21285 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
21286
21287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21288
21289 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
21290 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
21291
21292 @subsubheading Example
21293
21294 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
21295 @c box in TeX.
21296 @smallexample
21297 (gdb)
21298 -gdb-version
21299 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
21300 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21301 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
21302 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
21303 ~ certain conditions.
21304 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21305 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
21306 ~ details.
21307 ~This GDB was configured as
21308 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
21309 ^done
21310 (gdb)
21311 @end smallexample
21312
21313 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
21314 @findex -interpreter-exec
21315
21316 @subheading Synopsis
21317
21318 @smallexample
21319 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
21320 @end smallexample
21321 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
21322
21323 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
21324
21325 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21326
21327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
21328
21329 @subheading Example
21330
21331 @smallexample
21332 (gdb)
21333 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
21334 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
21335 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
21336 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
21337 ^done
21338 (gdb)
21339 @end smallexample
21340
21341 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
21342 @findex -inferior-tty-set
21343
21344 @subheading Synopsis
21345
21346 @smallexample
21347 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21348 @end smallexample
21349
21350 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
21351
21352 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21353
21354 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
21355
21356 @subheading Example
21357
21358 @smallexample
21359 (gdb)
21360 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21361 ^done
21362 (gdb)
21363 @end smallexample
21364
21365 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
21366 @findex -inferior-tty-show
21367
21368 @subheading Synopsis
21369
21370 @smallexample
21371 -inferior-tty-show
21372 @end smallexample
21373
21374 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
21375
21376 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
21377
21378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
21379
21380 @subheading Example
21381
21382 @smallexample
21383 (gdb)
21384 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
21385 ^done
21386 (gdb)
21387 -inferior-tty-show
21388 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
21389 (gdb)
21390 @end smallexample
21391
21392 @node Annotations
21393 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
21394
21395 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
21396 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
21397 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
21398 relatively high level.
21399
21400 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
21401 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
21402
21403 @ignore
21404 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
21405 @end ignore
21406
21407 @menu
21408 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
21409 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
21410 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
21411 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
21412 * Annotations for Running::
21413 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
21414 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
21415 @end menu
21416
21417 @node Annotations Overview
21418 @section What is an Annotation?
21419 @cindex annotations
21420
21421 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
21422 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
21423 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
21424 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
21425 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
21426 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
21427 cannot contain newline characters.
21428
21429 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
21430 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
21431 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
21432 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
21433 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
21434 means those three characters as output.
21435
21436 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
21437 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
21438 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
21439 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
21440 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
21441 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
21442 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
21443 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
21444 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
21445
21446 @table @code
21447 @kindex set annotate
21448 @item set annotate @var{level}
21449 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
21450 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
21451
21452 @item show annotate
21453 @kindex show annotate
21454 Show the current annotation level.
21455 @end table
21456
21457 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
21458
21459 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
21460
21461 @smallexample
21462 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
21463 GNU gdb 6.0
21464 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21465 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
21466 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
21467 under certain conditions.
21468 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
21469 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
21470 for details.
21471 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
21472
21473 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21474 (@value{GDBP})
21475 ^Z^Zprompt
21476 @kbd{quit}
21477
21478 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21479 $
21480 @end smallexample
21481
21482 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
21483 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
21484 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
21485 output from @value{GDBN}.
21486
21487 @node Prompting
21488 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
21489
21490 @cindex annotations for prompts
21491 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
21492 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
21493 over, etc.
21494
21495 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
21496 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
21497 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
21498 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
21499 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
21500 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
21501 features the following annotations:
21502
21503 @smallexample
21504 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
21505 ^Z^Zprompt
21506 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
21507 @end smallexample
21508
21509 The input types are
21510
21511 @table @code
21512 @findex pre-prompt annotation
21513 @findex prompt annotation
21514 @findex post-prompt annotation
21515 @item prompt
21516 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
21517
21518 @findex pre-commands annotation
21519 @findex commands annotation
21520 @findex post-commands annotation
21521 @item commands
21522 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
21523 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
21524
21525 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
21526 @findex overload-choice annotation
21527 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
21528 @item overload-choice
21529 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
21530
21531 @findex pre-query annotation
21532 @findex query annotation
21533 @findex post-query annotation
21534 @item query
21535 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
21536
21537 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
21538 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
21539 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
21540 @item prompt-for-continue
21541 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
21542 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
21543 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
21544 presence of annotations.
21545 @end table
21546
21547 @node Errors
21548 @section Errors
21549 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
21550
21551 @findex quit annotation
21552 @smallexample
21553 ^Z^Zquit
21554 @end smallexample
21555
21556 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
21557
21558 @findex error annotation
21559 @smallexample
21560 ^Z^Zerror
21561 @end smallexample
21562
21563 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
21564
21565 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
21566 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
21567 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
21568 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
21569 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
21570 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
21571 to the top level.
21572
21573 @findex error-begin annotation
21574 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
21575
21576 @smallexample
21577 ^Z^Zerror-begin
21578 @end smallexample
21579
21580 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
21581 message.
21582
21583 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
21584 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
21585 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
21586
21587 @node Invalidation
21588 @section Invalidation Notices
21589
21590 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
21591 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
21592 changed.
21593
21594 @table @code
21595 @findex frames-invalid annotation
21596 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
21597
21598 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
21599 have changed.
21600
21601 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
21602 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
21603
21604 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
21605 deleted a breakpoint.
21606 @end table
21607
21608 @node Annotations for Running
21609 @section Running the Program
21610 @cindex annotations for running programs
21611
21612 @findex starting annotation
21613 @findex stopping annotation
21614 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
21615 @code{step} or @code{continue},
21616
21617 @smallexample
21618 ^Z^Zstarting
21619 @end smallexample
21620
21621 is output. When the program stops,
21622
21623 @smallexample
21624 ^Z^Zstopped
21625 @end smallexample
21626
21627 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
21628 annotations describe how the program stopped.
21629
21630 @table @code
21631 @findex exited annotation
21632 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
21633 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
21634 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
21635
21636 @findex signalled annotation
21637 @findex signal-name annotation
21638 @findex signal-name-end annotation
21639 @findex signal-string annotation
21640 @findex signal-string-end annotation
21641 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
21642 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
21643 annotation continues:
21644
21645 @smallexample
21646 @var{intro-text}
21647 ^Z^Zsignal-name
21648 @var{name}
21649 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
21650 @var{middle-text}
21651 ^Z^Zsignal-string
21652 @var{string}
21653 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
21654 @var{end-text}
21655 @end smallexample
21656
21657 @noindent
21658 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
21659 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
21660 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
21661 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
21662 user's benefit and have no particular format.
21663
21664 @findex signal annotation
21665 @item ^Z^Zsignal
21666 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
21667 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
21668 terminated with it.
21669
21670 @findex breakpoint annotation
21671 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
21672 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
21673
21674 @findex watchpoint annotation
21675 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
21676 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
21677 @end table
21678
21679 @node Source Annotations
21680 @section Displaying Source
21681 @cindex annotations for source display
21682
21683 @findex source annotation
21684 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
21685
21686 @smallexample
21687 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
21688 @end smallexample
21689
21690 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
21691 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
21692 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
21693 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
21694 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
21695 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
21696 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
21697 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
21698 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
21699 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
21700 depend on the language).
21701
21702 @node GDB Bugs
21703 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
21704 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
21705 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
21706
21707 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
21708
21709 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
21710 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
21711 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
21712 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
21713
21714 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
21715 information that enables us to fix the bug.
21716
21717 @menu
21718 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
21719 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
21720 @end menu
21721
21722 @node Bug Criteria
21723 @section Have you found a bug?
21724 @cindex bug criteria
21725
21726 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
21727
21728 @itemize @bullet
21729 @cindex fatal signal
21730 @cindex debugger crash
21731 @cindex crash of debugger
21732 @item
21733 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
21734 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
21735
21736 @cindex error on valid input
21737 @item
21738 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
21739 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
21740 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
21741
21742 @cindex invalid input
21743 @item
21744 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
21745 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
21746 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
21747 for traditional practice''.
21748
21749 @item
21750 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
21751 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
21752 @end itemize
21753
21754 @node Bug Reporting
21755 @section How to report bugs
21756 @cindex bug reports
21757 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
21758
21759 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
21760 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
21761 contact that organization first.
21762
21763 You can find contact information for many support companies and
21764 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
21765 distribution.
21766 @c should add a web page ref...
21767
21768 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
21769 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
21770 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
21771 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
21772 be used.
21773
21774 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
21775 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
21776 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
21777 @samp{bug-gdb}.
21778
21779 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
21780 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
21781 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
21782 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
21783 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
21784 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
21785 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
21786 bug reports to the mailing list.
21787
21788 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
21789 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
21790 fact or leave it out, state it!
21791
21792 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
21793 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
21794 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
21795 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
21796 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
21797 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
21798 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
21799 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
21800 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
21801
21802 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
21803 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
21804 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
21805 self-contained.
21806
21807 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
21808 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
21809 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
21810 bugs properly.
21811
21812 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
21813
21814 @itemize @bullet
21815 @item
21816 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
21817 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
21818 version}.
21819
21820 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
21821 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
21822
21823 @item
21824 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
21825 version number.
21826
21827 @item
21828 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
21829 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
21830
21831 @item
21832 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
21833 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
21834 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
21835 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
21836 compilers.
21837
21838 @item
21839 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
21840 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
21841 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
21842 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
21843
21844 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
21845 and then we might not encounter the bug.
21846
21847 @item
21848 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
21849 reproduce the bug.
21850
21851 @item
21852 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
21853 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
21854
21855 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
21856 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
21857 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
21858 a chance to make a mistake.
21859
21860 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
21861 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
21862 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
21863 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
21864 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
21865 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
21866 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
21867 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
21868
21869 @pindex script
21870 @cindex recording a session script
21871 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
21872 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
21873 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
21874 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
21875
21876 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
21877 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
21878
21879 @item
21880 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
21881 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
21882 it by context, not by line number.
21883
21884 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
21885 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
21886
21887 @end itemize
21888
21889 Here are some things that are not necessary:
21890
21891 @itemize @bullet
21892 @item
21893 A description of the envelope of the bug.
21894
21895 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
21896 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
21897 changes will not affect it.
21898
21899 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
21900 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
21901 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
21902 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
21903
21904 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
21905 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
21906 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
21907 less time, and so on.
21908
21909 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
21910 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
21911
21912 @item
21913 A patch for the bug.
21914
21915 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
21916 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
21917 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
21918 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
21919
21920 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
21921 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
21922 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
21923 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
21924
21925 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
21926 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
21927 help us to understand.
21928
21929 @item
21930 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
21931
21932 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
21933 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
21934 @end itemize
21935
21936 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
21937 @c and consists of the two following files:
21938 @c rluser.texinfo
21939 @c inc-hist.texinfo
21940 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
21941 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
21942 @include rluser.texi
21943 @include inc-hist.texinfo
21944
21945
21946 @node Formatting Documentation
21947 @appendix Formatting Documentation
21948
21949 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
21950 @cindex reference card
21951 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
21952 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
21953 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
21954 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
21955 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
21956 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
21957
21958 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
21959 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
21960
21961 @smallexample
21962 make refcard.dvi
21963 @end smallexample
21964
21965 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
21966 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
21967 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
21968 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
21969 your @sc{dvi} output program.
21970
21971 @cindex documentation
21972
21973 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
21974 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
21975 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
21976 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
21977 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
21978 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
21979
21980 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
21981 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
21982 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
21983 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
21984 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
21985 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
21986 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
21987 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
21988
21989 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
21990 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
21991 @code{makeinfo}.
21992
21993 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
21994 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
21995 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
21996
21997 @smallexample
21998 cd gdb
21999 make gdb.info
22000 @end smallexample
22001
22002 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
22003 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
22004 Texinfo definitions file.
22005
22006 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
22007 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
22008 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
22009 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
22010 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
22011 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
22012 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
22013
22014 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
22015 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
22016 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
22017 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
22018 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
22019 directory.
22020
22021 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
22022 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
22023 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
22024 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
22025
22026 @smallexample
22027 make gdb.dvi
22028 @end smallexample
22029
22030 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
22031
22032 @node Installing GDB
22033 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
22034 @cindex installation
22035
22036 @menu
22037 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22038 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22039 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22040 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
22041 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
22042 @end menu
22043
22044 @node Requirements
22045 @section Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
22046 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
22047
22048 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
22049 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
22050
22051 @heading Tools/packages necessary for building @value{GDBN}
22052 @table @asis
22053 @item ISO C90 compiler
22054 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
22055 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
22056
22057 @end table
22058
22059 @heading Tools/packages optional for building @value{GDBN}
22060 @table @asis
22061 @item Expat
22062 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
22063 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
22064 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
22065 The @code{configure} script will search for this library in several
22066 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
22067 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
22068
22069 Expat is used currently only used to implement some remote-specific
22070 features.
22071
22072 @end table
22073
22074 @node Running Configure
22075 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @code{configure} script
22076 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
22077 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
22078 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
22079 build the @code{gdb} program.
22080 @iftex
22081 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
22082 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
22083 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
22084 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
22085 @end iftex
22086
22087 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
22088 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
22089 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
22090
22091 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
22092 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
22093
22094 @table @code
22095 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
22096 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
22097
22098 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
22099 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
22100
22101 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
22102 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
22103
22104 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
22105 @sc{gnu} include files
22106
22107 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
22108 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
22109
22110 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
22111 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
22112
22113 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
22114 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
22115
22116 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
22117 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
22118
22119 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
22120 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
22121 @end table
22122
22123 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
22124 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
22125 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
22126
22127 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
22128 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
22129 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
22130 argument.
22131
22132 For example:
22133
22134 @smallexample
22135 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22136 ./configure @var{host}
22137 make
22138 @end smallexample
22139
22140 @noindent
22141 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
22142 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
22143 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
22144 correct value by examining your system.)
22145
22146 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
22147 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
22148 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
22149 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
22150
22151 @need 750
22152 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
22153 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
22154 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
22155
22156 @smallexample
22157 sh configure @var{host}
22158 @end smallexample
22159
22160 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
22161 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
22162 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
22163 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
22164 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
22165
22166 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
22167 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
22168 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
22169 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
22170 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
22171 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
22172 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
22173 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
22174 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22175
22176 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
22177 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
22178 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
22179 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
22180 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
22181
22182 @node Separate Objdir
22183 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
22184
22185 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
22186 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
22187 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
22188 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
22189 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
22190 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
22191 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
22192 program specified there.
22193
22194 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
22195 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
22196 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
22197 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
22198 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
22199 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
22200
22201 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
22202 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
22203
22204 @smallexample
22205 @group
22206 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
22207 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
22208 cd ../gdb-sun4
22209 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
22210 make
22211 @end group
22212 @end smallexample
22213
22214 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
22215 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
22216 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
22217 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
22218 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
22219 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
22220
22221 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
22222 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
22223 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
22224 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
22225 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
22226
22227 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
22228 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
22229 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
22230 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
22231 You specify a cross-debugging target by
22232 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
22233
22234 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
22235 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
22236 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
22237
22238 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
22239 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
22240 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
22241 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
22242 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
22243
22244 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
22245 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
22246 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
22247 with each other.
22248
22249 @node Config Names
22250 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
22251
22252 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
22253 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
22254 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
22255 of information in the following pattern:
22256
22257 @smallexample
22258 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
22259 @end smallexample
22260
22261 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
22262 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
22263 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
22264
22265 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
22266 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
22267 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
22268 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
22269 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
22270 abbreviations---for example:
22271
22272 @smallexample
22273 % sh config.sub i386-linux
22274 i386-pc-linux-gnu
22275 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
22276 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
22277 % sh config.sub hp9k700
22278 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
22279 % sh config.sub sun4
22280 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
22281 % sh config.sub sun3
22282 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
22283 % sh config.sub i986v
22284 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
22285 @end smallexample
22286
22287 @noindent
22288 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
22289 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
22290
22291 @node Configure Options
22292 @section @code{configure} options
22293
22294 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
22295 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
22296 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
22297 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
22298
22299 @smallexample
22300 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
22301 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22302 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
22303 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
22304 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
22305 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
22306 @var{host}
22307 @end smallexample
22308
22309 @noindent
22310 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
22311 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
22312 @samp{--}.
22313
22314 @table @code
22315 @item --help
22316 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
22317
22318 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
22319 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
22320 @file{@var{dir}}.
22321
22322 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
22323 Configure the source to install programs under directory
22324 @file{@var{dir}}.
22325
22326 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
22327 @need 2000
22328 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
22329 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
22330 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
22331 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
22332 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
22333 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
22334 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
22335 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
22336 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
22337 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
22338 @var{dirname}.
22339
22340 @item --norecursion
22341 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
22342 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
22343
22344 @item --target=@var{target}
22345 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
22346 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
22347 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
22348
22349 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
22350
22351 @item @var{host} @dots{}
22352 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
22353
22354 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
22355 @end table
22356
22357 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
22358 needed for special purposes only.
22359
22360 @node Maintenance Commands
22361 @appendix Maintenance Commands
22362 @cindex maintenance commands
22363 @cindex internal commands
22364
22365 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
22366 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
22367 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
22368 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
22369 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
22370
22371 @table @code
22372 @kindex maint agent
22373 @item maint agent @var{expression}
22374 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
22375 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
22376 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
22377
22378 @kindex maint info breakpoints
22379 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
22380 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
22381 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
22382 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
22383 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
22384 is shown:
22385
22386 @table @code
22387 @item breakpoint
22388 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
22389
22390 @item watchpoint
22391 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
22392
22393 @item longjmp
22394 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
22395 @code{longjmp} calls.
22396
22397 @item longjmp resume
22398 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
22399
22400 @item until
22401 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
22402
22403 @item finish
22404 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
22405
22406 @item shlib events
22407 Shared library events.
22408
22409 @end table
22410
22411 @kindex maint check-symtabs
22412 @item maint check-symtabs
22413 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
22414
22415 @kindex maint cplus first_component
22416 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
22417 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
22418
22419 @kindex maint cplus namespace
22420 @item maint cplus namespace
22421 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
22422
22423 @kindex maint demangle
22424 @item maint demangle @var{name}
22425 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C manled @var{name}.
22426
22427 @kindex maint deprecate
22428 @kindex maint undeprecate
22429 @cindex deprecated commands
22430 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
22431 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
22432 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
22433 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
22434 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
22435 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
22436 the replacement as part of the warning.
22437
22438 @kindex maint dump-me
22439 @item maint dump-me
22440 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
22441 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
22442 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
22443 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
22444
22445 @kindex maint internal-error
22446 @kindex maint internal-warning
22447 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22448 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
22449 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
22450 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
22451 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
22452 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
22453 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
22454 @value{GDBN} session.
22455
22456 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
22457 used as the text of the error or warning message.
22458
22459 Here's an example of using @code{indernal-error}:
22460
22461 @smallexample
22462 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
22463 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
22464 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
22465 debugging may prove unreliable.
22466 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22467 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
22468 (@value{GDBP})
22469 @end smallexample
22470
22471 @kindex maint packet
22472 @item maint packet @var{text}
22473 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
22474 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
22475 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
22476 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
22477 checksum.
22478
22479 @kindex maint print architecture
22480 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22481 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
22482 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
22483
22484 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
22485 @item maint print dummy-frames
22486 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
22487
22488 @smallexample
22489 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
22490 @dots{}
22491 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
22492 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
22493 58 return (a + b);
22494 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
22495 @dots{}
22496 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
22497 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
22498 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
22499 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
22500 (@value{GDBP})
22501 @end smallexample
22502
22503 Takes an optional file parameter.
22504
22505 @kindex maint print registers
22506 @kindex maint print raw-registers
22507 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
22508 @kindex maint print register-groups
22509 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22510 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22511 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22512 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22513 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
22514
22515 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
22516 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
22517 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
22518 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
22519 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
22520 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
22521
22522 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
22523 write the information.
22524
22525 @kindex maint print reggroups
22526 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
22527 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
22528 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
22529 information.
22530
22531 The register groups info looks like this:
22532
22533 @smallexample
22534 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
22535 Group Type
22536 general user
22537 float user
22538 all user
22539 vector user
22540 system user
22541 save internal
22542 restore internal
22543 @end smallexample
22544
22545 @kindex flushregs
22546 @item flushregs
22547 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
22548
22549 @kindex maint print objfiles
22550 @cindex info for known object files
22551 @item maint print objfiles
22552 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
22553 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
22554 and symtabs.
22555
22556 @kindex maint print statistics
22557 @cindex bcache statistics
22558 @item maint print statistics
22559 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
22560 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
22561 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
22562 of minimal, partical, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
22563 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
22564 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
22565 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
22566 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
22567 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
22568 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
22569 lengths.
22570
22571 @kindex maint print type
22572 @cindex type chain of a data type
22573 @item maint print type @var{expr}
22574 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
22575 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
22576 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
22577 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
22578 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
22579
22580 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22581 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22582 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
22583 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
22584 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
22585
22586 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
22587 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
22588 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
22589 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
22590 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
22591 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
22592 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
22593 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
22594 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
22595
22596 @kindex maint set profile
22597 @kindex maint show profile
22598 @cindex profiling GDB
22599 @item maint set profile
22600 @itemx maint show profile
22601 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
22602
22603 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
22604 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
22605 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
22606 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
22607 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
22608 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
22609 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
22610
22611 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
22612 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
22613
22614 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
22615 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
22616 @item maint show-debug-regs
22617 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
22618 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
22619 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when GDB inserts or
22620 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
22621 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
22622
22623 @kindex maint space
22624 @cindex memory used by commands
22625 @item maint space
22626 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
22627 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
22628 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
22629 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
22630 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22631
22632 @kindex maint time
22633 @cindex time of command execution
22634 @item maint time
22635 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
22636 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
22637 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
22638 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
22639 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
22640
22641 @kindex maint translate-address
22642 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
22643 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
22644 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
22645 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
22646 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
22647 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
22648 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
22649
22650 @end table
22651
22652 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
22653 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
22654
22655 @table @code
22656 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
22657 @kindex set watchdog
22658 @cindex watchdog timer
22659 @cindex timeout for commands
22660 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
22661 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
22662 reports and error and the command is aborted.
22663
22664 @item show watchdog
22665 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
22666 @end table
22667
22668 @node Remote Protocol
22669 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
22670
22671 @menu
22672 * Overview::
22673 * Packets::
22674 * Stop Reply Packets::
22675 * General Query Packets::
22676 * Register Packet Format::
22677 * Tracepoint Packets::
22678 * Interrupts::
22679 * Examples::
22680 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
22681 * Memory map format::
22682 @end menu
22683
22684 @node Overview
22685 @section Overview
22686
22687 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
22688 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
22689 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
22690 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
22691
22692 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
22693 transmitted and received data respectfully.
22694
22695 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
22696 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
22697 @cindex remote serial protocol
22698 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
22699 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
22700 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
22701 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
22702
22703 @smallexample
22704 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22705 @end smallexample
22706 @noindent
22707
22708 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
22709 @noindent
22710 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
22711 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
22712 eight bit unsigned checksum).
22713
22714 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
22715 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
22716
22717 @smallexample
22718 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22719 @end smallexample
22720
22721 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
22722 @noindent
22723 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
22724 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
22725 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
22726
22727 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
22728 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
22729 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
22730 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
22731 retransmission):
22732
22733 @smallexample
22734 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
22735 <- @code{+}
22736 @end smallexample
22737 @noindent
22738
22739 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
22740 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
22741 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
22742 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
22743
22744 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
22745 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
22746 exceptions).
22747
22748 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
22749 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
22750 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
22751 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
22752
22753 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
22754 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
22755 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
22756
22757 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
22758 @anchor{Binary Data}
22759 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
22760 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
22761 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
22762 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
22763 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
22764 binary data.
22765
22766 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
22767 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
22768 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
22769 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
22770 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
22771 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
22772 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
22773 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
22774 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
22775 (described next).
22776
22777 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
22778 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
22779 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
22780 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
22781 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
22782 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
22783 value greater than 126 should not be used.
22784
22785 So:
22786 @smallexample
22787 "@code{0* }"
22788 @end smallexample
22789 @noindent
22790 means the same as "0000".
22791
22792 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
22793 error number. That number is not well defined.
22794
22795 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
22796 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
22797 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
22798 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
22799 on that response.
22800
22801 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
22802 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
22803 optional.
22804
22805 @node Packets
22806 @section Packets
22807
22808 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
22809 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
22810 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for details about the File
22811 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
22812
22813 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
22814 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
22815 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
22816 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
22817 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
22818 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
22819 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
22820 @var{baz}. GDB does not transmit a space character between the
22821 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
22822 @var{baz}.
22823
22824 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
22825 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
22826
22827 Here are the packet descriptions.
22828
22829 @table @samp
22830
22831 @item !
22832 @cindex @samp{!} packet
22833 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
22834 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
22835 debugged.
22836
22837 Reply:
22838 @table @samp
22839 @item OK
22840 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
22841 @end table
22842
22843 @item ?
22844 @cindex @samp{?} packet
22845 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
22846 step and continue.
22847
22848 Reply:
22849 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22850
22851 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
22852 @cindex @samp{A} packet
22853 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
22854 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
22855 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
22856
22857 Reply:
22858 @table @samp
22859 @item OK
22860 The arguments were set.
22861 @item E @var{NN}
22862 An error occurred.
22863 @end table
22864
22865 @item b @var{baud}
22866 @cindex @samp{b} packet
22867 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
22868 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
22869
22870 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
22871 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
22872 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
22873
22874 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
22875 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
22876 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
22877 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
22878 of view, nothing actually happened.}
22879
22880 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
22881 @cindex @samp{B} packet
22882 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
22883 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
22884
22885 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
22886 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
22887
22888 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
22889 @cindex @samp{c} packet
22890 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
22891 resume at current address.
22892
22893 Reply:
22894 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22895
22896 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
22897 @cindex @samp{C} packet
22898 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
22899 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
22900
22901 Reply:
22902 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
22903
22904 @item d
22905 @cindex @samp{d} packet
22906 Toggle debug flag.
22907
22908 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
22909 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
22910
22911 @item D
22912 @cindex @samp{D} packet
22913 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
22914 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
22915
22916 Reply:
22917 @table @samp
22918 @item OK
22919 for success
22920 @item E @var{NN}
22921 for an error
22922 @end table
22923
22924 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
22925 @cindex @samp{F} packet
22926 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
22927 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
22928 remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
22929
22930 @item g
22931 @anchor{read registers packet}
22932 @cindex @samp{g} packet
22933 Read general registers.
22934
22935 Reply:
22936 @table @samp
22937 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
22938 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
22939 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
22940 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
22941 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros
22942 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The
22943 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
22944 @item E @var{NN}
22945 for an error.
22946 @end table
22947
22948 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
22949 @cindex @samp{G} packet
22950 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
22951 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
22952
22953 Reply:
22954 @table @samp
22955 @item OK
22956 for success
22957 @item E @var{NN}
22958 for an error
22959 @end table
22960
22961 @item H @var{c} @var{t}
22962 @cindex @samp{H} packet
22963 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
22964 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
22965 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
22966 operations. The thread designator @var{t} may be @samp{-1}, meaning all
22967 the threads, a thread number, or @samp{0} which means pick any thread.
22968
22969 Reply:
22970 @table @samp
22971 @item OK
22972 for success
22973 @item E @var{NN}
22974 for an error
22975 @end table
22976
22977 @c FIXME: JTC:
22978 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
22979 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
22980 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
22981 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
22982 @c described. For example:
22983 @c
22984 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22985 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
22986 @c otherwise returns current registers.
22987 @c
22988 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
22989 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
22990 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
22991
22992 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
22993 @anchor{cycle step packet}
22994 @cindex @samp{i} packet
22995 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
22996 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
22997 step starting at that address.
22998
22999 @item I
23000 @cindex @samp{I} packet
23001 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
23002 step packet}.
23003
23004 @item k
23005 @cindex @samp{k} packet
23006 Kill request.
23007
23008 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
23009 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
23010 thread?)}.
23011
23012 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
23013 @cindex @samp{m} packet
23014 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23015 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
23016
23017 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
23018 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
23019 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
23020 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
23021 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
23022 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
23023 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
23024 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
23025
23026 Reply:
23027 @table @samp
23028 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23029 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
23030 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
23031 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
23032 @item E @var{NN}
23033 @var{NN} is errno
23034 @end table
23035
23036 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23037 @cindex @samp{M} packet
23038 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
23039 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
23040 hexadecimal number.
23041
23042 Reply:
23043 @table @samp
23044 @item OK
23045 for success
23046 @item E @var{NN}
23047 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
23048 written).
23049 @end table
23050
23051 @item p @var{n}
23052 @cindex @samp{p} packet
23053 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
23054 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
23055 register value is encoded.
23056
23057 Reply:
23058 @table @samp
23059 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
23060 the register's value
23061 @item E @var{NN}
23062 for an error
23063 @item
23064 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
23065 @end table
23066
23067 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
23068 @anchor{write register packet}
23069 @cindex @samp{P} packet
23070 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
23071 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
23072 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
23073
23074 Reply:
23075 @table @samp
23076 @item OK
23077 for success
23078 @item E @var{NN}
23079 for an error
23080 @end table
23081
23082 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23083 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
23084 @cindex @samp{q} packet
23085 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
23086 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
23087 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
23088
23089 @item r
23090 @cindex @samp{r} packet
23091 Reset the entire system.
23092
23093 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
23094
23095 @item R @var{XX}
23096 @cindex @samp{R} packet
23097 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
23098 This packet is only available in extended mode.
23099
23100 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
23101
23102 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
23103 @cindex @samp{s} packet
23104 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
23105 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
23106
23107 Reply:
23108 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23109
23110 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
23111 @anchor{step with signal packet}
23112 @cindex @samp{S} packet
23113 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
23114 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
23115
23116 Reply:
23117 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23118
23119 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
23120 @cindex @samp{t} packet
23121 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
23122 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
23123 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
23124
23125 @item T @var{XX}
23126 @cindex @samp{T} packet
23127 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
23128
23129 Reply:
23130 @table @samp
23131 @item OK
23132 thread is still alive
23133 @item E @var{NN}
23134 thread is dead
23135 @end table
23136
23137 @item v
23138 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
23139 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
23140
23141 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{tid}@r{]]}@dots{}
23142 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
23143 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
23144 If an action is specified with no @var{tid}, then it is applied to any
23145 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
23146 specified then other threads should remain stopped. Specifying multiple
23147 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
23148 Thread IDs are specified in hexadecimal. Currently supported actions are:
23149
23150 @table @samp
23151 @item c
23152 Continue.
23153 @item C @var{sig}
23154 Continue with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23155 @item s
23156 Step.
23157 @item S @var{sig}
23158 Step with signal @var{sig}. @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
23159 @end table
23160
23161 The optional @var{addr} argument normally associated with these packets is
23162 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
23163
23164 Reply:
23165 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
23166
23167 @item vCont?
23168 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
23169 Request a list of actions supporetd by the @samp{vCont} packet.
23170
23171 Reply:
23172 @table @samp
23173 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
23174 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
23175 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
23176 @item
23177 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
23178 @end table
23179
23180 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
23181 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
23182 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
23183 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
23184 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
23185 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory map
23186 format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
23187 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
23188 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23189 packet is received.
23190
23191 Reply:
23192 @table @samp
23193 @item OK
23194 for success
23195 @item E @var{NN}
23196 for an error
23197 @end table
23198
23199 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23200 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
23201 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
23202 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
23203 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
23204 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
23205 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
23206 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
23207 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
23208 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
23209 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
23210 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
23211
23212
23213 Reply:
23214 @table @samp
23215 @item OK
23216 for success
23217 @item E.memtype
23218 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
23219 @item E @var{NN}
23220 for an error
23221 @end table
23222
23223 @item vFlashDone
23224 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
23225 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
23226 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
23227 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
23228 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
23229 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
23230 request is completed.
23231
23232 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
23233 @anchor{X packet}
23234 @cindex @samp{X} packet
23235 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
23236 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
23237 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
23238
23239 Reply:
23240 @table @samp
23241 @item OK
23242 for success
23243 @item E @var{NN}
23244 for an error
23245 @end table
23246
23247 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23248 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
23249 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
23250 @cindex @samp{z} packet
23251 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
23252 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
23253 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
23254 @var{length} bytes.
23255
23256 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
23257 separately.
23258
23259 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
23260 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
23261 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
23262 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
23263 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
23264 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
23265
23266 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23267 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
23268 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
23269 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
23270 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
23271 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23272
23273 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
23274 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
23275 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
23276 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
23277 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
23278
23279 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
23280 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
23281 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
23282 target, is not defined.}
23283
23284 Reply:
23285 @table @samp
23286 @item OK
23287 success
23288 @item
23289 not supported
23290 @item E @var{NN}
23291 for an error
23292 @end table
23293
23294 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23295 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
23296 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
23297 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
23298 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
23299 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
23300
23301 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
23302 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
23303
23304 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
23305 movement.}
23306
23307 Reply:
23308 @table @samp
23309 @item OK
23310 success
23311 @item
23312 not supported
23313 @item E @var{NN}
23314 for an error
23315 @end table
23316
23317 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23318 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
23319 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
23320 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
23321 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
23322
23323 Reply:
23324 @table @samp
23325 @item OK
23326 success
23327 @item
23328 not supported
23329 @item E @var{NN}
23330 for an error
23331 @end table
23332
23333 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23334 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
23335 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
23336 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
23337 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
23338
23339 Reply:
23340 @table @samp
23341 @item OK
23342 success
23343 @item
23344 not supported
23345 @item E @var{NN}
23346 for an error
23347 @end table
23348
23349 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23350 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
23351 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
23352 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
23353 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
23354
23355 Reply:
23356 @table @samp
23357 @item OK
23358 success
23359 @item
23360 not supported
23361 @item E @var{NN}
23362 for an error
23363 @end table
23364
23365 @end table
23366
23367 @node Stop Reply Packets
23368 @section Stop Reply Packets
23369 @cindex stop reply packets
23370
23371 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
23372 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
23373 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
23374 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
23375 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
23376 @value{GDBN} source code.
23377
23378 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
23379 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
23380 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
23381 components.
23382
23383 @table @samp
23384
23385 @item S @var{AA}
23386 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23387 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
23388 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
23389
23390 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
23391 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
23392 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
23393 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
23394 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
23395 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
23396 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
23397 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
23398 @enumerate
23399 @item
23400 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
23401 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
23402 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
23403 two-digit hex number.
23404 @item
23405 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the thread process ID, in
23406 hex.
23407 @item
23408 If @var{n} is @samp{watch}, @samp{rwatch}, or @samp{awatch}, then the
23409 packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
23410 hex.
23411 @item
23412 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
23413 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
23414 future.
23415 @end enumerate
23416
23417 @item W @var{AA}
23418 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
23419 applicable to certain targets.
23420
23421 @item X @var{AA}
23422 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
23423
23424 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
23425 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
23426 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
23427 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
23428 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
23429
23430 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
23431 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
23432 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
23433 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
23434 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
23435 system calls.
23436
23437 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
23438 this very system call.
23439
23440 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
23441 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
23442 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
23443 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
23444 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O remote
23445 protocol extension}, for more details.
23446
23447 @end table
23448
23449 @node General Query Packets
23450 @section General Query Packets
23451 @cindex remote query requests
23452
23453 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
23454 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
23455 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
23456 sending information to and from the stub.
23457
23458 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
23459 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
23460 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
23461 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
23462 conventions:
23463
23464 @itemize @bullet
23465 @item
23466 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
23467 @item
23468 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
23469 letter.
23470 @item
23471 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
23472 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
23473 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
23474 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
23475 @end itemize
23476
23477 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
23478 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
23479 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
23480 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
23481 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
23482 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
23483 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
23484 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
23485 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
23486 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
23487 packet.}.
23488
23489 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
23490 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
23491 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
23492 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
23493 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
23494
23495 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
23496
23497 @table @samp
23498
23499 @item qC
23500 @cindex current thread, remote request
23501 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
23502 Return the current thread id.
23503
23504 Reply:
23505 @table @samp
23506 @item QC @var{pid}
23507 Where @var{pid} is an unsigned hexadecimal process id.
23508 @item @r{(anything else)}
23509 Any other reply implies the old pid.
23510 @end table
23511
23512 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
23513 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
23514 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
23515 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
23516 Reply:
23517 @table @samp
23518 @item E @var{NN}
23519 An error (such as memory fault)
23520 @item C @var{crc32}
23521 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
23522 @end table
23523
23524 @item qfThreadInfo
23525 @itemx qsThreadInfo
23526 @cindex list active threads, remote request
23527 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
23528 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
23529 Obtain a list of all active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
23530 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
23531 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
23532 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
23533 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
23534 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
23535
23536 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
23537
23538 Reply:
23539 @table @samp
23540 @item m @var{id}
23541 A single thread id
23542 @item m @var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
23543 a comma-separated list of thread ids
23544 @item l
23545 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
23546 @end table
23547
23548 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
23549 more thread ids, in big-endian unsigned hex, separated by commas.
23550 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
23551 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
23552 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
23553
23554 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
23555 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
23556 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
23557 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
23558 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
23559
23560 @var{thread-id} is the (big endian, hex encoded) thread id associated with the
23561 thread for which to fetch the TLS address.
23562
23563 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
23564 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
23565 information associated with the variable.)
23566
23567 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI specific encoding of the
23568 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
23569 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
23570 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
23571 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
23572 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
23573
23574 Reply:
23575 @table @samp
23576 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23577 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
23578 local storage requested.
23579
23580 @item E @var{nn}
23581 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23582
23583 @item
23584 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
23585 @end table
23586
23587 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
23588 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
23589 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
23590 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
23591 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
23592 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
23593 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
23594
23595 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
23596
23597 Reply:
23598 @table @samp
23599 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
23600 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
23601 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
23602 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
23603 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
23604 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
23605 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
23606 @end table
23607
23608 @item qOffsets
23609 @cindex section offsets, remote request
23610 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
23611 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
23612 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
23613 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
23614 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
23615
23616 Reply:
23617 @table @samp
23618 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy};Bss=@var{zzz}
23619 @end table
23620
23621 @item qP @var{mode} @var{threadid}
23622 @cindex thread information, remote request
23623 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
23624 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
23625 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
23626
23627 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
23628 (see below).
23629
23630 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
23631
23632 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
23633 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
23634 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
23635 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
23636 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
23637 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
23638 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
23639 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
23640 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
23641 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
23642 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
23643 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
23644
23645 Reply:
23646 @table @samp
23647 @item OK
23648 The request succeeded.
23649
23650 @item E @var{nn}
23651 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
23652
23653 @item
23654 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
23655 the stub.
23656 @end table
23657
23658 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
23659 command (@pxref{Remote configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
23660 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23661 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23662
23663 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
23664 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
23665 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
23666 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
23667 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
23668 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
23669 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
23670 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
23671 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
23672
23673 Reply:
23674 @table @samp
23675 @item OK
23676 A command response with no output.
23677 @item @var{OUTPUT}
23678 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
23679 @item E @var{NN}
23680 Indicate a badly formed request.
23681 @item
23682 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
23683 @end table
23684
23685 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
23686 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23687 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23688 packets.)
23689
23690 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
23691 @cindex supported packets, remote query
23692 @cindex features of the remote protocol
23693 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
23694 @anchor{qSupported}
23695 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
23696 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
23697 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
23698 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
23699 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
23700 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
23701 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
23702 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
23703 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
23704 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
23705 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
23706 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
23707 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
23708 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
23709
23710 Reply:
23711 @table @samp
23712 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
23713 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
23714 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
23715 possible forms).
23716 @item
23717 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
23718 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
23719 @end table
23720
23721 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
23722 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
23723 are:
23724
23725 @table @samp
23726 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
23727 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
23728 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
23729 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
23730 @item @var{name}+
23731 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
23732 need an associated value.
23733 @item @var{name}-
23734 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
23735 @item @var{name}?
23736 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
23737 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
23738 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
23739 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
23740 @end table
23741
23742 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
23743 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
23744 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
23745 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
23746 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
23747
23748 No values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
23749 are defined yet. Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
23750 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
23751 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
23752 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Values
23753 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
23754 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
23755 improvements in the remote protocol---support for unlimited length
23756 responses would be a @var{gdbfeature} example, if it were not implied by
23757 the @samp{qSupported} query. The stub's reply should be independent
23758 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
23759 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
23760 all the features it supports.
23761
23762 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
23763 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
23764
23765 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
23766 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
23767 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
23768 form response.
23769
23770 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
23771 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
23772 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
23773 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
23774
23775 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
23776 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
23777 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
23778 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
23779 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
23780
23781 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
23782
23783 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.2 0.2 0.2
23784 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
23785 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
23786 @item Feature Name
23787 @tab Value Required
23788 @tab Default
23789 @tab Probe Allowed
23790
23791 @item @samp{PacketSize}
23792 @tab Yes
23793 @tab @samp{-}
23794 @tab No
23795
23796 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
23797 @tab No
23798 @tab @samp{-}
23799 @tab Yes
23800
23801 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
23802 @tab No
23803 @tab @samp{-}
23804 @tab Yes
23805
23806 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
23807 @tab No
23808 @tab @samp{-}
23809 @tab Yes
23810
23811 @end multitable
23812
23813 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
23814
23815 @table @samp
23816 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
23817 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
23818 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
23819 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
23820 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
23821 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
23822 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
23823 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
23824 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
23825 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
23826
23827 @item qXfer:auxv:read
23828 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
23829 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
23830
23831 @end table
23832
23833 @item qSymbol::
23834 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
23835 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
23836 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
23837 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
23838
23839 Reply:
23840 @table @samp
23841 @item OK
23842 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23843 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23844 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
23845 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
23846 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
23847 below.
23848 @end table
23849
23850 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
23851 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
23852
23853 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
23854 target has previously requested.
23855
23856 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
23857 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
23858 will be empty.
23859
23860 Reply:
23861 @table @samp
23862 @item OK
23863 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
23864 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
23865 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
23866 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
23867 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
23868 @end table
23869
23870 @item QTDP
23871 @itemx QTFrame
23872 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23873
23874 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{id}
23875 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
23876 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
23877 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
23878 the target OS. @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. This
23879 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
23880 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
23881 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
23882 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
23883 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
23884
23885 Reply:
23886 @table @samp
23887 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
23888 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
23889 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
23890 the thread's attributes.
23891 @end table
23892
23893 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
23894 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
23895 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
23896 packets.)
23897
23898 @item QTStart
23899 @itemx QTStop
23900 @itemx QTinit
23901 @itemx QTro
23902 @itemx qTStatus
23903 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
23904
23905 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
23906 @cindex read special object, remote request
23907 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
23908 @anchor{qXfer read}
23909 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
23910 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
23911 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
23912 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to the object; it can supply
23913 additional details about what data to access.
23914
23915 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
23916 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
23917 formats, listed below.
23918
23919 @table @samp
23920 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23921 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
23922 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
23923 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
23924
23925 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23926 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23927 @end table
23928
23929 @table @samp
23930 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
23931 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
23932 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory map format}. The
23933 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
23934 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
23935
23936 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
23937 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
23938 @end table
23939
23940 Reply:
23941 @table @samp
23942 @item m @var{data}
23943 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
23944 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
23945 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
23946 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
23947 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
23948 request.
23949
23950 @item l @var{data}
23951 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
23952 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
23953 than the @var{length} in the request.
23954
23955 @item l
23956 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
23957 There is no more data to be read.
23958
23959 @item E00
23960 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23961
23962 @item E @var{nn}
23963 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
23964 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23965
23966 @item
23967 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
23968 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
23969 @end table
23970
23971 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
23972 @cindex write data into object, remote request
23973 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
23974 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
23975 into the data. @samp{@var{data}@dots{}} is the binary-encoded data
23976 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
23977 is specific to the object; it can supply additional details about what data
23978 to access.
23979
23980 No requests of this form are presently in use. This specification
23981 serves as a placeholder to document the common format that new
23982 specific request specifications ought to use.
23983
23984 Reply:
23985 @table @samp
23986 @item @var{nn}
23987 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
23988 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
23989
23990 @item E00
23991 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
23992
23993 @item E @var{nn}
23994 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
23995 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
23996
23997 @item
23998 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
23999 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
24000 @end table
24001
24002 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
24003 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
24004 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
24005 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
24006 must respond with an empty packet.
24007
24008 @end table
24009
24010 @node Register Packet Format
24011 @section Register Packet Format
24012
24013 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
24014 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
24015 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
24016 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
24017 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
24018 most-significant - least-significant.
24019
24020 @table @r
24021
24022 @item MIPS32
24023
24024 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
24025 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
24026 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
24027
24028 @item MIPS64
24029
24030 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
24031 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
24032 as @code{MIPS32}.
24033
24034 @end table
24035
24036 @node Tracepoint Packets
24037 @section Tracepoint Packets
24038 @cindex tracepoint packets
24039 @cindex packets, tracepoint
24040
24041 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
24042 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
24043
24044 @table @samp
24045
24046 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
24047 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
24048 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
24049 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
24050 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
24051 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
24052 tracepoint's actions.
24053
24054 Replies:
24055 @table @samp
24056 @item OK
24057 The packet was understood and carried out.
24058 @item
24059 The packet was not recognized.
24060 @end table
24061
24062 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
24063 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
24064 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
24065 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
24066 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
24067 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
24068 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
24069
24070 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
24071 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
24072 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
24073 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
24074 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
24075 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
24076 tracepoint actions.
24077
24078 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
24079 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
24080 following forms:
24081
24082 @table @samp
24083
24084 @item R @var{mask}
24085 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
24086 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
24087 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
24088 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
24089 not fit in a 32-bit word.
24090
24091 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
24092 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
24093 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
24094 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
24095 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
24096 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
24097 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
24098
24099 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
24100 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
24101 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
24102 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
24103 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
24104 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
24105 packet).
24106
24107 @end table
24108
24109 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
24110 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
24111 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
24112 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
24113 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
24114 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
24115 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
24116 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
24117
24118 Replies:
24119 @table @samp
24120 @item OK
24121 The packet was understood and carried out.
24122 @item
24123 The packet was not recognized.
24124 @end table
24125
24126 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
24127 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
24128 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
24129 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
24130
24131 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
24132 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
24133 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
24134 one of the following forms:
24135
24136 @table @samp
24137 @item F @var{f}
24138 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
24139 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
24140 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
24141
24142 @item T @var{t}
24143 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
24144 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
24145
24146 @end table
24147
24148 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
24149 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24150 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
24151 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
24152
24153 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
24154 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24155 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
24156 is a hexadecimal number.
24157
24158 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
24159 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
24160 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
24161 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
24162 numbers.
24163
24164 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
24165 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
24166 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
24167
24168 @item QTStart
24169 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
24170 hits in the trace frame buffer.
24171
24172 @item QTStop
24173 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
24174
24175 @item QTinit
24176 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
24177
24178 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
24179 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
24180 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
24181 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
24182
24183 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
24184 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
24185 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
24186 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
24187
24188 @item qTStatus
24189 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
24190
24191 Replies:
24192 @table @samp
24193 @item T0
24194 There is no trace experiment running.
24195 @item T1
24196 There is a trace experiment running.
24197 @end table
24198
24199 @end table
24200
24201
24202 @node Interrupts
24203 @section Interrupts
24204 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
24205
24206 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
24207 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
24208 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
24209 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
24210
24211 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
24212 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does
24213 not currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
24214 interfaces.
24215
24216 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
24217 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
24218 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
24219 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
24220 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
24221 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
24222 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
24223 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
24224
24225 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
24226 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
24227 implementation defined. If the stub is successful at interrupting the
24228 running program, it is expected that it will send one of the Stop
24229 Reply Packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
24230 of successfully stopping the program. Interrupts received while the
24231 program is stopped will be discarded.
24232
24233 @node Examples
24234 @section Examples
24235
24236 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
24237 does not get any direct output:
24238
24239 @smallexample
24240 -> @code{R00}
24241 <- @code{+}
24242 @emph{target restarts}
24243 -> @code{?}
24244 <- @code{+}
24245 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24246 -> @code{+}
24247 @end smallexample
24248
24249 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
24250
24251 @smallexample
24252 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
24253 <- @code{+}
24254 -> @code{s}
24255 <- @code{+}
24256 @emph{time passes}
24257 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
24258 -> @code{+}
24259 -> @code{g}
24260 <- @code{+}
24261 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
24262 -> @code{+}
24263 @end smallexample
24264
24265 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
24266 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
24267 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
24268
24269 @menu
24270 * File-I/O Overview::
24271 * Protocol basics::
24272 * The F request packet::
24273 * The F reply packet::
24274 * The Ctrl-C message::
24275 * Console I/O::
24276 * List of supported calls::
24277 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
24278 * Constants::
24279 * File-I/O Examples::
24280 @end menu
24281
24282 @node File-I/O Overview
24283 @subsection File-I/O Overview
24284 @cindex file-i/o overview
24285
24286 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
24287 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
24288 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
24289 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
24290 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
24291 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
24292
24293 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
24294 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
24295 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
24296 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
24297 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
24298
24299 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
24300 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
24301 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
24302 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
24303 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
24304 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
24305 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
24306
24307 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
24308 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
24309 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
24310 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
24311 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
24312
24313 @smallexample
24314 (@value{GDBP}) continue
24315 <- target requests 'system call X'
24316 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
24317 -> GDB returns result
24318 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
24319 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
24320 @end smallexample
24321
24322 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
24323 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
24324 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
24325 system are not supported by this protocol.
24326
24327 @node Protocol basics
24328 @subsection Protocol basics
24329 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
24330
24331 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
24332 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
24333 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
24334 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
24335 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
24336 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
24337 to call the appropriate host system call:
24338
24339 @itemize @bullet
24340 @item
24341 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
24342
24343 @item
24344 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
24345 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
24346 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
24347 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol specific representation.
24348
24349 @end itemize
24350
24351 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
24352
24353 @itemize @bullet
24354 @item
24355 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
24356 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
24357 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
24358 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
24359 packet.
24360
24361 @item
24362 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
24363 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
24364
24365 @item
24366 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
24367
24368 @item
24369 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
24370
24371 @item
24372 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
24373 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
24374 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
24375 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
24376 packet.
24377
24378 @end itemize
24379
24380 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
24381 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
24382
24383 @itemize @bullet
24384 @item
24385 Return value.
24386
24387 @item
24388 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
24389
24390 @item
24391 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
24392
24393 @end itemize
24394
24395 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
24396 the latest continue or step action.
24397
24398 @node The F request packet
24399 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
24400 @cindex file-i/o request packet
24401 @cindex @code{F} request packet
24402
24403 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
24404
24405 @table @samp
24406 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
24407
24408 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
24409 This is just the name of the function.
24410
24411 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
24412 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
24413 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
24414 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
24415 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
24416 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
24417 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
24418
24419 @end table
24420
24421
24422
24423 @node The F reply packet
24424 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
24425 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
24426 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
24427
24428 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
24429
24430 @table @samp
24431
24432 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call specific attachment}
24433
24434 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
24435
24436 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
24437 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
24438
24439 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
24440 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
24441 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
24442
24443 @smallexample
24444 F0,0,C
24445 @end smallexample
24446
24447 @noindent
24448 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
24449
24450 @smallexample
24451 F-1,4,C
24452 @end smallexample
24453
24454 @noindent
24455 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
24456
24457 @end table
24458
24459
24460 @node The Ctrl-C message
24461 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} message
24462 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
24463
24464 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
24465 reply packet (@pxref{The F reply packet}),
24466 the target should behave as if it had
24467 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
24468 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
24469 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
24470 packet.
24471
24472 It's important for the target to know in which
24473 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
24474
24475 @itemize @bullet
24476 @item
24477 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
24478
24479 @item
24480 The system call on the host has been finished.
24481
24482 @end itemize
24483
24484 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
24485 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
24486 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
24487 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
24488 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
24489 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
24490
24491 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
24492 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
24493 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
24494 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
24495 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
24496 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
24497 or the full action has been completed.
24498
24499 @node Console I/O
24500 @subsection Console I/O
24501 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
24502
24503 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
24504 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
24505 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
24506 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
24507 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
24508 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
24509 conditions is met:
24510
24511 @itemize @bullet
24512 @item
24513 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
24514 @code{read}
24515 system call is treated as finished.
24516
24517 @item
24518 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
24519 newline.
24520
24521 @item
24522 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
24523 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
24524
24525 @end itemize
24526
24527 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
24528 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
24529 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
24530 is stopped at the user's request.
24531
24532
24533 @node List of supported calls
24534 @subsection List of supported calls
24535 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
24536
24537 @menu
24538 * open::
24539 * close::
24540 * read::
24541 * write::
24542 * lseek::
24543 * rename::
24544 * unlink::
24545 * stat/fstat::
24546 * gettimeofday::
24547 * isatty::
24548 * system::
24549 @end menu
24550
24551 @node open
24552 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
24553 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
24554
24555 @table @asis
24556 @item Synopsis:
24557 @smallexample
24558 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
24559 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
24560 @end smallexample
24561
24562 @item Request:
24563 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
24564
24565 @noindent
24566 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24567
24568 @table @code
24569 @item O_CREAT
24570 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
24571 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
24572 are concerned.
24573
24574 @item O_EXCL
24575 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
24576 an error and open() fails.
24577
24578 @item O_TRUNC
24579 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
24580 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
24581 truncated to zero length.
24582
24583 @item O_APPEND
24584 The file is opened in append mode.
24585
24586 @item O_RDONLY
24587 The file is opened for reading only.
24588
24589 @item O_WRONLY
24590 The file is opened for writing only.
24591
24592 @item O_RDWR
24593 The file is opened for reading and writing.
24594 @end table
24595
24596 @noindent
24597 Other bits are silently ignored.
24598
24599
24600 @noindent
24601 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
24602
24603 @table @code
24604 @item S_IRUSR
24605 User has read permission.
24606
24607 @item S_IWUSR
24608 User has write permission.
24609
24610 @item S_IRGRP
24611 Group has read permission.
24612
24613 @item S_IWGRP
24614 Group has write permission.
24615
24616 @item S_IROTH
24617 Others have read permission.
24618
24619 @item S_IWOTH
24620 Others have write permission.
24621 @end table
24622
24623 @noindent
24624 Other bits are silently ignored.
24625
24626
24627 @item Return value:
24628 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
24629 occurred.
24630
24631 @item Errors:
24632
24633 @table @code
24634 @item EEXIST
24635 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
24636
24637 @item EISDIR
24638 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
24639
24640 @item EACCES
24641 The requested access is not allowed.
24642
24643 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24644 @var{pathname} was too long.
24645
24646 @item ENOENT
24647 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24648
24649 @item ENODEV
24650 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
24651
24652 @item EROFS
24653 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
24654 write access was requested.
24655
24656 @item EFAULT
24657 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
24658
24659 @item ENOSPC
24660 No space on device to create the file.
24661
24662 @item EMFILE
24663 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
24664
24665 @item ENFILE
24666 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
24667 has been reached.
24668
24669 @item EINTR
24670 The call was interrupted by the user.
24671 @end table
24672
24673 @end table
24674
24675 @node close
24676 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
24677 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
24678
24679 @table @asis
24680 @item Synopsis:
24681 @smallexample
24682 int close(int fd);
24683 @end smallexample
24684
24685 @item Request:
24686 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
24687
24688 @item Return value:
24689 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
24690
24691 @item Errors:
24692
24693 @table @code
24694 @item EBADF
24695 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
24696
24697 @item EINTR
24698 The call was interrupted by the user.
24699 @end table
24700
24701 @end table
24702
24703 @node read
24704 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
24705 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
24706
24707 @table @asis
24708 @item Synopsis:
24709 @smallexample
24710 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
24711 @end smallexample
24712
24713 @item Request:
24714 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24715
24716 @item Return value:
24717 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
24718 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
24719 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
24720
24721 @item Errors:
24722
24723 @table @code
24724 @item EBADF
24725 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24726 reading.
24727
24728 @item EFAULT
24729 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24730
24731 @item EINTR
24732 The call was interrupted by the user.
24733 @end table
24734
24735 @end table
24736
24737 @node write
24738 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
24739 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
24740
24741 @table @asis
24742 @item Synopsis:
24743 @smallexample
24744 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
24745 @end smallexample
24746
24747 @item Request:
24748 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
24749
24750 @item Return value:
24751 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
24752 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
24753 is returned.
24754
24755 @item Errors:
24756
24757 @table @code
24758 @item EBADF
24759 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
24760 writing.
24761
24762 @item EFAULT
24763 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24764
24765 @item EFBIG
24766 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
24767 host specific maximum file size allowed.
24768
24769 @item ENOSPC
24770 No space on device to write the data.
24771
24772 @item EINTR
24773 The call was interrupted by the user.
24774 @end table
24775
24776 @end table
24777
24778 @node lseek
24779 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
24780 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
24781
24782 @table @asis
24783 @item Synopsis:
24784 @smallexample
24785 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
24786 @end smallexample
24787
24788 @item Request:
24789 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
24790
24791 @var{flag} is one of:
24792
24793 @table @code
24794 @item SEEK_SET
24795 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
24796
24797 @item SEEK_CUR
24798 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
24799 bytes.
24800
24801 @item SEEK_END
24802 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
24803 bytes.
24804 @end table
24805
24806 @item Return value:
24807 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
24808 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
24809 value of -1 is returned.
24810
24811 @item Errors:
24812
24813 @table @code
24814 @item EBADF
24815 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
24816
24817 @item ESPIPE
24818 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
24819
24820 @item EINVAL
24821 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
24822
24823 @item EINTR
24824 The call was interrupted by the user.
24825 @end table
24826
24827 @end table
24828
24829 @node rename
24830 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
24831 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
24832
24833 @table @asis
24834 @item Synopsis:
24835 @smallexample
24836 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
24837 @end smallexample
24838
24839 @item Request:
24840 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
24841
24842 @item Return value:
24843 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24844
24845 @item Errors:
24846
24847 @table @code
24848 @item EISDIR
24849 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
24850 directory.
24851
24852 @item EEXIST
24853 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
24854
24855 @item EBUSY
24856 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
24857 process.
24858
24859 @item EINVAL
24860 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
24861 of itself.
24862
24863 @item ENOTDIR
24864 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
24865 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
24866 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
24867
24868 @item EFAULT
24869 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
24870
24871 @item EACCES
24872 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24873
24874 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24875
24876 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
24877
24878 @item ENOENT
24879 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
24880
24881 @item EROFS
24882 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24883
24884 @item ENOSPC
24885 The device containing the file has no room for the new
24886 directory entry.
24887
24888 @item EINTR
24889 The call was interrupted by the user.
24890 @end table
24891
24892 @end table
24893
24894 @node unlink
24895 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
24896 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
24897
24898 @table @asis
24899 @item Synopsis:
24900 @smallexample
24901 int unlink(const char *pathname);
24902 @end smallexample
24903
24904 @item Request:
24905 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
24906
24907 @item Return value:
24908 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24909
24910 @item Errors:
24911
24912 @table @code
24913 @item EACCES
24914 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24915
24916 @item EPERM
24917 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
24918
24919 @item EBUSY
24920 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
24921 being used by another process.
24922
24923 @item EFAULT
24924 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24925
24926 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24927 @var{pathname} was too long.
24928
24929 @item ENOENT
24930 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
24931
24932 @item ENOTDIR
24933 A component of the path is not a directory.
24934
24935 @item EROFS
24936 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
24937
24938 @item EINTR
24939 The call was interrupted by the user.
24940 @end table
24941
24942 @end table
24943
24944 @node stat/fstat
24945 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
24946 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
24947 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
24948
24949 @table @asis
24950 @item Synopsis:
24951 @smallexample
24952 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
24953 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
24954 @end smallexample
24955
24956 @item Request:
24957 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
24958 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
24959
24960 @item Return value:
24961 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
24962
24963 @item Errors:
24964
24965 @table @code
24966 @item EBADF
24967 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
24968
24969 @item ENOENT
24970 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
24971 path is an empty string.
24972
24973 @item ENOTDIR
24974 A component of the path is not a directory.
24975
24976 @item EFAULT
24977 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
24978
24979 @item EACCES
24980 No access to the file or the path of the file.
24981
24982 @item ENAMETOOLONG
24983 @var{pathname} was too long.
24984
24985 @item EINTR
24986 The call was interrupted by the user.
24987 @end table
24988
24989 @end table
24990
24991 @node gettimeofday
24992 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
24993 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
24994
24995 @table @asis
24996 @item Synopsis:
24997 @smallexample
24998 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
24999 @end smallexample
25000
25001 @item Request:
25002 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
25003
25004 @item Return value:
25005 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
25006
25007 @item Errors:
25008
25009 @table @code
25010 @item EINVAL
25011 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
25012
25013 @item EFAULT
25014 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
25015 @end table
25016
25017 @end table
25018
25019 @node isatty
25020 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
25021 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
25022
25023 @table @asis
25024 @item Synopsis:
25025 @smallexample
25026 int isatty(int fd);
25027 @end smallexample
25028
25029 @item Request:
25030 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
25031
25032 @item Return value:
25033 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
25034
25035 @item Errors:
25036
25037 @table @code
25038 @item EINTR
25039 The call was interrupted by the user.
25040 @end table
25041
25042 @end table
25043
25044 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
25045 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
25046 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
25047 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
25048 needed.
25049
25050
25051 @node system
25052 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
25053 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
25054
25055 @table @asis
25056 @item Synopsis:
25057 @smallexample
25058 int system(const char *command);
25059 @end smallexample
25060
25061 @item Request:
25062 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
25063
25064 @item Return value:
25065 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
25066 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
25067 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
25068 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
25069 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
25070 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
25071 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
25072
25073 @item Errors:
25074
25075 @table @code
25076 @item EINTR
25077 The call was interrupted by the user.
25078 @end table
25079
25080 @end table
25081
25082 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
25083 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
25084 the host is simplified before it's returned
25085 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
25086 is discarded, and the return value consists
25087 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
25088
25089 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
25090 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
25091 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
25092
25093 @table @code
25094 @item set remote system-call-allowed
25095 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
25096 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
25097 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
25098
25099 @item show remote system-call-allowed
25100 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
25101 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
25102 protocol.
25103 @end table
25104
25105 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25106 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
25107 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25108
25109 @menu
25110 * Integral datatypes::
25111 * Pointer values::
25112 * Memory transfer::
25113 * struct stat::
25114 * struct timeval::
25115 @end menu
25116
25117 @node Integral datatypes
25118 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
25119 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
25120
25121 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
25122 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
25123 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
25124
25125 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
25126 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
25127
25128 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
25129
25130 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
25131 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
25132
25133 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
25134
25135 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
25136 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
25137 byte order.
25138
25139 @node Pointer values
25140 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
25141 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
25142
25143 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
25144 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
25145 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
25146 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
25147
25148 @smallexample
25149 @code{1aaf/12}
25150 @end smallexample
25151
25152 @noindent
25153 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
25154 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
25155 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
25156 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
25157
25158 @smallexample
25159 @code{123456/d}
25160 @end smallexample
25161
25162 @node Memory transfer
25163 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory transfer
25164 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
25165
25166 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
25167 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol specific format
25168 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
25169 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
25170 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
25171 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
25172 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
25173
25174
25175 @node struct stat
25176 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
25177 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
25178
25179 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
25180 is defined as follows:
25181
25182 @smallexample
25183 struct stat @{
25184 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
25185 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
25186 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
25187 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
25188 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
25189 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
25190 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
25191 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
25192 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
25193 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
25194 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
25195 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
25196 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
25197 @};
25198 @end smallexample
25199
25200 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25201 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25202 structure is of size 64 bytes.
25203
25204 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
25205 range of values.
25206
25207 @table @code
25208
25209 @item st_dev
25210 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
25211
25212 @item st_ino
25213 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25214
25215 @item st_mode
25216 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
25217 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
25218
25219 @item st_uid
25220 @itemx st_gid
25221 @itemx st_rdev
25222 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
25223
25224 @item st_atime
25225 @itemx st_mtime
25226 @itemx st_ctime
25227 These values have a host and file system dependent
25228 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
25229 support exact timing values.
25230 @end table
25231
25232 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
25233 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
25234 continuing.
25235
25236 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
25237 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
25238 get truncated on the target.
25239
25240 @node struct timeval
25241 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
25242 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
25243
25244 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
25245 is defined as follows:
25246
25247 @smallexample
25248 struct timeval @{
25249 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
25250 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
25251 @};
25252 @end smallexample
25253
25254 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
25255 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
25256 structure is of size 8 bytes.
25257
25258 @node Constants
25259 @subsection Constants
25260 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
25261
25262 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
25263 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
25264 values before and after the call as needed.
25265
25266 @menu
25267 * Open flags::
25268 * mode_t values::
25269 * Errno values::
25270 * Lseek flags::
25271 * Limits::
25272 @end menu
25273
25274 @node Open flags
25275 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
25276 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
25277
25278 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
25279
25280 @smallexample
25281 O_RDONLY 0x0
25282 O_WRONLY 0x1
25283 O_RDWR 0x2
25284 O_APPEND 0x8
25285 O_CREAT 0x200
25286 O_TRUNC 0x400
25287 O_EXCL 0x800
25288 @end smallexample
25289
25290 @node mode_t values
25291 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
25292 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
25293
25294 All values are given in octal representation.
25295
25296 @smallexample
25297 S_IFREG 0100000
25298 S_IFDIR 040000
25299 S_IRUSR 0400
25300 S_IWUSR 0200
25301 S_IXUSR 0100
25302 S_IRGRP 040
25303 S_IWGRP 020
25304 S_IXGRP 010
25305 S_IROTH 04
25306 S_IWOTH 02
25307 S_IXOTH 01
25308 @end smallexample
25309
25310 @node Errno values
25311 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
25312 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
25313
25314 All values are given in decimal representation.
25315
25316 @smallexample
25317 EPERM 1
25318 ENOENT 2
25319 EINTR 4
25320 EBADF 9
25321 EACCES 13
25322 EFAULT 14
25323 EBUSY 16
25324 EEXIST 17
25325 ENODEV 19
25326 ENOTDIR 20
25327 EISDIR 21
25328 EINVAL 22
25329 ENFILE 23
25330 EMFILE 24
25331 EFBIG 27
25332 ENOSPC 28
25333 ESPIPE 29
25334 EROFS 30
25335 ENAMETOOLONG 91
25336 EUNKNOWN 9999
25337 @end smallexample
25338
25339 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
25340 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
25341
25342 @node Lseek flags
25343 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
25344 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
25345
25346 @smallexample
25347 SEEK_SET 0
25348 SEEK_CUR 1
25349 SEEK_END 2
25350 @end smallexample
25351
25352 @node Limits
25353 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
25354 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
25355
25356 All values are given in decimal representation.
25357
25358 @smallexample
25359 INT_MIN -2147483648
25360 INT_MAX 2147483647
25361 UINT_MAX 4294967295
25362 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
25363 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
25364 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
25365 @end smallexample
25366
25367 @node File-I/O Examples
25368 @subsection File-I/O Examples
25369 @cindex file-i/o examples
25370
25371 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25372 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
25373
25374 @smallexample
25375 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
25376 @emph{request memory read from target}
25377 -> @code{m1234,6}
25378 <- XXXXXX
25379 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
25380 -> @code{F6}
25381 @end smallexample
25382
25383 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
25384 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
25385
25386 @smallexample
25387 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25388 @emph{request memory write to target}
25389 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25390 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
25391 -> @code{F6}
25392 @end smallexample
25393
25394 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
25395 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
25396
25397 @smallexample
25398 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25399 -> @code{F-1,9}
25400 @end smallexample
25401
25402 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
25403 host is called:
25404
25405 @smallexample
25406 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25407 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
25408 <- @code{T02}
25409 @end smallexample
25410
25411 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
25412 host is called:
25413
25414 @smallexample
25415 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
25416 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
25417 <- @code{T02}
25418 @end smallexample
25419
25420 @node Memory map format
25421 @section Memory map format
25422 @cindex memory map format
25423
25424 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
25425 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
25426 memory map.
25427
25428 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
25429 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
25430 lists memory regions. The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
25431
25432 @smallexample
25433 <?xml version="1.0"?>
25434 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
25435 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
25436 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
25437 <memory-map>
25438 region...
25439 </memory-map>
25440 @end smallexample
25441
25442 Each region can be either:
25443
25444 @itemize
25445
25446 @item
25447 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
25448 bytes from there:
25449
25450 @smallexample
25451 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25452 @end smallexample
25453
25454
25455 @item
25456 A region of read-only memory:
25457
25458 @smallexample
25459 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
25460 @end smallexample
25461
25462
25463 @item
25464 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
25465 bytes in length:
25466
25467 @smallexample
25468 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
25469 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
25470 </memory>
25471 @end smallexample
25472
25473 @end itemize
25474
25475 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
25476 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
25477 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
25478
25479 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
25480
25481 @smallexample
25482 <!-- ................................................... -->
25483 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
25484 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
25485 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
25486 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
25487 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
25488 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
25489 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
25490 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
25491 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
25492 and its type, or device. -->
25493 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
25494 start CDATA #REQUIRED
25495 length CDATA #REQUIRED
25496 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
25497 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
25498 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
25499 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
25500 @end smallexample
25501
25502 @include agentexpr.texi
25503
25504 @include gpl.texi
25505
25506 @raisesections
25507 @include fdl.texi
25508 @lowersections
25509
25510 @node Index
25511 @unnumbered Index
25512
25513 @printindex cp
25514
25515 @tex
25516 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
25517 % meantime:
25518 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
25519 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
25520 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
25521 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
25522 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
25523 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
25524 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
25525 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
25526 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
25527 \page\colophon
25528 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
25529 @end tex
25530
25531 @bye
This page took 0.572026 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.